Technical Report Documentation Page 1. Report No. FHWA/TX-04/0-4023-P3
2. Government Accession No.
3. Recipient's Catalog No. 5. Report Date February 2006 Published April 2006
4. Title and Subtitle DYNAMIC MESSAGE SIGN MESSAGE DESIGN AND DISPLAY MANUAL
6. Performing Organization Code
7. Author(s) Conrad L. Dudek With Contributions by Gerald L. Ullman
8. Performing Organization Report No. Report 0-4023-P3
10. Work Unit No. (TRAIS)
9. Performing Organization Name and Address Texas Transportation Institute The Texas A&M University System College Station, Texas 77843-3135
11. Contract or Grant No. Project No. 0-4023 13. Type of Report and Period Covered Manual: September 2000 – February 2006
12. Sponsoring Agency Name and Address Texas Department of Transportation Research and Technology Implementation Office P.O. Box 5080 Austin, Texas 78763-5080
14. Sponsoring Agency Code
15. Supplementary Notes Research performed in cooperation with the Texas Department of Transportation and the U.S. Department of Transportation, Federal Highway Administration. Research Project Title: Automated Dynamic Message Sign Design and Display If you have any comments regarding this product, please send them to Conrad Dudek at the Texas Transportation Institute (email: [email protected]), with a copy to Fabian Kalapach, Traffic Operations Division, TxDOT (email: [email protected]). 16. Abstract Project This Dynamic Message Sign Message Design and Display Manual was written for use by Texas Department of Transportation (TxDOT) personnel who have responsibility for the operation of and/or message design for large permanent dynamic message signs (DMSs) or portable DMSs. The Manual is designed to help both new and experienced users of DMSs at various levels of the agency including 1) entry-level personnel, 2) personnel very experienced with traffic operations, and 3) managers. It provides very specific information for entry-level personnel, reminders for experienced personnel, and higher-level information for managers regardless of whether they work in one of the Traffic Management Centers (TMCs) in the state. The Dynamic Message Sign Message Design and Display Manual contains the following 22 modules: 1) Introduction, 2) Principles of DMS Operations, 3) DMS Operating Fundamentals, 4) Principles of DMS Message Design, 5) Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents, 6) Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork, 7) Establishing the Maximum Message Length, 8) Dealing with Long Messages, 9) Designing DMS Messages for Incidents, 10) Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork, 11) Quick Reference Guide for Designing DMS Messages, 12) Modifying Messages to Improve Effectiveness, 13) Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise, 14) Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMS, 15) AMBER Alert, 16) Catastrophic Event, 17) High Water and Flood, 18) Ozone, 19) Planned Special Events, 20) Hurricane Evacuation, 21) DMS Operations Policies, and 22) DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines. 17. Key Words Dynamic Message Signs, Dynamic Message Sign Operations Policy, Dynamic Message Sign Message Design, Abbreviations, Highway Incidents, Highway Construction and Maintenance, AMBER Alert, Catastrophic Event, Floods, Planned Special Events, Ozone, Hurricane Evacuation,
18. Distribution Statement No restrictions. This document is available to the public through NTIS: National Technical Information Service 5285 Port Royal Road Springfield, Virginia 22161
19. Security Classif.(of this report) Unclassified
20. Security Classif.(of this page) Unclassified
21. No. of Pages 592
22. Price
Form DOT F 1700.7 (8-72) Reproduction of completed page authorized
DYNAMIC MESSAGE SIGN MESSAGE
DESIGN AND DISPLAY MANUAL
by
Conrad L. Dudek, Ph.D., P.E. Research Engineer
Texas Transportation Institute
With Contributions by
Gerald L. Ullman, Ph.D, P.E. Program Manager
Texas Transportation Institute
Report 0-4023-P3
Project Number 0-4023 Research Project Title: Automated Dynamic Message Sign Design and Display
Sponsored by the Texas Department of Transportation
In Cooperation with the U.S. Department of Transportation Federal Highway Administration
February 2006 Published: May 2006
TEXAS TRANSPORTATION INSTITUTE The Texas A&M University System College Station, Texas 77843-3135
DISCLAIMER Page v
DISCLAIMER The contents of this report reflect the views of the authors, who are responsible for the facts and the accuracy of the data presented herein. The contents do not necessarily reflect the official views or policies of the Texas Department of Transportation (TxDOT) or the Federal Highway Administration. This report is not intended to constitute a standard, specification, or regulation, nor is it intended for construction, bidding, or permit purposes. The engineer in charge of the study was Dr. Conrad L Dudek, P.E. #24320.
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS Page vi
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS This research was sponsored by the Texas Department of Transportation in cooperation with the Federal Highway Administration. The authors would like to thank the following TxDOT employees who provided guidance and expertise throughout the course of this study: Fabian Kalapach and Richard Reeves (retired), project directors; Brian Burk, Rick Cortez, Wallace Ewell (deceased), Brian Fariello, Pat Irwin (retired), Bubba Needham, Tai Nguyen, Terry Sams (retired) and Sally Wegmann, project advisory committee members; Al Kosik, project coordinator; and Carlton Allen and Steve Connell.
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page vii
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS
MODULE 1. INTRODUCTION 1.1 BACKGROUND AND SIGNIFICANCE OF THE DYNAMIC MESSAGE SIGN MESSAGE DESIGN AND DISPLAY MANUAL ................................................................................................................... 1-1 1.2 DMS MESSAGE DESIGN PROCESS ........................................................ 1-2 1.3 OVERVIEW OF MANUAL MODULES................................................... 1-3 MODULE 1. INTRODUCTION ................................................................................ 1-4 MODULE 2. PRINCIPLES OF DMS OPERATIONS .............................................. 1-4 MODULE 3. DMS OPERATING FUNDAMENTALS ............................................ 1-4 MODULE 4. PRINCIPLES OF DMS MESSAGE DESIGN..................................... 1-4
MODULE 5. DESIGNING THE BASIC DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS....... 1-4 MODULE 6. DESIGNING THE BASIC DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK..... 1-5 MODULE 7. ESTABLISHING THE MAXIMUM MESSAGE LENGTH............... 1-5 MODULE 8. DEALING WITH LONG MESSAGES ............................................... 1-5 MODULE 9. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR INCIDENTS .......................... 1-5 MODULE 10. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR ROADWORK........................ 1-5 MODULE 11. QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE FOR DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES.................................................................................... 1-6 MODULE 12. MODIFYING MESSAGES TO IMPROVE EFFECTIVENESS ........ 1-6 MODULE 13. PRIORITIES WHEN COMPETING MESSAGE NEEDS ARISE...... 1-6 MODULE 14. MESSAGE DESIGN EXAMPLES FOR INCIDENTS: LARGE DMS.................................................................................. 1-6 MODULE 15. AMBER ALERT .................................................................................. 1-6 MODULE 16. CATASTROPHIC EVENT .................................................................. 1-6 MODULE 17. HIGH WATER AND FLOODS ........................................................... 1-6 MODULE 18. OZONE................................................................................................. 1-7 MODULE 19. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS .......................................................... 1-7 MODULE 20. HURRICANE EVACUATION............................................................ 1-7 MODULE 21. DMS OPERATIONS POLICIES ......................................................... 1-7 MODULE 22. DMS OPERATIONS PROCEDURES AND GUIDELINES............... 1-7 APPENDIX A. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES......................................................................................... 1-7 APPENDIX B. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES......................................................................................... 1-7 APPENDIX C. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN AND FOG .......... 1-8 APPENDIX D. EFFECTS OF LARGE TRUCKS ON DMS LEGIBILITY................. 1-8
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page viii
MODULE 2 PRINCIPLES OF DMS OPERATIONS ............. 2-1 2.1 INTRODUCTION.................................................................................................. 2-1 EARLY WARNING MESSAGES.................................................................................. 2-1 ADVISORY MESSAGES............................................................................................... 2-1 ALTERNATIVE ROUTE MESSAGES.......................................................................... 2-1 2.2 IMPORTANCE OF MAINTAINING DMS CREDIBILITY............ 2-2 MODULE 3. DMS OPERATING FUNDAMENTALS .......... 3-1
3.1 BASIC CONSIDERATIONS FOR OPERATING DMSs.................. 3-1 DETERMINE THE PURPOSE FOR USING A DMS.................................................... 3-2 What Is the Problem I Am Trying to Address? ......................................................... 3-2 What Verified Information Do I Have? ..................................................................... 3-2 Who Is the Audience for the DMS Message?............................................................ 3-3 What Type of Motorist Response Is Required?......................................................... 3-3 Where Should the Response Take Place?.................................................................. 3-3 What Degree of Motorist Response Is Required?...................................................... 3-4 DETERMINE THE APPROPRIATE DMS TO USE ..................................................... 3-4 Proximity of DMSs to Problem ................................................................................. 3-4 Characteristics of the DMS Hardware ....................................................................... 3-4 Roadway, Traffic, and Environmental Characteristics in the Vicinity of the DMS.. 3-5 DETERMINE WHAT TO DISPLAY ON THE DMS.................................................... 3-5 Basic Information Needs and DMS Message ............................................................ 3-5 Diversion Routes........................................................................................................ 3-6 DMS Operator Message Options ............................................................................... 3-6 Selecting a Message from a Message Library ..................................................... 3-6 Modifying a Message from a Message Library ................................................... 3-7 Creating a New Message ..................................................................................... 3-7 DETERMINE HOW LONG TO DISPLAY THE MESSAGE ....................................... 3-7 RESOLVE ANY MESSAGE SIGNING CONFLICTS THAT EXIST.......................... 3-7 DISPLAY AND VERIFY DMS MESSAGE .................................................................. 3-8
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page ix
MODULE 4. PRINCIPLES OF DMS MESSAGE DESIGN .............................................................................................................................. 4-1 4.1 OVERVIEW OF ISSUES................................................................................... 4-1 4.2 SELECTING AN AUDIENCE FOR THE DMS MESSAGE .......... 4-3 4.3 DEFINITIONS AND MESSAGE DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS ............................................................................................ 4-4 DEVELOPING EFFECTIVE DMS MESSAGES........................................................... 4-4 MESSAGE CONTENT ................................................................................................... 4-4 MESSAGE LENGTH...................................................................................................... 4-4 MESSAGE LOAD AND UNIT OF INFORMATION ................................................... 4-6 MESSAGE FORMAT ..................................................................................................... 4-7 4.4 BASE DMS MESSAGE TO SATISFY MOTORIST INFORMATION NEEDS .................................................................................. 4-8 GENERAL CONCEPT OF BASE DMS MESSAGE..................................................... 4-8 INCIDENT/ROADWORK DESCRIPTOR..................................................................... 4-8 INCIDENT/ROADWORK LOCATION......................................................................... 4-8 LANES CLOSED .......................................................................................................... 4-10 CLOSURE DESCRIPTOR............................................................................................ 4-10 CLOSURE LOCATION................................................................................................ 4-10 EFFECT ON TRAVEL.................................................................................................. 4-10 Delay ........................................................................................................................ 4-10 Travel Time.............................................................................................................. 4-11 AUDIENCE FOR ACTION .......................................................................................... 4-13 ACTION ........................................................................................................................ 4-14 GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTION................................................. 4-14 4.5 WORD AND PHRASE MEANINGS AND CRITERIA................... 4-15 SELECTING FROM ALTERNATIVE WORDS AND PHRASES............................. 4-15 Use, Take and Follow .............................................................................................. 4-15 Construction vs. Roadwork...................................................................................... 4-16 Exit vs. Ramp........................................................................................................... 4-16 A Dash vs. Thru ....................................................................................................... 4-16 Nite vs. Night ........................................................................................................... 4-16 For 1 Week............................................................................................................... 4-16 Weekend .................................................................................................................. 4-17 WORDS AND TERMS WITH LOW MOTORIST UNDERSTANDING................... 4-17 Calendar Dates ......................................................................................................... 4-17 Lane Shift, Traffic Shifts, Lanes Change and New Traffic Pattern......................... 4-18
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page x
Revised July 2006
4.6 DIVERSION/DETOUR ROUTE DESCRIPTIONS FOR INCIDENT AND ROADWORK SITUATIONS .................................. 4-19 INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 4-19 DIVERSION/DETOUR ROUTE TYPES ..................................................................... 4-19 Type 1 Diversion Route ........................................................................................... 4-19 Type 2 Diversion Route ........................................................................................... 4-20 Type 3 Diversion Route ........................................................................................... 4-20 Type 4 Diversion Route ........................................................................................... 4-20 Type 5 Diversion Route: Incident Emergency Route Plan...................................... 4-21 Type 6 Detour Route: Traffic Control Plan for Roadwork Closure ........................ 4-21 Summary of Diversion/Detour Route Types ........................................................... 4-21 4.7 DYNAMIC FEATURES ON DMSs............................................................ 4-23
INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 4-23 FLASHING AN ENTIRE ONE-PHASE MESSAGE................................................... 4-23 FLASHING ONE LINE OF A ONE-PHASE MESSAGE............................................ 4-24 ALTERNATING TEXT ON ONE LINE OF A THREE-LINE DMS WHILE
KEEPING THE OTHER TWO LINES OF TEXT THE SAME............................. 4-24 MODULE 5. DESIGNING THE BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS ...................................................................................................... 5-1 5.1 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR LANE-CLOSURE (BLOCKAGE) INCIDENTS .......................................................................... 5-1 BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS.......................................................................... 5-1 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT ... 5-2 Incident Descriptor..................................................................................................... 5-2 Incident Location ....................................................................................................... 5-3 Lanes Closed.............................................................................................................. 5-4 Effect on Travel ......................................................................................................... 5-5 Action......................................................................................................................... 5-6 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message .............................................................................................. 5-6 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ............................................ 5-7 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ...... 5-8 Audience for Action................................................................................................... 5-9 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 5-10 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE INCIDENT... 5-11 Incident Descriptor................................................................................................... 5-11 Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-12 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-13
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xi
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-14 Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-15 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion
Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-15 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) .......................................... 5-16 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-17 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-18 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 5-19 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE INCIDENT .................................... 5-20 Incident Descriptor................................................................................................... 5-21 Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-22 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-23 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-24 Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-25 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-25 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) .......................................... 5-26 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-27 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-28 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 5-29 5.2 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY .......................................................................... 5-30 BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS .......................................................................... 5-30 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE .... 5-31 Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-32 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-33 Closure Location...................................................................................................... 5-34 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-35 Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-36 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 5-36 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-37 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route ................... 5-38 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-39 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 5-40 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE.... 5-41 Incident Descriptor................................................................................................... 5-41 Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-42 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-43 Closure Location...................................................................................................... 5-44 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-45
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xii
Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-46 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-46 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 5-47 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-48 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route ................... 5-49 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-50 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 5-51 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE CLOSURE ..................................... 5-52 Incident Descriptor................................................................................................... 5-53 Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-54 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-55 Closure Location...................................................................................................... 5-56 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-57 Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-58 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-58 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 5-59 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-60 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-61 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 5-62
5.3 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS ON AN
INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE CONNECTOR RAMP ........................................................................... 5-63 BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS .......................................................................... 5-63 DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE................................. 5-64 Incident Descriptor................................................................................................... 5-64 Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-65 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-66 Ramp Closure Descriptor......................................................................................... 5-67 Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-68 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-68 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 5-69 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-70 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route ................... 5-71 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-72 Good Reason for Following Action......................................................................... 5-73
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xiii
MODULE 6. DESIGNING THE BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK .................................................................................................. 6-1 6.1 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR LANE CLOSURES DURING ROADWORK .......................................................................................................... 6-1 BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS ............................................................................ 6-1 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE ROADWORK. 6-2 Roadwork Descriptor ................................................................................................. 6-2 Roadwork Location.................................................................................................... 6-3 Lanes Closed.............................................................................................................. 6-4 Effect on Travel ......................................................................................................... 6-5 Action ........................................................................................................................ 6-6 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message .............................................................................................. 6-6 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ..................................... 6-7 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .............................................................................................................. 6-8 Audience for Action................................................................................................... 6-9 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 6-10 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE ROADWORK.......................................................................................................... 6-11 Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-11 Roadwork Location.................................................................................................. 6-12 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-13 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-14 Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-15 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 6-15 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-16 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-17 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-18 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 6-19 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK................................ 6-20 Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-20 Roadwork Location.................................................................................................. 6-21 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-22 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-23
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xiv
Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-24 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 6-24 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-25 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-26 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-27 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 6-28 6.2 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK THAT REQUIRES CLOSING THE FREEWAY .............................................. 6-29 BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS .......................................................................... 6-29 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE .... 6-30 Base DMS Message Elements ................................................................................. 6-30 Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-31 Closure Location...................................................................................................... 6-32 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-33 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-34 Action....................................................................................................................... 6-35 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-36 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 6-37 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE.... 6-38 Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-38 Closure Location...................................................................................................... 6-39 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-40 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-41 Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-42 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 6-42 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-43 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-44 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 6 Diversion Route ................... 6-45 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-46 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 6-47 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE... 6-48 Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-49 Closure Location...................................................................................................... 6-50 Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-51 Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-52
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xv
Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-53 Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 6-53 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-54 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-55 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-56 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 6-57
6.3 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT REQUIRES CLOSING THE CONNECTOR RAMP ........................................................................... 6-58 BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS .......................................................................... 6-58 DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE................................. 6-59 Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-59 Closure Location...................................................................................................... 6-60 Ramp Closure Descriptor......................................................................................... 6-61 Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-62 Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-62 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-63 Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 6 Diversion Route ................... 6-64 Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-65 Good Reason for Following the Action ................................................................... 6-66 MODULE 7. ESTABLISHING THE MAXIMUM MESSAGE LENGTH ............................................................................................. 7-1
7.1 MESSAGE LENGTH AND DMS VIEWING DISTANCE REQUIREMENTS ................................................................................................ 7-1 7.2 MAXIMUM DMS LEGIBILITY DISTANCES FOR DAY AND
NIGHT OPERATIONS....................................................................................... 7-4
7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs ....................................................................................... 7-6 INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................... 7-6 REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVE DESIGN SPEEDS 45 MPH AND ABOVE...................................................................................................................... 7-6 REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVE DESIGN SPEEDS BELOW 45 MPH ....... 7-6
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xvi
EXAMPLES .................................................................................................................... 7-6 Example 1 .................................................................................................................. 7-6 Example 2 .................................................................................................................. 7-7 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs.................................................. 7-10
INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 7-10 REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES FOR PERMANENT DMSs ............ 7-10 REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES FOR PORTABLE DMSs ................ 7-10 EXAMPLES .................................................................................................................. 7-10 Example 1 ................................................................................................................ 7-10 Example 2 ................................................................................................................ 7-11 7.5 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN AND FOG............................................................................................................................. 7-18 REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN........................................................................................... 7-18 REDUCTIONS FOR FOG ............................................................................................ 7-18 EXAMPLE..................................................................................................................... 7-19 7.6 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS WHEN LARGE TRUCKS ARE PRESENT............................................................................... 7-20 INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 7-20 EFFECT OF LARGE TRUCKS ON DMS VIEWING................................................. 7-20 MODULE 8. DEALING WITH LONG MESSAGES.............. 8-1
8.1 SPLITTING MESSAGES.................................................................................. 8-1 NO MORE THAN TWO PHASES SHOULD BE USED .............................................. 8-1 EACH PHASE MUST BE UNDERSTOOD BY ITSELF.............................................. 8-1 COMPATIBLE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON THE SAME PHASE........................................................................................................... 8-2 A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATION..................................................................................... 8-3 NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS........................................ 8-3 8.2 APPROACHES TO REDUCING MESSAGE LENGTH.................. 8-5 DELETING “DEAD” WORDS ...................................................................................... 8-5 Street, Avenue or Boulevard...................................................................................... 8-5 Ahead ......................................................................................................................... 8-5 FORMATTING MESSAGES ......................................................................................... 8-6 Messages WITH Incident Descriptor Message Element ........................................... 8-6 Messages WITH Roadwork Descriptor Message Element........................................ 8-7
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xvii
Messages WITHOUT Incident Descriptor Message Element ................................... 8-8 Messages WITHOUT Roadwork Descriptor Message Element ............................... 8-9 USING ABBREVIATIONS .......................................................................................... 8-10 Acceptable Abbreviations........................................................................................ 8-10 Unacceptable Abbreviations .................................................................................... 8-10 8.3 REDUCING MESSAGE UNITS OF INFORMATION ................... 8-13 REFORMATTING THE MESSAGE............................................................................ 8-13 8.4 REDUCING UNITS OF INFORMATION FROM THE BASE DMS MESSAGE................................................................................................... 8-14 INITIAL REDUCTION APPROACHES...................................................................... 8-14 Reducing Redundancy in Incident and Roadwork Messages .................................. 8-14 Omitting Reference to Same Freeway as Incident/Roadwork and DMS ........... 8-14 Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages ............................................ 8-15 Combining Incident Descriptor, Location and Lanes Closed Message Elements ....................................................................................................... 8-15 Combining Location of Closure Message Element and Action Message Element ........................................................................................................ 8-16 Combining Message Elements for Roadwork Messages......................................... 8-17 Combining Roadwork Descriptor Message Element with Lanes Closed Message Element ......................................................................................... 8-17 Combining Roadwork Descriptor, Closure Location and Lanes Closed
Message Elements ....................................................................................... 8-18 Combining Location of Closure Message Element and Action Message Element ........................................................................................................ 8-18 SECONDARY REDUCTION APPROACH ................................................................ 8-19 Reducing the Number of Definitions in the Action Message Element.................... 8-19 PRIORITY REDUCTION PRINCIPLES...................................................................... 8-20 MODULE 9. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR INCIDENTS .................................................................................................................... 9-1 9.1 LANE CLOSURE (BLOCKAGE) INCIDENTS.................................... 9-1 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT ..... 9-1 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds .......................... 9-1 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS .............................................................. 9-1 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog .............................. 9-2 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message .................. 9-2
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xviii
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................... 9-2 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ................................................. 9-4 Format the Message ................................................................................................... 9-5 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................... 9-5 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less.................................................................. 9-5 Finalize DMS Message .............................................................................................. 9-6 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message................................................................................................................ 9-6 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE INCIDENT..... 9-7 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds .......................... 9-7 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS .............................................................. 9-7 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog .............................. 9-8 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message .................. 9-8 Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................... 9-8 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................... 9-10 Format the Message ................................................................................................. 9-10 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................. 9-10 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less................................................................ 9-11 Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................ 9-12 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message.............................................................................................................. 9-12 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE INCIDENT .................................... 9-13 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................ 9-13 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS ............................................................ 9-13 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ............................ 9-14 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message ................ 9-14 Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................. 9-14 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................... 9-16 Format the Message ................................................................................................. 9-16 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................. 9-16 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less................................................................ 9-17 Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................ 9-18 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message.............................................................................................................. 9-18
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xix
9.2 INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY..... 9-19 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE .... 9-19 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................ 9-19 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS ............................................................ 9-19 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ............................ 9-20 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message ................ 9-20 Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................. 9-20 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................... 9-21 Format the Message ................................................................................................. 9-22 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................. 9-22 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less................................................................ 9-23 Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................ 9-24 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message.............................................................................................................. 9-24 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE.... 9-25 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................ 9-25 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS ............................................................ 9-25 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ............................ 9-26 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message ................ 9-26 Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................. 9-26 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................... 9-28 Format the Message ................................................................................................. 9-28 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................. 9-28 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less................................................................ 9-29 Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................ 9-30 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message.............................................................................................................. 9-30 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE CLOSURE ..................................... 9-31 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................ 9-31 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS ............................................................ 9-31 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ............................ 9-32 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message ................ 9-32 Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................. 9-32 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................... 9-33 Format the Message ................................................................................................. 9-34 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................. 9-34
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xx
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less................................................................ 9-35 Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................ 9-36 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message.............................................................................................................. 9-36 9.3 INCIDENTS ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE CONNECTOR RAMP .......................... 9-37 DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE................................. 9-37 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................ 9-37 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS ............................................................ 9-37 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ............................ 9-38 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message ................ 9-38 Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................. 9-38 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................... 9-40 Format the Message ................................................................................................. 9-40 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................. 9-40 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less................................................................ 9-41 Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................ 9-42
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message.............................................................................................................. 9-42 MODULE 10. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR ROADWORK .............................................................................................................. 10-1 10.1 LANE CLOSURE DURING ROADWORK .......................................... 10-1 DMS ON THE SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE ROADWORK.......................................................................................................... 10-1 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................ 10-1 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS ............................................................ 10-1 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ............................ 10-2 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message ................ 10-2 Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................ 10-2 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................... 10-4 Format the Message ................................................................................................. 10-5 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................. 10-5 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less................................................................ 10-5 Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................ 10-6 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message.............................................................................................................. 10-6
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxi
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE ROADWORK.......................................................................................................... 10-7 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................ 10-7 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS ............................................................ 10-7 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ............................ 10-8 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message ................ 10-8 Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ................ 10-8 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................. 10-10 Format the Message........................................................................................... 10-10 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 10-10 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 10-11 Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 10-12 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message ............................................................................................................. 10-12 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK ............................... 10-13 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ....................... 10-13 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS............................................................ 10-13 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog............................ 10-14 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message................ 10-14 Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................ 10-14 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary............................................... 10-16 Format the Message................................................................................................. 10-16 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 10-16 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 10-17 Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 10-18 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message ............................................................................................................. 10-18 10.2 ROADWORK THAT REQUIRES CLOSING THE FREEWAY ............................................................................................................ 10-19 DMS ON THE SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE ............................................................................................................. 10-19 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ...................... 10-19 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS .......................................................... 10-19 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local
Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.. 10-20 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message .............. 10-20 Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs .............. 10-20
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxii
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................. 10-21 Format the Message ............................................................................................... 10-21 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ............................................................... 10-21 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less.............................................................. 10-22 Finalize DMS Message .......................................................................................... 10-23 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message............................................................................................................ 10-23 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE.. 10-24 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ...................... 10-24 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS .......................................................... 10-24 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local
Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.. 10-25 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message .............. 10-25 Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs .............. 10-25 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................. 10-26 Format the Message ............................................................................................... 10-27 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ............................................................... 10-27 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less.............................................................. 10-28
Finalize DMS Message .......................................................................................... 10-29 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message............................................................................................................ 10-29 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE. 10-30 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ...................... 10-30 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS .......................................................... 10-30 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local
Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.. 10-31 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message .............. 10-31 Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs .............. 10-31 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................. 10-32 Format the Message ............................................................................................... 10-33 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ............................................................... 10-33 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less.............................................................. 10-33 Finalize DMS Message .......................................................................................... 10-34 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message............................................................................................................ 10-35 10.3 ROADWORK ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT REQUIRES CLOSING THE CONNECTOR RAMP ..................... 10-36
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE............................... 10-36 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ...................... 10-36
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxiii
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS .......................................................... 10-36 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.. 10-37 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message .............. 10-37 Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs .............. 10-37 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................. 10-39 Format the Message ............................................................................................... 10-39 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ............................................................... 10-39 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less.............................................................. 10-40 Finalize DMS Message .......................................................................................... 10-41 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message............................................................................................................ 10-41 MODULE 11. QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE FOR DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES ................................................................ 11-1
11.1 INTRODUCTION................................................................................................ 11-1 11.2 LANE CLOSURE (BLOCKAGE) INCIDENTS.................................. 11-2 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT ... 11-2 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT............ 11-4 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT ............................................. 11-6 11.3 INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY..... 11-8 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE .... 11-8 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE .......... 11-12 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE............................................ 11-16 11.4 LANE CLOSURES DURING ROADWORK..................................... .11-19 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE
ROADWORK........................................................................................................ 11-19 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE
ROADWORK........................................................................................................ 11-21 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK.............................. 11-23 11.5 ROADWORK REQUIRING TOTAL FREEWAY CLOSURE. 11-25 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE .. 11-25 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE.. 11-27 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE. 11-29
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxiv
MODULE 12. MODIFYING MESSAGES TO IMPROVE EFFECTIVENESS.................................................................... 12-1 12.1 INTRODUCTION................................................................................................ 12-1 EXAMPLES OF IMPROVED MESSAGES FOR INCIDENTS.................................. 12-2 EXAMPLES OF IMPROVED MESSAGES FOR ROADWORK ............................... 12-7 MODULE 13. PRIORITIES WHEN COMPETING MESSAGE NEEDS ARISE............................................................................. 13-1 13.1 INTRODUCTION................................................................................................ 13-1 13.2 BASIC MESSAGE PRIORITIES ................................................................ 13-1 13.3 COMMON TYPES OF COMPETING MESSAGE NEEDS ......... 13-1 13.4 RESOLUTION OF COMMON TYPES OF
COMPETINGMESSAGE NEEDS.............................................................. 13-2 TWO EVENTS OCCUR CONCURRENTLY ON THE SAME FREEWAY.............. 13-3 Major Accident with Another Event........................................................................ 13-3 Minor Accident with Another Event........................................................................ 13-4 Construction with Another Event ............................................................................ 13-5 Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) with Another Event....................... 13-6 Disabled Vehicle with Another Event ..................................................................... 13-7 Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure with Another Event .................................................................................................................. 13-8 Incidents (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Freeway Closures with Another Event .................................................................................................... 13-9 Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s) with Another Event ..................... 13-10 Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closures with Another Event ................................................................................................................ 13-11 Special Event Exit with Another Event ................................................................. 13-12 ONE EVENT OCCURS ON THE PRIMARY FREEWAY AND THE SECOND OCCURS CONCURRENTLY ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY .............. 13-13 Major Accident on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway............................................................................................................ 13-14 Minor Accident on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway............................................................................................................ 13-15 Construction on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway............................................................................................................ 13-16 Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway...................................................... 13-17
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxv
Disabled Vehicle on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway........................................................................................ 13-18
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway............................... 13-19 Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Closure of the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway............................... 13-20 Maintenance Operations Requiring a Lane Closure on the Primary Freeway
with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway.............................................. 13-21 Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Closure of the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway...................................................... 13-22 Special Event Exit on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an
Intersecting Freeway........................................................................................ 13-23 ONE EVENT OCCURS ON THE PRIMARY FREEWAY AND THE SECOND OCCURS CONCURRENTLY ON A CONNECTING FREEWAY IN ANOTHER STATE............................................................................................... 13-24 TWO EVENTS OCCUR CONCURRENTLY ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY ............................................................................................................ 13-25 Major Accident with Another Event...................................................................... 13-25 Minor Accident with Another Event...................................................................... 13-26 Construction with Another Event .......................................................................... 13-27 Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) with Another Event..................... 13-28 Disabled Vehicle with Another Event 13-29 Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure with Another Event ................................................................................................................ 13-30 Incidents (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Freeway Closure with Another Event .................................................................................................. 13-31 Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s) with Another Event ..................... 13-32 Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closure with Another Event ................................................................................................................ 13-33 Special Event Exit with Another Event ................................................................. 13-34 ONE EVENT OCCURS ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY AND THE SECOND OCCURS CONCURRENTLY ON A CONNECTING FREEWAY IN ANOTHER STATE............................................................................................... 13-35 MODULE 14. DMS MESSAGE DESIGN EXAMPLES FOR INCIDENTS: LARGE DMSs .......................................................... 14-1 14.1 OBJECTIVES AND SUMMARY ................................................................ 14-1 14.2 INCIDENT EXAMPLES: ALL LANES ARE CLOSED................. 14-2 DEFINE SITUATION................................................................................................... 14-3 Analyze Incident and Incident Scene Characteristics.............................................. 14-3
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxvi
DEFINE MESSAGE FOR DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT (DMS #1)................................................................. 14-4 Identify DMS Characteristics .................................................................................. 14-4 Review Conditions at the DMS Location ................................................................ 14-4 Identify Diversion Route Characteristics................................................................. 14-4 Set Objectives .......................................................................................................... 14-5 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................ 14-5 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS ............................................................ 14-6 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ..................................................................................................................... 14-6 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message ................ 14-6 Define Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ....................... 14-6 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................... 14-8 Format the Message ................................................................................................. 14-8 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ................................................................. 14-8 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less................................................................ 14-8 Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................ 14-9 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorist to View the DMS Message.................................................................................................. 14-10 DESIGN MESSAGE FOR DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE INCIDENT (DMS #2) ............................................................. 14-11 Identify DMS Characteristics ................................................................................ 14-11 Review Conditions at the DMS Location .............................................................. 14-11 Identify Diversion Route Characteristics............................................................... 14-11 Set Objectives ........................................................................................................ 14-12 Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ...................... 14-12 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS .......................................................... 14-12 Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog ................................................................................................................... 14-13 Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message .............. 14-13 Define Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ..................... 14-13 Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary ............................................. 14-14 Format the Message ............................................................................................... 14-15 Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS ............................................................... 14-15 Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less.............................................................. 14-15 Finalize DMS Message .......................................................................................... 14-16 Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorist to View the DMS Message.................................................................................................. 14-16
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxvii
MODULE 15. AMBER ALERT ................................................................ 15-1 15.1 BACKGROUND, PROGRAMS, AND POLICIES .............................. 15-1 FEDERAL AMBER PLAN PROGRAM AND POLICIES ........................................... 15-1 TEXAS AMBER ALERT NETWORK AND POLICIES.............................................. 15-2 TXDOT AMBER ALERT COORDINATION............................................................... 15-3 15.2 MESSAGE ELEMENTS ................................................................................... 15-3 PRIORITY OF INFORMATION ................................................................................... 15-3 SITUATION DESCRIPTION......................................................................................... 15-4 VEHICLE DESCRIPTION............................................................................................. 15-4 LICENSE PLATE NUMBER......................................................................................... 15-4 TELEPHONE NUMBER................................................................................................ 15-5 TUNE TO RADIO .......................................................................................................... 15-6 15.3 MESSAGES.............................................................................................................. 15-6 ISSUES WITH MESSAGES CONTAINING VEHICLE DESCRIPTOR AND/OR A LICENSE PLATE NUMBER............................................................... 15-7 SCENARIOS AND MESSAGES ................................................................................... 15-7 MODULE 16. CATASTROPHIC EVENT ...................................... 16-1 16.1 BACKGROUND, PROGRAMS, and POLICIES ................................. 16-1 NATIONAL INCIDENT MANAGEMENT SYSTEM – INCIDENT COMMAND SYSTEM ................................................................................................................... 16-1 THE TEXAS OFFICE OF HOMELAND SECURITY.................................................. 16-1 THE GOVERNOR’S DIVISION OF EMERGENCY MANAGEMENT...................... 16-1 THE STATE OPERATIONS CENTER ......................................................................... 16-1 TEXAS SECURITY ANALYSIS AND ALERT CENTER........................................... 16-2 FEDERAL HIGHWAY ADMINISTRATION POLICY ON EMERGENCY OR SECURITY ALERT MESSAGES............................................................................ 16-2 16.2 MESSAGES.............................................................................................................. 16-3 CLOSING ACCESS TO THE CITY (AREA)................................................................ 16-3 DMS Relatively Close to the Event .......................................................................... 16-3 DMS Far from the Event ........................................................................................... 16-4
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxviii
MODULE 17. HIGH WATER AND FLOOD............................... 17-1 17.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 17-1 DRIVER INFORMATION NEEDS ............................................................................... 17-1 17.2 MESSAGES FOR WATER ON THE FREEWAY BUT PASSABLE ................................................................................................................17.2 MESSAGE FORMAT AND MESSAGE ELEMENTS ................................................. 17-2 Water Descriptor ....................................................................................................... 17-2 Water Location .......................................................................................................... 17-2 Water Downstream of Crossing Highway or Street ............................................ 17-2 Water Between Exit and Entrance Ramps........................................................... 17-3 Water Upstream of Exit Ramp............................................................................. 17-3 Action ........................................................................................................................ 17-3 17.3 MESSAGES FOR FREEWAY FLOOD CONDITION ..................... 17-4 MESSAGE FORMAT AND MESSAGE ELEMENTS ................................................. 17-4 Freeway Closure Descriptor...................................................................................... 17-4 Closure Location ....................................................................................................... 17-5 Action ........................................................................................................................ 17-5 DMS on Same Freeway and Relatively Close to the Flood ................................ 17-5 DMS on Same Freeway but Relatively Far from the Flood ................................ 17-5 MODULE 18. OZONE ....................................................................................... 18-1 18.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 18-1 18.2 OZONE MESSAGES .......................................................................................... 18-1 DAY PRIOR TO OZONE ACTION DAY..................................................................... 18-1 DAY OF OZONE ACTION DAY.................................................................................. 18-2 MODULE 19. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS .......................... 19-1 19.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 19-1 IMPACT AND OPERATIONAL STRATEGIES OF PLANNES SPECIAL EVENTS.................................................................................................................... 19-1 Categories of Planned Special Events ....................................................................... 19-1 SETTING PRIORITIES FOR PLANNED SPECIAL EVENT MESSAGES ................ 19-3
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxix
INFORMATION ON DMSs TO ACCOMPLISH OPERATIONAL STRATEGIES........................................................................................................... 19-3 Drivers Traveling to the Event .................................................................................. 19-3 Best Signing Strategy........................................................................................... 19-3 Information on DMS: Divert Event Traffic to an Alternative Route ................... 19-4 Static Trailblazer Signs ....................................................................................... 19-4 Drivers Not Traveling to the Event ........................................................................... 19-5 POLICY FOR DISPLAYING DMS MESSAGES ......................................................... 19-5 MODULE 20. HURRICANE EVACUATION ............................. 20-1 MODULE 21. DMS OPERATIONS POLICIES ........................ 21-1 21.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 21-1 21.2 FEDERAL POLICIES ........................................................................................ 21-1 21.3 REGIONAL POLICIES..................................................................................... 21-3 21.4 POTENTIAL TXDOT OPERATIONS POLICY
STATEMENTS FOR PERMANENT DMSs ........................................... 21-4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................... 21-4 1. RESPONSIBILITY FOR OPERATIONS OF DMSs............................................... 21-5 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-5 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-5 General ...................................................................................................................... 21-5 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-5 2. OPERATION OF DMSs BY OTHER STATE PERSONNEL................................. 21-5 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-5 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-5 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-6 3. OPERATION OF DMSs BY LAW ENFORCEMENT PERSONNEL.................... 21-6 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-6 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-6 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-6 4. GENERAL OPERATIONS ...................................................................................... 21-7 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-7 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-7 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-7
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxx
5. BLANK SIGNS......................................................................................................... 21-7 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-7 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-7 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-8 6. MESSAGES DURING PEAK PERIODS ................................................................ 21-9 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-9 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-9 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-9 7. DISPLAY OF TRAVEL TIMES .............................................................................. 21-9 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-9 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-9 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-10 8. DISPLAY OF UPCOMING ROADWORK ........................................................... 21-10 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-10 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-10 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-10 9. DISPLAY OF UPCOMING SPECIAL EVENTS THAT ADVERSELY
AFFECT TRAVEL ................................................................................................. 21-11 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-11 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-11 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-11
10. TRAFFIC DIVERSION (GENERAL).................................................................... 21-11 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-11 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-11 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-12 11. TRAFFIC DIVERSION TO ROADWAYS NOT UNDER THE
JURISDICTION OF TXDOT ................................................................................. 21-12 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-12 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-12 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-12
12. ADVANCE NOTICE OF ROADWORK INVOLVING LANE CLOSURES ...... 21-13 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-13 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-13 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-13 13. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS............................................................................. 21-13 Policy Alternative #1............................................................................................... 21-14 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-14 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-14
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxxi
Policy Alternative #2............................................................................................... 21-14 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-14 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-14 14. REGULATORY SPEED MESSAGES................................................................... 21-15 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-15 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-15 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-15 15. ADVERSE WEATHER, ENVIRONMENTAL, AND ROADWAY
CONDITIONS......................................................................................................... 21-16 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-16 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-16 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-16
16. LIMITS OF DMS INFLUENCE FOR INCIDENTS.............................................. 21-16 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-16 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-16 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-17 17. ADVERTISING ...................................................................................................... 21-17 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-17 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-17 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-17 18. PUBLIC SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENTS ............................................................ 21-18 Policy Alternative #1............................................................................................... 21-18 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-18 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-18 Policy Alternative #2............................................................................................... 21-19 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-19 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-19 19. DISPLAY OF AMBER ALERTS........................................................................... 21-19 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-19 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-19 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-20 20. DRIVER SAFETY CAMPAIGNS ......................................................................... 21-20 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-20 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-21 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-21 21. DISPLAYING MESSAGES FOR OTHER STATES ............................................ 21-21 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-21 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-21 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-21
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxxii
22. INTERMODAL INFORMATION.......................................................................... 21-21 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-21 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-22 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-22 23 OPERATION WITH LANE CONTROL SIGNALS ............................................. 21-22 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-22 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-22 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-22 24. TEST MESSAGES.................................................................................................. 21-23 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-23 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-23 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-23
MODULE 22. DMS OPERATIONS PROCEDURES AND GUIDELINES ............................................................................................... 22-1 22.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 22-1 22.2 DAYS AND HOURS OF OPERATION .................................................... 22-2 22.3 DMS OPERATORS ............................................................................................. 22-2 22.4 RESPONSIBILITIES OF DMS OPERATORS ..................................... 22-3 22.5 AUTHORITY TO DESIGN MESSAGES................................................. 22-5 22.6 DOCUMENTATION OF DMS USAGE.................................................... 22-5 22.7 GROUPING OPERATIONS OF MORE THAN ONE DMS .......... 22-5 APPENDICES A. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES .......................................................................................................................... A-1 B. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES ...........................................................................................................................B-1
MAIN TABLE OF CONTENTS Page xxxiii
C. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN AND FOG ............C-1 D. EFFECTS OF LARGE TRUCKS ON DMS VISIBILITY..................... D-1
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-i
MODULE 1. INTRODUCTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS 1.1 BACKGROUND AND SIGNIFICANCE OF THE DYNAMIC MESSAGE SIGN MESSAGE DESIGN AND DISPLAY MANUAL ................................................................................................................... 1-1 1.2 DMS MESSAGE DESIGN PROCESS ........................................................ 1-2 1.3 OVERVIEW OF MANUAL MODULES................................................... 1-3 MODULE 1. INTRODUCTION ................................................................................... 1-4 MODULE 2. PRINCIPLES OF DMS OPERATIONS ................................................. 1-4 MODULE 3. DMS OPERATING FUNDAMENTALS ............................................... 1-4 MODULE 4. PRINCIPLES OF DMS MESSAGE DESIGN........................................ 1-4 MODULE 5. DESIGNING THE BASIC DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS.......... 1-4 MODULE 6. DESIGNING THE BASIC DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK........ 1-5
MODULE 7. ESTABLISHING THE MAXIMUM MESSAGE LENGTH.................. 1-5 MODULE 8. DEALING WITH LONG MESSAGES .................................................. 1-5 MODULE 9. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR INCIDENTS ............................. 1-5
MODULE 10. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR ROADWORK........................... 1-5 MODULE 11. QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE FOR DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES 1-6
MODULE 12. MODIFYING MESSAGES TO IMPROVE EFFECTIVENESS ........... 1-6 MODULE 13. PRIORITIES WHEN COMPETING MESSAGE NEEDS ARISE......... 1-6 MODULE 14. MESSAGE DESIGN EXAMPLES FOR INCIDENTS: LARGE DMS............................................................................................................. 1-6 MODULE 15. AMBER ALERT ..................................................................................... 1-6 MODULE 16. CATASTROPHIC EVENT ..................................................................... 1-6 MODULE 17. HIGH WATER AND FLOODS .............................................................. 1-6 MODULE 18. OZONE.................................................................................................... 1-7 MODULE 19. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS ............................................................. 1-7 MODULE 20. HURRICANE EVACUATION............................................................... 1-7 MODULE 21. DMS OPERATIONS POLICIES ............................................................ 1-7 MODULE 22. DMS OPERATIONS PROCEDURES AND GUIDELINES.................. 1-7 APPENDIX A. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES.. 1-7 APPENDIX B. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL
CURVES.................................................................................................................... 1-7 APPENDIX C. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN AND FOG.......... 1-8
APPENDIX D. EFFECTS OF LARGE TRUCKS ON DMS LEGIBILITY ................ 1-8
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-1
MODULE 1. INTRODUCTION 1.1 BACKGROUND AND SIGNIFICANCE OF THE DYNAMIC
MESSAGE SIGN MESSAGE DESIGN AND DISPLAY MANUAL
This Dynamic Message Sign Message Design and Display Manual is designed for use by personnel in the Texas Department of Transportation (TxDOT) who have responsibility for the operation of and/or message design for large permanent dynamic message signs (DMSs) or portable DMSs. The Manual is written to help both new and experienced users of DMSs at various levels of the agency including 1) entry level personnel, 2) personnel very experienced with traffic operations, and 3) managers. It provides very specific information for entry-level personnel, reminders for experienced personnel and higher-level information for managers regardless whether or not they work in one of the Traffic Management Centers (TMCs) in the state. The design and display of messages on DMSs introduce many challenges to transportation agencies. The following paragraphs briefly summarize some of the relevant issues involved. Dynamic message signs, previously termed changeable message signs (CMSs) and sometimes referred to as variable message signs (VMSs), are one of the primary links a transportation agency has to the motoring public it serves. Although they have been in existence for more than 40 years in some parts of the U.S., only the recent emphasis and financial support of the Intelligent Transportation System (ITS) legacy has allowed most state transportation departments to purchase them and build the electronic monitoring systems necessary to operate them as a key component in an Advanced Transportation Management System. Since they represent many motorists’ primary concept of ITS, improperly designed messages or operations of DMSs will have negative impacts on the public’s perception of ITS in general. It is imperative that TxDOT districts take steps to ensure that the content, format, and application of information on the DMSs under their jurisdictions are of the highest possible quality and consistency statewide. The fact that DMSs are operated by different TMCs in different cities should be transparent to the motorist as they travel from one region of the state to the other. The design and display of messages on DMSs introduce many challenges. Recommendations to meet these challenges are presented in this Manual. The Manual is patterned after the New Jersey DOT’s Variable Message Sign Operations Manual (2000) and FHWA’s Guidelines for Changeable Message Sign Messages (2002). TxDOT’s Dynamic Message Sign Message Design and Display Manual includes the latest objective data and information that meets the specific needs of TxDOT.
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-2 1.2 DMS MESSAGE DESIGN PROCESS The Dynamic Message Sign Message Design and Display Manual is written with a focus on 1) the design of effective DMS messages for incident conditions and roadwork, and 2) when and where to display messages. This emphasis is intentional for the following reason. DMS operations require the user to have a good understanding of not only traffic operations but also a working knowledge of how messages are designed. The DMS message design procedure in this Manual, in effect, helps the user to learn more about traffic operations and to understand the strengths, limitations and possible consequences of the messages the operator displays. Emphasis is given throughout the Manual for effective message designs for DMSs located:
• On the same freeway and relatively close to the incident or roadwork; • On the same freeway but relatively far from the incident or roadwork; and • On a different freeway than the incident or roadwork.
The DMS message design process begins with the development of a Base DMS Message using guidelines of acceptable words and message terms for either incident or roadwork events. The Base DMS Message is the sum total of all the information that motorists need on a DMS in order to make a fully informed driving decision (e.g., whether to take an alternative route). In most cases, the Base DMS Message must be shortened because it will exceed the amount of information that motorists can read and comprehend in the short time they have available to read the message, or the message will exceed the amount of information that can physically fit on the DMS. The maximum length of message that can be displayed on a DMS depends on how far away motorists can adequately view the message and on their perception and information processing capabilities. Viewing distance will be affected by the type of sign used (light-emitting diode [LED], fiber-optic, etc.), the sun position, geometric design, and environmental conditions at the DMS location. Travel speed will affect the amount of information that motorists can read and comprehend. Guidance is given in the Manual in tables on the maximum number of units of information that can be displayed on a DMS based on type of DMS, travel speed, and sun position. In some cases when portable DMSs are used, it may be necessary to reduce the maximum number of units of information (using tables in the Manual) because of sight distance restrictions to the DMS due to vertical grades or horizontal curves. Additional guidelines are given for sight distance restrictions to the DMS because of fog or heavy rain. After the maximum number of units of information that should be displayed on a DMS is determined, detailed guidance is provided to shorten the Base DMS Message so that the maximum is not exceeded while keeping the most important information in the message. The process provides for consistency of information and format. Furthermore, the process assures that motorists will be able to read and understand the messages. The underlying objective is to keep messages as complete and concise as possible.
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-3 1.3 OVERVIEW OF MANUAL MODULES The Dynamic Message Sign Message Design and Display Manual contains the following twenty-two modules and four appendices:
• Module 1. Introduction; • Module 2. Principles of DMS Operations; • Module 3. DMS Operating Fundamentals; • Module 4. Principles of DMS Message Design; • Module 5. Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents; • Module 6. Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork; • Module 7. Establishing the Maximum Message Length; • Module 8. Dealing with Long Messages; • Module 9. Designing DMS Messages for Incidents; • Module 10. Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork; • Module 11. Quick Reference Guide for Designing DMS Messages; • Module 12. Modifying Messages to Improve Effectiveness; • Module 13. Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise; • Module 14. Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMS; • Module 15. AMBER Alert; • Module 16. Catastrophic Event; • Module 17. High Water and Floods; • Module 18. Ozone; • Module 19. Planned Special Events; • Module 20. Hurricane Evacuation; • Module 21. DMS Operations Policies; • Module 22. DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines;
• Appendix A Message Length Reductions for Vertical Curves; • Appendix B. Message Length Reductions for Horizontal Curves; • Appendix C. Message Length Reductions for Rain and Fog; and • Appendix D. Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility.
As discussed below, Modules 5, 6, 9 and 10 address details of the DMS message design processes for incidents and roadwork. These modules were written in a style to simplify the message design process for the DMS message designer. In addition, the intent was to reduce the amount of information the user has to search within the Manual when messages are designed. As such, the user will find a degree of repetition if Modules 5, 6, 9 and 10 are read from the beginning to the end. The Manual user will recognize the value of the repetition in these modules when messages are actually designed. A summary of the type of material covered in each module is provided below.
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-4 MODULE 1. INTRODUCTION The first module includes a discussion of the background and significance of the Dynamic Message Sign Message Design and Display Manual. The importance of the design of effective DMS messages is discussed and the message design process is summarized. MODULE 2. PRINCIPLES OF DMS OPERATIONS Base principles of DMS operations including the use of DMSs and the importance of maintaining DMS credibility are presented in the second module. MODULE 3. DMS OPERATING FUNDAMENTALS Module 3 contains a discussion of the five basic considerations when operating DMSs. These are: 1) determine the purpose for using a DMS, 2) determine which DMS is (are) appropriate to use, 3) determine what to display on the DMS, 4) determine how long to display the message, and 5) resolve any message signing conflicts that exist. MODULE 4. PRINCIPLES OF DMS MESSAGE DESIGN Basic principles for designing DMS messages are presented in Module 4. It contains an overview of issues for message design, discussion of selecting the audience for the message and definitions and message design considerations. Details are given for the first step in the DMS message design process: the design of the Base DMS Message needed to satisfy motorist information needs when the DMS is used to advise motorists of an accident or roadwork. Meanings of words and phrases based on human factors research are also given. The module also includes classification, definition, and discussion of six types of diversion routes that might apply in a diversion situation. MODULE 5. DESIGNING THE BASIC DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS Module 5 is devoted to presentation of the details, including message elements and words or terms, for designing the Base DMS Message when the sign is used to advise motorists of incidents. It includes detailed guidelines for 1) lane-closure (blockage) incidents, 2) incidents that block all the lanes, and 3) incidents that require closing the freeway. The guidelines are addressed for DMSs located on 1) the same freeway and relatively close to the incident or closure, 2) the same freeway but relatively far from the incident or closure, and 3) a different freeway than the incident or closure. The user of the Manual will find a degree of repetition in this module. The repetition is necessary in order to allow the user to reference successive pages when designing a message for the specific DMS location relative to the incident (i.e., relatively near, relatively far, on a different freeway) rather than shuffling through several sections of the Manual.
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-5 MODULE 6. DESIGNING THE BASIC DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK Module 6 is similar to Module 5 with the exception it addresses the design of the Base DMS Message when the sign is used to advise motorists of roadwork. Also, similar to Module 5, the Manual user will find a degree of repetition in this module. The repetition is necessary in order to allow the user to reference successive pages when designing a message for the specific DMS location relative to the roadwork (i.e., relatively near, relatively far, on a different freeway) rather than shuffling through several sections of the Manual. MODULE 7. ESTABLISHING THE MAXIMUM MESSAGE LENGTH Guidelines for the maximum DMS message length in terms of the maximum number of units of information that can be displayed are given in Module 7 based on DMS type, travel speed, and sun position. Guidelines for reducing this maximum on LED DMSs due to adverse vertical grades, horizontal curves, rain, or fog are also presented. A discussion and data concerning the number of motorists who may fail to read the DMS message because of the presence of trucks in the traffic stream are also given. MODULE 8. DEALING WITH LONG MESSAGES In most cases, the Base DMS Message designed in Modules 5 and 6 and reduced in length based on data in Module 7 will exceed the amount of information that motorists can read and comprehend in the short time they have available to read the message, or will exceed the amount of information that can physically fit on the DMS. Module 8 contains guidelines for several ways to reduce the message length and units of information. It includes guidelines on using abbreviations, deleting “dead” words, reformatting the message and combining message elements. Guidelines for splitting a message onto two phases when the message is too long to fit on one phase are also presented. MODULE 9. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR INCIDENTS A detailed step-by-step procedure for designing DMS messages for incidents is provided in Module 9. It includes detailed procedures for 1) lane-closure (blockage) incidents, 2) incidents that block all the lanes, and 3) incidents that require closing the freeway. The procedures are given for DMSs located on 1) the same freeway and relatively close to the incident or closure, 2) the same freeway but relatively far from the incident or closure, and 3) a different freeway than the incident or closure. MODULE 10. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR ROADWORK Module 10 is similar to Module 9, with the exception that it addresses designing DMS messages when the sign is used to advise motorists of roadwork.
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-6 MODULE 11. QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE FOR DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES The objective of Module 11 is to provide a quick reference guide for designing and selecting DMS messages. It is intended for TMC supervisory personnel and for DMS operators who have considerable experience with using the guidelines in Modules 9 and 10. MODULE 12. MODIFYING MESSAGES TO IMPROVE EFFECTIVENESS Module 12 is a quick reference guide illustrating how messages that violate good and sound principles for effective design can be improved. The Module includes examples of both incident and roadwork messages. MODULE 13. PRIORITIES WHEN COMPETING MESSAGE NEEDS ARISE Occasionally, two or more events occur simultaneously that require a decision as to which event should be displayed on the DMS. Module 13 contains a set of tables to help the DMS operator establish signing priority. MODULE 14. MESSAGE DESIGN EXAMPLES FOR INCIDENTS: LARGE DMS Two examples are given that illustrate how Module 9 is used to design DMS messages for large DMSs when incidents occur that close all the lanes of a freeway. MODULE 15. AMBER ALERT Federal and the state of Texas policies are discussed as well as the importance of statewide coordination of AMBER alert DMS messages. Recommended information elements that should be included in an AMBER alert message and recommended message design for a variety of scenarios are presented. MODULE 16. CATASTROPHIC EVENT Brief discussions of the National Incident Management System, Texas Office of Homeland Security, Governor’s Division of Emergency Management, and State Operations Center are presented. Federal policy on displaying DMS messages for emergencies and security is also presented. Recommendations are given for effect DMS message design during catastrophic events. MODULE 17. HIGH WATER AND FLOODS Driver information needs and recommended DMS message design are given for situations when 1) high water is on the freeway but drivers are still able to pass through and 2) the freeway is flooded and drivers are not able to continue on the freeway.
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-7 MODULE 18. OZONE Module 18 contains DMS design recommendations for ozone alerts on the day prior to an ozone action day and the day of the ozone action day. MODULE 19. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS Module 19 contains a listing and discussion of the categories of planned special events. Typical DMS messages for drivers who are traveling to the event and those not traveling to the event but are impacted by the event traffic are shown. MODULE 20. HURRICANE EVACUATION A brief discussion is presented concerning the focus group studies that were conducted as part of Study 0-4023. Given that following the focus group studies, Hurricane Rita impacted the Texas Gulf Coast and resulted in mass evacuation from major cities, it was deemed desirable to take advantage of the plight and evacuation experiences. A recommendation was made that Module 20 be completed after the results of further study in Project 0=4296 become available. MODULE 21. DMS OPERATIONS POLICIES Module 21 is divided into two major parts. The first part contains summaries of available DMS operations policies and guidelines at the federal level. In part two, guidelines are presented to assist TxDOT in developing statewide and regional policies for the operation of DMSs. Twenty-four candidate policy issues are presented. The following information is given for each of the issues: a) an explanation of the policy, b) a policy statement example that TxDOT can use in developing a policy, and c) a discussion of justification and/or considerations that may influence TxDOT’s decision to elect to include the statement in its policies. MODULE 22. DMS OPERATIONS PROCEDURES AND GUIDELINES Module 22 contains a listing and discussions of items that TxDOT may want to include in a manual on DMS operations procedures and guidelines. APPENDIX A. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES The theory and procedure for determining the sight distance to a DMS when there are restrictions because of a vertical curve are presented in Appendix A. Four examples using the procedure in Appendix A are also included. APPENDIX B. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES The theory and procedure for determining the sight distance to a DMS when there are restrictions because of a horizontal curve are presented in Appendix B. Two examples using the procedure in Appendix B are also included.
MODULE 1 Introduction Page 1-8 APPENDIX C. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN AND FOG The theory and procedure for determining the sight distance to a DMS when there are visual restrictions because of a heavy rain or fog are presented in Appendix C. An example illustrating the procedure is included. APPENDIX D. EFFECTS OF LARGE TRUCKS ON DMS LEGIBILITY The theory and procedure for determining the effects of large trucks on DMS legibility are presented in Appendix D. Two examples illustrating the procedure are included.
MODULE 2 Principles of DMS Operations Page 2-i
MODULE 2. PRINCIPLES OF DMS OPERATIONS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
2.1 INTRODUCTION.................................................................................................. 2-1
EARLY WARNING MESSAGES.................................................................................. 2-1
ADVISORY MESSAGES............................................................................................... 2-1
ALTERNATIVE ROUTE MESSAGES.......................................................................... 2-1
2.2 IMPORTANCE OF MAINTAINING DMS CREDIBILITY............ 2-2
MODULE 2 Principles of DMS Operations Page 2-1
MODULE 2. PRINCIPLES OF DMS OPERATIONS
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Road signs exist to communicate information to motorists. Static guide signs are permanent
and are limited to presenting information that is largely “geographically linked.” Dynamic
message signs can present up-to-the-moment traffic information.
DMSs are programmable traffic control devices that can usually display any combination of
characters to present messages to motorists. These signs are either permanent in which case they
are usually installed above or on the side of the roadway, or transportable, in which case they are
attached to a trailer or mounted directly on a truck and driven to a desired location. Portable
DMSs are much smaller than permanent DMSs and are often used in highway work zones, when
major accidents or natural disasters occur, or for special events (e.g., sport events).
Dynamic message signs perform a critical role on
freeways by furnishing motorists with real-time
information that advises them of a problem and
in some cases, a suggested course of action.
Dynamic message signs improve motorist safety
and reduce traffic congestion and delay. They are used to manage traffic by displaying early
warning, advisory and alternative route messages.
EARLY WARNING MESSAGES
Early warning messages give motorists advance notice of slow traffic and queuing ahead and
are effective in reducing secondary accidents. When used in freeway work zones, early warning
messages also give notice of new detours, changes in detour route, changes in lane patterns,
special speed control measures, etc.
ADVISORY MESSAGES
Advisory messages provide motorists with useful information about a specific problem along
their route. This information allows motorists to change their speed or path, as the situation
dictates, in advance of the problem area, or motorists may elect to voluntarily take an alternative
route to their destination.
ALTERNATIVE ROUTE MESSAGES
Alternative route messages influence motorists to travel to their chosen destination using
different routes than originally intended. The alternative route is one designated by the
transportation agency. In cases when the freeway is physically closed as a result of construction,
accident, or natural disaster, motorists are notified that an alternative route must be used.
DMSs are used to manage traffic by displaying:
! Early warning messages
! Advisory messages
! Alternative route messages
MODULE 2 Principles of DMS Operations Page 2-2
2.2 IMPORTANCE OF MAINTAINING DMS CREDIBILITY
To be effective, DMSs must provide timely,
reliable, accurate and relevant information and
they must be operated properly. An important
consideration in properly operating a DMS
system is to maintain credibility. Regardless of
how well a message is designed, there is a risk of
motorists distrusting the signing system if the messages are not changed at the correct times and
updated to reflect current traffic conditions. Each time the information displayed is disproved,
the credibility of the system decreases. Eventually motorists ignore the messages and the DMS
system is in jeopardy.
The first rule of good DMS operation is that
specific traffic information (e.g., accident)
should not be displayed before it has been
verified. For example, does the DMS
operator know there was an accident? Does he/she know where it occurred? Does he/she know
how many lanes are closed? Does he/she know if a specific route for diversion can handle the
capacity?
It is the responsibility of the DMS operator
to ensure that the motorists respect the
DMSs and continue to have confidence in
them. There are at least six ways to reduce
message credibility:
! Inaccurate information (e.g., no
accident is observed when traffic passes
by the location where an incident was
displayed on a DMS).
! Information is not current (e.g., the message is the same each morning when motorists pass
the sign).
! Information is irrelevant to essentially all motorists using that facility.
! Information is obvious by inspection, hence, is redundant (e.g., displaying HEAVYCONGESTION when motorists are driving bumper to bumper in peak traffic).
! Information is trivial (e.g.,DRIVE CAREFULLY, SUPPORT YOUR LOCAL RED CROSS,
time, and temperature). If trivial information is displayed, many motorists, particularly
commuters, will ignore the messages that have no direct impact on their trips and,
consequently, they will begin to ignore the DMS. When an important message is displayed
that will impact their trip, the motorists may not read the message.
WHAT MOTORISTS EXPECT FROM DMSs:
! Up-to-the-minute information
! Reliable information
! Accurate information
! Relevant information
RULE 1 - Never display specific traffic information
before it has been verified.
RULE 2 - There are at least six ways to lose the
motorists’ confidence in the DMS:
Display information that is! Inaccurate
! Not current
! Irrelevant
! Obvious
! Trivial
and/or display ! Erroneous numbers (e.g., incorrect speeds, travel
times, etc.)
MODULE 2 Principles of DMS Operations Page 2-3
! Displaying erroneous numbers such as traffic speeds and time to reach a destination can be
easily checked and disproved. The DMS operator should never display these values unless
they can be accurately predicted. However, delay time is more difficult to disprove by
motorists.
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-i
MODULE 3. DMS OPERATING FUNDAMENTALS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
3.1 BASIC CONSIDERATIONS FOR OPERATING DMSs.................. 3-1
DETERMINE THE PURPOSE FOR USING A DMS.................................................... 3-2
What Is the Problem I Am Trying to Address? ......................................................... 3-2
What Verified Information Do I Have? ..................................................................... 3-2
Who Is the Audience for the DMS Message?............................................................ 3-3
What Type of Motorist Response Is Required?......................................................... 3-3
Where Should the Response Take Place?.................................................................. 3-3
What Degree of Motorist Response Is Required?...................................................... 3-4
DETERMINE THE APPROPRIATE DMS TO USE ..................................................... 3-4
Proximity of DMSs to Problem ................................................................................. 3-4
Characteristics of the DMS Hardware ....................................................................... 3-4
Roadway, Traffic, and Environmental Characteristics in the Vicinity of the DMS.. 3-5
DETERMINE WHAT TO DISPLAY ON THE DMS.................................................... 3-5
Basic Information Needs and DMS Message ............................................................ 3-5
Diversion Routes........................................................................................................ 3-6
DMS Operator Message Options ............................................................................... 3-6
Selecting a Message from a Message Library ..................................................... 3-6
Modifying a Message from a Message Library ................................................... 3-7
Creating a New Message ..................................................................................... 3-7
DETERMINE HOW LONG TO DISPLAY THE MESSAGE ....................................... 3-7
RESOLVE ANY MESSAGE SIGNING CONFLICTS THAT EXIST.......................... 3-7
DISPLAY AND VERIFY DMS MESSAGE .................................................................. 3-8
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-1
MODULE 3. DMS OPERATING FUNDAMENTALS
3.1 BASIC CONSIDERATIONS FOR OPERATING DMSs
It is important to remember that DMSs are tools to help manage traffic on a roadway system.
Just as a carpenter carefully selects a tool and then uses that tool to accomplish a particular
construction task, one must determine when and how to use DMSs to best accomplish traffic
management tasks.
The operation of DMSs involves five basic considerations presented in logical order:
1. Determine the purpose for using a DMS;
2. Determine the appropriate DMS to use;
3. Determine what to display on the DMS;
4. Determine how long to display the message; and
5. Resolve any message signing conflicts that exist.
Within each of these, several factors and issues need to be addressed. It is important to realize
that these factors often change over the duration of an incident or other event. These changes
require the operator to revisit the situation and possibly modify how the DMS is being used.
This process can be illustrated as shown in Figure 3.1.
Figure 3.1 DMS Operating Process
Determine which DMS is (are) appropriate to use
Determine the purpose of using a DMS
Determine what to display on the DMS
Determine how long to display the message
Resolve any message signing conflicts that exist
Display and verify DMS message
Co
nti
nu
ou
sly c
han
gin
g i
nfo
rmat
ion
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-2
DETERMINE THE PURPOSE FOR USING A DMS
DMSs should always be used with a specific purpose or objective in mind. To determine this
purpose, the DMS operator must fully understand six things:
1. What is the problem I am trying to address?
2. What verified information do I have?
3. Who is the audience that I am trying to reach with the DMS message?
4. What type of motorist response is required?
5. Where should the response take place?
6. What degree of response is required?
What Is the Problem I Am Trying to Address?
The DMS operator must consider not only the basic type of problem (i.e., accident, work
zone lane closure, etc.) that exists, but also the following:
! Location of problem (position within the roadway right-of-way as well as its relation to other
freeways and major traffic generators);
! Scope (number and types of agencies that will likely need to be involved, whether police
officers will be required to direct traffic at the scene or on a detour, whether a major incident
response team will be activated);
! Potential duration of the situation; and
! Extent of impacts (number of lanes affected, location where lanes are affected, nearby ramps
that are blocked or constrained by the traffic queue, etc.).
What Verified Information Do I Have?
Credibility is very important in DMS operations. Although it is desirable to select and design
messages based on complete and perfect information, situations often occur where an operator
receives only limited information about a problem (particularly early in the timeline of an event).
Furthermore, the information may be from an unknown or untrained source (i.e., a motorist) or
may conflict with other information the operator has been received. As a result, a DMS operator
must decide what information can be used, and how it can be best used to operate the DMS.
Verified information is that which is obtained directly by the DMS operator via closed circuit
television or other visual means, or is provided by approved personnel of selected agencies. Law
enforcement officers, emergency response personnel, or transportation agency courtesy patrol
personnel are examples of individuals who can generally provide verified information.
Unverified information, on the other hand, is not obtained directly by the DMS operator or
received from the sources above. Most common examples of unverified information are calls
received from motorists about incidents that they have encountered. Unconfirmed commercial
radio reports are another source of unverified information.
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-3
DMS operators should only use verified information to operate DMSs. Motorists and other
sources of unverified information will often provide inaccuracies about locations and effects that,
if presented to the public and found to be false, degrade the credibility of the DMS system and
the operating agency. However, unverified information can be useful to the operator in identifying information items that may need to be explored further. For example, calls from one
or more motorists that an incident has cleared may prompt the DMS operator to check a closed
circuit television camera or contact the appropriate enforcement agency to verify that the
incident has indeed cleared.
If recommendations are to be made about a specific diversion route to use around a problem, the
DMS operator must also have information about current conditions on that route. If the operator
cannot obtain such information, the DMS should not recommend a specific route. The only
exception to this is when the freeway has been completely closed and police officers are
directing traffic along a designated detour route.
Who Is the Audience for the DMS Message?
A component of establishing an objective for a DMS message is to decide who the audience
will be for the message. The audience is the group of motorists that the DMS operator wants to
respond to the message in some manner. In some cases, this may be all of the motorists who
pass the DMS. In other cases, the message is intended for only some of the motorists (e.g., those
who are traveling all the way downtown). Depending on the situation, it may be necessary to
identify the intended audience as part of the DMS message itself. In other situations, the
intended audience is implied.
What Type of Motorist Response Is Required?
The operator of a DMS must first decide what he or she wants motorists to do in response to
the message placed on a sign or group of signs. Messages will be most effective when they
encourage some type of response from the motorist, such as to:
! Reduce speed,
! Move out of a blocked or closed lane, and/or
! Take an alternative route.
Where Should the Response Take Place?
The location where responses are desired will depend on 1) type of response desired, 2) the
layout of the roadway system, 3) the type and severity of problem being addressed and 4) the
availability of existing guide signs or those installed by TxDOT in response to a major incident. It
is important to realize that the desired motorist response to a particular problem may differ
depending on where in the roadway system the motorists are at that particular time. For example,
the desired response for a motorist traveling immediately upstream of a full freeway closure might
be to follow the designated traffic control devices off of the freeway, along the designated
alternative route, and back to the freeway. For motorists approaching on an intersecting freeway
farther upstream of the closure, however, the desired response might simply be to not exit onto the
closed freeway, and find their own alternative route to their ultimate destination. In general, the
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-4
more severe the problem and the longer it is expected to last, the farther upstream messages can be
displayed on DMSs.
What Degree of Motorist Response Is Required?
The DMS operator must continuously monitor traffic conditions and motorist response to the
DMS messages. Suggested alternative routes must provide improved travel to motorists
compared to remaining on the freeway. Remember, the messages on the DMSs can be changed
when conditions on the alternative route(s) no longer are better than the freeway.
DETERMINE THE APPROPRIATE DMS TO USE
Proximity of DMSs to Problem
Next, the operator must determine which DMS or DMS group within the overall DMS system
should be used to address a particular situation or problem. DMS operators should have a fairly
good idea of current locations of permanent DMSs or be able to quickly determine their location
from maps or computerized databases. These signs should be located where it is most
advantageous to provide information to motorists. For advance warning of future lane closures
and special events, the messages displayed are typically of a general warning nature and can be
displayed on DMSs over a fairly wide area. When signing for a current incident or work zone lane
closure, however, the DMS operator must be careful to make sure that the DMSs selected will
reach the appropriate audience for the message to be displayed. Two simple questions should be
asked when determining which DMS should be activated:
! Is the expected duration of the incident or lane closure longer than the expected travel time
from that DMS to the incident or lane closure?
! Are there a significant number of motorists traveling past the DMS who are destined for the
incident or lane closure location?
If the answer to either of these questions is “no,” the DMS is probably not appropriate to activate
for that situation.
Characteristics of the DMS Hardware
The characteristics of the DMS have an effect on how far away the DMS can be read and,
consequently, how much information can be presented to motorists. This information is generally
determined prior to TMC operations of the DMS. Some of the characteristics of a DMS that affect
legibility and message length include the type of sign (LED, fiberoptic, etc.), the number of lines
available, and the number of characters on each line.
In locations where permanent DMS have not been installed or in situations where the amount of
information that needs to be presented exceeds the motorists’ processing capabilities from a single
sign, it may be necessary to deploy portable DMSs to provide the necessary information to
motorists. The operator must consider the time needed to deploy these devices in determining
whether they are appropriate for a given situation. These DMSs should also be deployed far
enough away from other DMS, existing static signing, and complex roadway geometry such as
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-5
weaving areas. The DMS operator must ensure that motorists are not overloaded with information
when choosing where to place the portable DMS.
Roadway, Traffic, and Environmental Characteristics in the Vicinity of the DMS
The DMS operator also needs to be familiar with the actual site characteristics in the vicinity of
the DMS. These characteristics dictate the amount of information that can be displayed. Among
the items of interest are the following:
! The operating speed of traffic on the roadway;
! The presence and design characteristics of any vertical curves affecting sight distance;
! The presence of horizontal curves and obstructions such as trees, bridge abutments, or
construction vehicles that constrain sight distance to the DMS around the curve;
! The location of the DMS relative to the position of the sun (for daytime conditions);
! The presence, number, and information on static guide signs in the vicinity; and
! Whether or not rain or fog is present to degrade visibility to the sign.
DETERMINE WHAT TO DISPLAY ON THE DMS
Basic Information Needs and DMS Message
DMSs are a transportation agency’s direct link to the motoring public. Displaying well-
designed messages on DMSs is key to effectively managing traffic and to maintaining credibility
with motorists. The vast majority of this Manual is devoted to proper design of DMS messages.
Proper design begins with understanding the basic information needs of motorists. Motorists need
several different types of information in order to make their driving decisions. These elements
include the following:
! The type of problem (incident or road work descriptor),
! Location of the problem,
! The lanes that are affected (closure description),
! Location of the lane closure,
! The effect on travel,
! The audience for the message,
! Proper response or driving action by motorists, and
! A reason to follow the recommended driving action.
Unfortunately, motorists are not equipped to perceive, process, and remember a large amount of
information at one time. Consequently, the job of the DMS operator is to decide what information
is most important and how to present that information on a DMS in a way that maximizes motorist
understanding and encourages them to take appropriate actions.
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-6
Diversion Routes
Motorists must not be diverted to arbitrary routes. The practice in some TxDOT districts is to
divert traffic to another freeway rather than an arterial alternative route when diversion is required
unless the primary freeway is closed. It is important that the suggested freeway diversion route
result in a significant time savings compared to remaining on the primary freeway. In addition, it
must be a route that motorists can travel on without getting lost. Therefore, before recommended
diversion routes are displayed on a DMS, the DMS operator must know the following about the
route:
! Current traffic conditions,
! Current traffic capacity constraints, and
! Guide sign information.
When motorists are advised by the DMS message to divert and take a specific highway or route, it
is essential that the destination names and routes used in the message are the same as those
displayed on the existing guide signs. Inconsistency between the DMS message and the existing
guide signs will lead to motorist confusion and cause some to take incorrect routes. Therefore, the
DMS operator must have full knowledge of the wording and route markers on the existing guide
signs before diversion messages directing motorists to a specific highway or route are used in a
DMS message.
DMS Operator Message Options
The design of a safe, effective DMS message requires consideration of a number of different
factors and interactions between factors. This design process is complex, as is shown in the
following modules, and can take a significant amount of time to utilize properly. Fortunately,
many situations require a message or group of messages that are identical to those used in other
past situations or that have been developed in advance for a particular event. In other situations, a
DMS message or message group can utilize a general template and modify an item or two prior to
display on the DMS(s). Finally, an extremely complicated or unusual situation may necessitate
following the complete design process in order to determine the best DMS message to display.
Basic considerations under each of these approaches are discussed below.
Selecting a Message from a Message Library
In the simplest case, a DMS operator may be able to select a proper message from an existing
message library on the DMS operating system. The agency would have a predefined scenario
prepared (following the proper message design process) for a given type of problem, location,
severity (such as how many and which lanes are blocked or closed), and time of day. If a problem
develops that fits the scenario, the DMS operator can simply call up a message from the library
and display it on the appropriate sign(s). This approach only requires that the DMS operator be
able to verify that all of the information to be displayed on the DMS is correct (which lane or lanes
are blocked, the location of the problem, etc.).
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-7
Modifying a Message from a Message Library
Another type of DMS message that may be included in message libraries is one that requires
some modification by the operator prior to displaying it on a sign. The modification may be
needed to display the correct location of a problem to motorists, the lane(s) that are affected, the
action that should be taken, etc.
Modified messages present special challenges in DMS operations. They require DMS operators to
make sometimes complex decisions about message elements that need to be changed, whether a
change in overall message format is required (e.g., if the location name is fairly long), the proper
term to use for a location, etc. Consequently, the potential for errors to creep into modified
messages can increase during periods of high operator workload. DMS operators need to pay
special attention to ensure that they review such messages prior to posting on a DMS.
Creating a New Message
If a message in the library does not properly address the particular situation of interest or
cannot be modified to address the situation, a new message must be created. Principles and
procedures illustrated elsewhere in this Manual should be followed to formulate the message. This
requires the highest level of reasoning and decision making from the DMS operator. Those
operators who have responsibility for creating new messages must have adequate training in the
message design process.
DETERMINE HOW LONG TO DISPLAY THE MESSAGE
After messages have been selected and conflicts resolved, the DMS operator must decide how
long to display the message on the sign. For advance warning of upcoming work activity or
special events, the message can be shown for several hours or even days prior to the event.
However, it is more difficult to determine an appropriate duration for incidents. If the operator has
responsibility for only a limited number of DMSs and the incident occurs during off-peak periods
when demand for attention is lower, it may be acceptable to set an extremely long duration on the
message and simply turn the message off when the incident clears. This means that the operator
must constantly monitor the incident and then remember to deactivate the signs at its conclusion.
During periods of high operator workload or if the operator has a large number of DMSs to
operate, it may be necessary to estimate the expected duration of the incident and set the message
display time to that duration. This may require the operator to periodically adjust the time setting
if the expected duration changes as more information about the incident is obtained. The
advantage of such a procedure is that it ensures against an operator forgetting that a message is
being displayed long after an incident is cleared. Failure to deactivate messages that are no longer
relevant can degrade the agency’s credibility with the motoring public.
RESOLVE ANY MESSAGE SIGNING CONFLICTS THAT EXIST
After determining which message or messages are appropriate for the situation, the fourth step
in the process is to resolve any conflicts that may exist within the DMS system. For example, it is
possible that two incidents may occur in adjacent sections of roadway. These incidents may each
warrant several DMS messages in the vicinity, some on the same signs. In these cases, the
MODULE 3 DMS Operating Fundamentals Page 3-8
operator must prioritize messages at each DMS and display the message that is most appropriate.
Details on how to make these prioritization decisions are provided in MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise.
The most common types of possible message conflicts are as follows:
! Two events (incidents and/or road work) occur concurrently on the same freeway as the
DMS,
! One event (incident or roadwork) occurs on the same freeway as the DMS and a second
event occurs concurrently on an intersecting freeway,
! One event (incident or roadwork) occurs on the same freeway as the DMS and a second
event occurs concurrently on a connecting freeway in another state, and
! One event (incident or roadwork) occurs on an intersecting freeway to the DMS and a second
event occurs concurrently on a connecting freeway in another state.
Generally speaking, events on Texas freeways that are more current, more severe, and impact a
greater number of motorists passing the DMS will have higher priority.
DISPLAY AND VERIFY DMS MESSAGE
Once the operator is satisfied with the accuracy of the information available, the information in
the message and the message format, the selected message can be displayed. After the DMS
message is activated, it is important that the operator validate that the correct message is displayed
on the DMSs. It would be desirable to be able to validate the message by viewing the messages
via the closed circuit television (CCTV) system and electronically. If CCTVs are not positioned
such that the messages can be viewed, the operator will have to rely solely upon electronic
validation from the software/computer system. The implication is that DMSs should be part of a
coordinated ITS system and each component must reliably work together.
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-i
MODULE 4. PRINCIPLES OF DMS MESSAGE DESIGN
TABLE OF CONTENTS
4.1 OVERVIEW OF ISSUES................................................................................... 4-1 4.2 SELECTING AN AUDIENCE FOR THE DMS MESSAGE .......... 4-3 4.3 DEFINITIONS AND MESSAGE DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS ............................................................................................ 4-4 DEVELOPING EFFECTIVE DMS MESSAGES........................................................... 4-4 MESSAGE CONTENT ................................................................................................... 4-4 MESSAGE LENGTH...................................................................................................... 4-4 MESSAGE LOAD AND UNIT OF INFORMATION ................................................... 4-6 MESSAGE FORMAT ..................................................................................................... 4-7 4.4 BASE DMS MESSAGE TO SATISFY MOTORIST INFORMATION NEEDS .................................................................................. 4-8 GENERAL CONCEPT OF BASE DMS MESSAGE..................................................... 4-8 INCIDENT/ROADWORK DESCRIPTOR..................................................................... 4-8 INCIDENT/ROADWORK LOCATION......................................................................... 4-8 LANES CLOSED .......................................................................................................... 4-10 CLOSURE DESCRIPTOR............................................................................................ 4-10 CLOSURE LOCATION................................................................................................ 4-10 EFFECT ON TRAVEL.................................................................................................. 4-10 Delay ........................................................................................................................ 4-10 Travel Time.............................................................................................................. 4-11 AUDIENCE FOR ACTION .......................................................................................... 4-13 ACTION ........................................................................................................................ 4-14 GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTION................................................. 4-14 4.5 WORD AND PHRASE MEANINGS AND CRITERIA................... 4-15 SELECTING FROM ALTERNATIVE WORDS AND PHRASES............................. 4-15 Use, Take and Follow .............................................................................................. 4-15 Construction vs. Roadwork...................................................................................... 4-16 Exit vs. Ramp........................................................................................................... 4-16 A Dash vs. Thru ....................................................................................................... 4-16 Nite vs. Night ........................................................................................................... 4-16 For 1 Week............................................................................................................... 4-16 Weekend .................................................................................................................. 4-17 WORDS AND TERMS WITH LOW MOTORIST UNDERSTANDING................... 4-17 Calendar Dates ......................................................................................................... 4-17 Lane Shift, Traffic Shifts, Lanes Change and New Traffic Pattern......................... 4-18
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-ii
4.6 DIVERSION/DETOUR ROUTE DESCRIPTIONS FOR INCIDENT AND ROADWORK SITUATIONS .................................. 4-19 INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 4-19 DIVERSION/DETOUR ROUTE TYPES ..................................................................... 4-19 Type 1 Diversion Route ........................................................................................... 4-19 Type 2 Diversion Route ........................................................................................... 4-20 Type 3 Diversion Route ........................................................................................... 4-20 Type 4 Diversion Route ........................................................................................... 4-20 Type 5 Diversion Route: Incident Emergency Route Plan...................................... 4-21 Type 6 Detour Route: Traffic Control Plan for Roadwork Closure ........................ 4-21 Summary of Diversion/Detour Route Types ........................................................... 4-21 4.7 DYNAMIC FEATURES ON DMSs............................................................ 4-23
INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 4-23 FLASHING AN ENTIRE ONE-PHASE MESSAGE................................................... 4-23 FLASHING ONE LINE OF A ONE-PHASE MESSAGE............................................ 4-24 ALTERNATING TEXT ON ONE LINE OF A THREE-LINE DMS WHILE KEEPING THE OTHER TWO LINES OF TEXT THE SAME............................. 4-24
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-1
MODULE 4. PRINCIPLES OF DMS MESSAGE DESIGN 4.1 OVERVIEW OF ISSUES Dynamic message signs are one of the primary links a transportation agency has to the motoring public it serves. Since the signs represent the primary concept of ITS to motorists, improperly designed or operated DMS messages will have a negative impact on the perception of the public about ITS in general. The design and display of messages on DMSs introduce many challenges to transportation agencies. The following paragraphs briefly summarize some of the relevant issues involved. DMSs are the direct link with the motoring public—DMSs can be an effective tool for communicating with motorists. However, displaying messages that are too long for motorists to read at prevailing highway speeds or that are too complex or inappropriately designed leading to motorist confusion, can adversely affect both traffic flow and the transportation agency's credibility. Efforts must be made to ensure that DMS messages are standardized and consistently applied throughout the state or region—The messages displayed must be “transparent” to travelers in the state or region. Therefore, messages need to be presented in a consistent manner and order based on motorists’ expectancies. Only a few seconds are available to communicate a message—At prevailing highway speeds, the DMS message must be presented to motorists in about 8 seconds or less. This translates to a message with a maximum of eight words--Uninformed transportation personnel sometimes display messages that are too long for motorists, particularly slower readers such as the elderly, to read while driving at prevailing speeds. Available exposure time controls the maximum length of message that should be displayed—Results of research indicates that reading times for DMSs are higher than those for static guide signs. The distinguishing factor is that motorists can scan guide signs for relevant information, whereas they must read the entire message displayed on DMSs in order to understand the message. Exposure time is directly related to message legibility distance and driving speed. For a specific type and design of DMS, the available message exposure time dictates the maximum length of message that can be displayed for a given highway operating speed. In many signing situations, some of the basic information needed by motorists must be omitted from the DMS message—Key DMS objectives include maximizing information transfer to motorists, providing explicit advice, eliciting specific motorist response, and inducing motorist confidence. One major challenge is that this must be accomplished within a short time phase. DMS operators must strive to satisfy basic motorist information needs that allow more informed driving decisions to be made during incidents and roadwork. However, in most cases these basic needs exceed the number of units of information that a motorist can read and comprehend at prevailing driving speeds. Therefore, some of the information in the basic message must be omitted in order to meet the maximum number of units of information that can be processed by motorists. Tradeoffs must be made as to what elements of the message should be omitted.
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-2
In many signing situations DMS legibility distance constraints dictate the need to reduce the amount of information that is needed to fully communicate with motorists—The length of message that can be displayed on a DMS at a location also depends on how far away the motorists can adequately view the message and the prevailing speed of vehicles. At some locations, geometric features obscure the visibility of the DMS. At times, trucks in the traffic stream may obscure the motorist’s view of the DMS. Environmental conditions such as rain and fog deteriorate the amount of light that is coming from the DMS, thus reducing the distance at which motorists can read the message. The DMS message length must be reduced to compensate for the reduced legibility distance. Measures must be taken when developing DMS messages to enhance motorist understanding of messages—Research and experience have allowed the author of this Manual to determine which words and word combinations are understood by most motorists. In developing messages, factors that enhance understanding of messages include the following: 1. Simplicity of words, 2. Brevity, 3. Standardized order of words, 4. Standardized order of message lines, and 5. Using understood abbreviations when abbreviations are needed.
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-3
4.2 SELECTING AN AUDIENCE FOR THE DMS MESSAGE The DMS message designer must know the intended audience for the message that will be displayed. Research has found that in some cases commuters and visitors have different informational needs. The visitor has very limited information about a city other than interstate route numbers, whereas, commuters understand most of the intersecting and parallel streets. Thus, messages that incorporate local street or highway names that are understood by commuters, may not be understood by unfamiliar motorists. Also, abbreviations used for landmarks, bridges, and entertainment and recreational facilities may not be well understood by unfamiliar motorists even though they may be understood by local motorists. Research has also found differences among cities in Texas of motorist understanding of terms and abbreviations. For example, motorists in Houston are familiar with the term BLTWY 8, whereas, motorists in Austin, Dallas, El Paso, Fort Worth, and San Antonio are not.
UNFAMILIAR MOTORISTS WILL HAVE DIFFICULTY IN UNDERSTANDING: • Local street and highway names; and • Abbreviations for local landmarks, bridges,
and entertainment and recreational facilities.
Certain local names of facilities, landmarks, bridges, and entertainment and recreational facilities in selected Texas cities are not well-understood by motorists from other Texas cities.
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-4
4.3 DEFINITIONS AND MESSAGE DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS DEVELOPING EFFECTIVE DMS MESSAGES To be effective, a DMS must communicate a meaningful message that can be read and understood by motorists within a very short time period (constrained by the sight distance characteristics of the location and design features of the DMS). Extensive human factors and traffic operations research has been conducted, most of it by the author of this Manual and his colleagues, to develop fundamental principles and guidelines for DMS message design. The principles and guidelines are based on a solid understanding of motorist physical and information-processing capabilities and are valid so long as they are consistently and properly applied. MESSAGE CONTENT Message content refers to specific information displayed on a DMS, essentially, what is wrong ahead and what the motorist should do about it are the key elements.
DEFINITIONS FOR MESSAGE “___________” CONTENT: specific information displayed. LENGTH: number of words or number of characters
and spaces. LOAD: number of units of information in message. INFORMATIONAL UNIT: the answer to a question a motorist might ask. FORMAT: order of the units of information.
If DMSs are to be read and believed by motorists, the content of the message must provide information relative to their needs. Above all, they want to know if something “ahead” has occurred on the roadway which would change their plans. A DMS message should present “advice.” This appears at the end of the brief message. It may be REDUCE SPEED, EXIT AND TAKE OTHER ROUTES or some other advice. Motorists will ignore advice unless a reason is offered for taking it. The "reason" in most cases is the problem (ACCIDENT, LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED, etc.). Motorists expect this information to appear first in a DMS message. Motorists also would like to know where the problem has occurred. This is given on the second line. If the incident occurs far away, it may not affect them because they planned to exit long before then. MESSAGE LENGTH Length refers to either the number of words or the number of characters and spaces in a DMS message. With DMS line capacity less than optimal, it becomes necessary to count the characters in a message to determine if the message will fit. If the message does not fit, look for abbreviations to use and/or eliminate redundant words. It may at times be necessary to display the message in two phases. The maximum length of a DMS message is controlled in part by reading time—the time the motorist has available to read the message. Reading time is affected by 1) the time that the motorist is within the legibility zone of the DMS message, and 2) by the amount of activity in the
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-5
traffic stream which the motorist must attend to (e.g., reading signs, adjusting vehicle speed, lane positioning, etc.). The entire message must be short enough to allow motorists to glance at the sign and read and comprehend the message while attending to the complex driving situation. Message familiarity enhances motorist reading time. When information displayed on a DMS applies to unfamiliar drivers or when the information being presented to commuters is unusual, longer reading times will be required than for information posted frequently and seen repeatedly by commuting traffic. Obviously, site-specific characteristics and normal DMS operating procedures dictate what information is usual and what is not, and so this factor varies from location to location.
It takes unfamiliar motorists longer to read a DMS message than familiar motorists who see the sign regularly. Familiar motorists need more time to read unusual messages.
Another important consideration in designing DMS messages is the need for motorists to time-share their attention to the roadway, to traffic, and to reading signs. Adults can read quite fast while sitting at home reading a newspaper or novel or while in stopped traffic reading a sign or billboard. However, motorists cannot always devote full attention to sign reading. They must share their attention between information necessary for the task of driving and the information on signs. Because of this time-sharing, it will take longer to read a sign than if the motorists could devote all of their attention to the sign. Another important consideration is that motorists must read the entire message on a DMS. In contrast, they do not have to read the entire guide sign to obtain relevant information about guidance. Therefore, it takes a motorist longer to read a DMS message than to read the message on a guide sign. In a driving situation, the motorist has a limited amount of time to read a message on a sign. He/she can start reading a sign when the words become legible at the legibility distance of the sign. About 85 percent of motorists can begin reading a message on LED DMSs with 18-inch characters—commonly used in Texas—at about 650 feet in front of the sign. Research strongly suggests that motorists can read an 8-word message (excluding prepositions such as TO and AT) in 8 seconds, or one word/second. Based on the known legibility distance of DMSs, this translates to a maximum message length of 8 words while the motorist is traveling at 55 mph, 7 words at 65 mph, and 6 words at 70 mph. Longer messages should be avoided because motorists will often reduce their speeds in order to read the message.
AVOID MESSAGES LONGER THAN: • 8 words at 55 mph • 7 words at 65 mph • 6 words at 70 mph
DMS messages that are too long for motorists to read while traveling at normal speeds will result in some motorists slowing to read the message.
When the complexity of the driving situation increases due to extremes in geometrics, heavier traffic volumes, increased traffic conflicts (e.g., merging, lane changing), or climatological conditions, motorists will attend to those information needs they feel are most important to them and to their safety.
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-6
These demands on the motorist will result in less time available to read the DMS message. In addition, lighting and environmental conditions change. For example, during part of the day the sun may not affect the legibility of the DMS. However, if the sun shines directly in the eyes of the motorist, then the legibility distance for the motorist can be greatly reduced. It may be necessary to reduce the length of the message to account for the reduced visibility.
REDUCE MESSAGE LENGTH WHEN: • Motorist work load is increased due to extreme
geometrics, very heavy traffic, merging, heavy lane changing, or adverse climatological conditions.
• Conditions change during the day that affects motorist visibility to the DMS (e.g., sun in eyes).
The DMS message designer should always look for ways to reduce the message length without losing the intent of the message. Reducing message length can sometimes be accomplished by using alternative phrases that are understandable by motorists and have the same meaning as the original. Also, there may be redundancy or unimportant information in the message which can be omitted. For situations such as these, refer to Module 8 – DEALING WITH LONG MESSAGES.
Always look for ways to reduce message length without losing the intent of the message. See Module 8 - DEALING WITH LONG MESSAGES
MESSAGE LOAD AND UNIT OF INFORMATION The term load refers to the units of information in the total message. A unit of information (informational unit) refers to the answer to a question a motorist might ask. Stated another way, a unit of information is each data item in a message that a motorist could use to make a decision. Each answer is one unit of information. The message in the following table has four units of information and serves to illustrate the concept of units of information.
UNIT OF INFORMATION Question Answer Unit of Info 1. What happened? , ACCIDENT , 1 unit 2. Where? , PAST ROWLAND , 1 unit 3. Who is advisory for? , FAIR PARK , 1 unit 4. What is advised? , USE FITZHUGH , 1 unit
A unit of information typically is one to three words, but at times can be up to four words. Since motorists can process a limited amount of information, the amount of information that should be displayed on a DMS is also limited. Research and operational experience indicate that no more than four units of information should be in a message when the traffic operating speeds are 35 mph or more. No more than five units of information should be displayed when the operating speeds are less than 35 mph. In addition, no more than three units of information should be displayed on a one message phase.
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-7
Normally, only one unit of information appears on each line of the DMS. However, a unit of information may be displayed on more than one line. A sign line, however, should not contain more than two units of information.
ENTIRE MESSAGE: • No more than 4 units of information for
operating speeds of 35 mph or more.
When a DMS message meeting all informational requirements of the motorist exceeds the maximum number of units of information that should be displayed on a single sign, tradeoffs must be made to determine what elements of the messages should be omitted. If it is deemed necessary by the agency to display all of the required information, two DMSs will be needed. Guidelines to reduce the number of units of information are given in Section 8.2 – Approaches
• No more than 5 units of information for operating speeds less than 35 mph
LENGTH OF MESSAGE PHASE: • No more than 3 units of information. LENGTH OF MESSAGE LINE: • No more than 2 units of information.
to educing Message Length on page 8-5.
ESSAGE FORMAT
sily read and interpret the information and make rational decisions based on that formation.
river
stand essages. Examples of acceptable and unacceptable format approaches are shown below.
AT PATERSON
R M Message formatting refers to the order and arrangement of the units of information on a DMS. The DMS message must contain the proper information in the expected order to allow motorists to eain Placement of message elements on the wrong line or in the wrong sequence will result in dconfusion and will increase message reading times. Conversely, consistent formatting of information enhances motorist expectations and reduces the time required to read and underm
ROADWORK ON I-10 EAST
I-10 EAST AT PATERSON ROADWORK
Acceptable
Not Acceptable
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-8
4.4 BASE DMS MESSAGE TO SATISFY MOTORIST INFORMATION NEEDS
GENERAL CONCEPT OF BASE DMS MESSAGE The Base DMS Message is the sum total of all the information that motorists need on the DMS in order to make a fully informed driving decision (e.g., whether to take an alternative route). In most cases, the Base DMS Message will exceed the maximum amount of informational units that should be displayed on a DMS. Therefore, the Base DMS Message must be reduced in length and content to allow motorists to read, understand and react to the message.
THE BASE DMS MESSAGE: • Is the sum total of all the information that motorists need
to make a fully informed driving decision; • Will normally exceed the maximum amount of
informational units that should be displayed; and • Must normally be reduced in length and content.
The message elements that make up the Base DMS Message include: 1) Incident/ Roadwork Descriptor (situation description), 2) Incident/Roadwork Location, 3) Lanes Closed; 4) Closure Descriptor, 5) Closure Location, 6) Effect on Travel (e.g., major delay), 7) Audience for Action, 8) Action, and 9) Good Reason for Following the Action.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS: • Incident/Roadwork Descriptor (situation
description), • Incident/Roadwork Location, • Lanes Closed, • Closure Descriptor, • Closure Location, • Effect on Travel (e.g., major delay), • A action is for a udience for Action (when the
specific group of motorists), • Action (tells motorists what to do), and
INCIDENT/ROADWORK DESCRIPTOR The Incident/Roadwork Descriptor informs the motorist of the unusual situation. When an accident or roadwork blocks part of the roadway, motorists want advance warning.
• One Good Reason for Following Action (usually implied by other message elements).
INCIDENT/ROADWORK LOCATION The Incident/Roadwork Location informs the motorist about the location of the unusual situation and thus must directly follow the Incident/Roadwork Descriptor. Knowing the location helps the motorist to make judgments as to the distance he/she could be affected. In addition, it also provides basic information as to the location downstream where the motorist can return to the freeway. If the incident or roadwork is on the same freeway as the DMS, there is no need to display the freeway route number or name; this is understood by motorists. However, when displaying information about an incident that has occurred on an intersecting freeway the route number or name must be displayed.
WHEN INCIDENT/ROADWORK IS ON SAME FREEWAY AS THE DMS: • No need to display route number or name
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-9
When a majority of motorists are commuters, the incident/roadwork location should be referenced to the nearest cross street or exit ramp. Commuters are highly familiar with cross-street names and exit ramp names (or numbers). When there are no cross-streets or exit ramps in the vicinity of the incident, a prominent landmark (airport, factory, etc.) may be substituted. When a majority of motorists would be unfamiliar with the names of local cross-streets, the incident/roadwork location should be described in distances to the nearest half-mile. Where numbers are used for exit ramps, the incident location can be referenced to the exit ramp number.
FOR COMMUTERS: Reference location of problem to street names, exit
names, exit numbers, or landmarks. FOR UNFAMILIAR MOTORISTS: Reference location of problem by distance or exit
numbers.
ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
ACCIDENT AT EXIT 12
ACCIDENT 1 MILE
For familiar motorists
For familiar and unfamiliar motorists
For unfamiliar motorists
When a lane is closed, it is advisable to display the location where the lane closure begins and where it ends. This information is useful to the motorist in assessing where to return to the freeway if he/she decides to avoid the congestion. An example follows.
Displaying the location where a lane closure begins and where it ends helps motorists.
LEFT LANE CLOSED
FROM EXIT 12 TO EXIT 14
Showing limits of lane
closure The terms ST, RD and AVE are used with the names of streets, roads and avenues, respectively. These terms are not required and could be omitted. However, these terms must be used for streets and avenues with the same numeric names in the region (e.g., 7TH ST vs. 7TH AVE). An example follows.
ST, RD and AVE are not required and could be omitted. They must be used for streets and avenues with the same numeric names (e.g., 7TH ST, 7TH AVE).
ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
ACCIDENT
AT 7TH AVE
AVE not required
AVE required
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-10
LANES CLOSED The Lanes Closed message element gives specific information about which lanes or exit ramps are closed or blocked. It helps the motorist prepare to change into the open lanes or to prepare to use another exit ramp. CLOSURE DESCRIPTOR The Closure Descriptor message element is used in place of the Incident/Roadwork Descriptor when all lanes on the facility or exit ramp are closed. CLOSURE LOCATION The location of a freeway closure will be at an exit ramp that will normally be different than the actual incident location. The Closure Location message element specifically states the location where the freeway is closed and would be used in place of the Incident/Roadwork Location. EFFECT ON TRAVEL The Effect on Travel message element informs the motorist of the severity of the situation (i.e., delay or travel time) and helps the motorist make informed decisions about whether diversion is appropriate. In addition, it can imply the expected arrival time (in general terms) to the motorist’s destination. Delay Motorists interpret DELAY (shown in minutes) as being relative to their normal expected travel time to traverse the freeway and arrive at their destination. DELAY implies that it will take that much longer than usual. DELAY does not mean that the motorist will be held up in traffic at one location for that long or that it will take that long to remove an incident.
(number) MIN DELAY means that the motorist can expect his/her trip to be that much longer than usual.
AVOID (number) MIN DELAY gives the advantage of the
stated diversion route over the existing route. SAVE (number) MIN also gives the advantage of the
stated diversion route over the primary route.
Delay information can be displayed in terms of “X Minutes Delay,” “Avoid X Minutes Delay,” or “Save X Minutes.” If the delay is expressed in the first form, it refers to travel time on the primary route and should appear in the DMS message immediately after the Incident/Roadwork Descriptor and the Incident/Roadwork Location (if displayed). If delay is expressed in terms of “Avoid X Minutes Delay” or “Save X Minutes,” the reference is to an advantage of using the alternative route and should appear after the Action message element that mentions the alternative route. The following examples illustrate the different ways that delay information could be displayed.
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-11
ACCIDENT AT EXIT 12
ACCIDENT AT EXIT 12
ACCIDENT AT EXIT 12
20 MIN DELAY USE I-410
USE I-410
AVOID 20 MIN DELAY
USE I-410
SAVE 20 MIN
Example of “X MIN DELAY”
Example of
“AVOID X MIN DELAY”
Example of
“SAVE X MIN@� To be useful to the motorist, it is best to display specific delay times. However, when displaying a value (number) the DMS operator must have full confidence in the delay values selected. This is a number that motorists can sometimes check. Confidence in the DMS system can be adversely affected if the numbers are incorrect. As an alternative to displaying a specific delay value, it is safer to display generic information such as MAJOR DELAY or MINOR DELAY. Results of studies conducted implied that the average Texas motorist interprets MAJOR DELAY as meaning the delay is at least 45 minutes. HEAVY DELAY was interpreted to mean that the delay is at least 25 minutes. A majority of motorists understood MAJOR DELAY to be more severe than HEAVY DELAY.
THE GENERIC TERMS: MAJOR DELAY means to the average motorist in Texas
a delay of 45 minutes or more. HEAVY DELAY means to the average motorist in Texas
a delay of 25 to 45 minutes.
Sometimes the Effect on Travel element can be combined with the Incident/Roadwork Descriptor. In the case of delay, the message MAJOR ACCIDENT has specific meaning to motorists. Motorists in Texas would interpret MAJOR ACCIDENT to mean that they can expect delays of 45 minutes or more. Travel Time Another form of an Effect on Travel element is travel time. However, travel time should not be displayed as part of an incident or roadwork message because motorists prefer other types of information that is deemed more important to them. Travel time is very useful to motorists because it gives them some indication as to the potential arrival time to their destination. Also, travel times can be displayed during the off-peak periods and has the added advantage that a message will be displayed on the DMS more frequently rather than having a sign blank in the absence of an incident. When used, the posted travel times are calculated from speed measurements at two successive detector stations or are measured directly with automated vehicle identification equipment. Although the travel time information is historical in nature, it is fairly recent. Because of rapidly changing traffic conditions, it is difficult to post travel time information manually. It is more efficient to display travel times automatically using system software.
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-12
Although display of travel times is advantageous, the following possible credibility issues have created concerns for some TMC managers: • Display of historic travel times; and • Daily repetition of the same travel times displayed to commuters. First, current technology does not allow TMCs to accurately predict travel times, thus recent historical travel times are displayed. Motorists can easily measure their own travel times and dispute incorrectly posted travel times. If “10 minutes” is displayed on a CMS and it takes motorists 15 minutes, credibility may be weakened. To circumvent this concern, TransStar in Houston displayed the time of day of the most recent calculation of travel times in the format below.
TRAVEL TIME TO I-610
20 MIN AT 8:20 An approach used by TransGuide in San Antonio is to display a range of the estimated travel time. The DMS operator gives motorists the important information they need about potential arrival times while maintaining motorist credibility and support of the DMS system. An example of a message showing a range of travel time is shown below.
Travel time RANGE is a good alternative.
TRAVEL TIME
TO DOWNTOWN 8-12 MINS
The results of studies conducted in 2000 for TxDOT indicated that displaying recent historical travel times may not be a credibility issue provided that the differences in expected and actual travel times are not significantly different. The second concern with displaying travel time on a regular basis is the possibility that commuter drivers may see the same travel times posted daily if traffic conditions do not change from day to day, may begin to ignore the CMS at later dates, and thus may not read the sign when important incident information is presented. To date, no research has been conducted to validate or disprove this concern.
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-13
AUDIENCE FOR ACTION The Audience for Action message element is used when the Action message element applies to a specific group of motorists rather than all of the motorists traveling past the DMS. It alerts a specific group of motorists that the action part of the message applies to them. When the Audience for Action applies to all motorists on the highway at the location of the DMS, then the statement is not displayed. When the Action applies to only a segment of the motorists, then the Audience for Action message element should be used to avoid confusion as to whom the Action applies.
WHEN THE ACTION APPLIES TO: • ALL MOTORISTS – Audience for Action message
element is NOT used. • A SEGMENT OF MOTORISTS – Audience for
Action message element is used.
Motorists expect when they see an Audience for Action message element on the DMS, they will also see an Action message element. An Audience for Action message element must always be accompanied with an Action statement.
An Audience for Action message element must always be accompanied by an Action message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT
PAST ROWLAND
(Problem) (Location)
USE OTHER ROUTES
(Action)
Message Phase 1 Message Phase 2
Action message element applies to all drivers passing CMS
MAJOR ACCIDENT PAST ROWLAND
(Problem) (Location)
GALVESTON USE I-610
(Audience) (Action)
Message Phase 1 Message Phase 2
Action message element applies to a specific group of drivers (Philadelphia traffic) Generally, the word TRAFFIC after a destination is not necessary. The reader of a sign can only be a motorist who is a part of the traffic stream, so FAIR PARK, TAKE NEXT EXIT can only mean FAIR PARK TRAFFIC, TAKE NEXT EXIT.
Generally, the word TRAFFIC after a destination name is not necessary.
The primary exception to this message design principle is when the location of the incident--either in terms of the cross street, miles ahead, or simply AHEAD--is not displayed, it is frequently necessary to display TRAFFIC after the destination. The following examples are presented:
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-14
ACCIDENT PAST I-30
FAIR PARK USE FITZHUGH
ACCIDENT
FAIR PARK TRAFFIC USE FITZHUGH
“TRAFFIC” not required
“TRAFFIC” required
If TRAFFIC were omitted from the second message, motorists could interpret the message to mean that an accident occurred near Fair Park. City destinations appearing on a DMS must be consistent with existing signing practices. Nicknames should be avoided. For example, SAN ANTONIO should be used rather than the term ALAMO CITY.
Names used for cities must be identical to those appearing on existing static signs.
Many cities have large areas known locally by a single name, but which house smaller areas of wider general knowledge. Caution should be used when signing for these areas so that the name displayed is consistent with the name used by motorists. If the audience includes non-local, unfamiliar motorists, the more general, lesser known destination would be confusing if the activity was being held at a specific, more widely known destination.
Names used for major generators must be specific and address the exact place where the activity takes place.
ACTION The Action message element is necessary because it tells the motorist what to do. It is best that every incident management DMS message have an action statement. Omitting the Action leaves the motorist with a great deal of uncertainty as to the best course of action. GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTION When a motorist is advised to take an alternative route, he/she must be confident that it is the correct decision and that doing so will result in significant savings in time. Therefore, the motorist should be given a Good Reason for Following the Action. In most cases, the good reason is implied through the Incident or Roadwork Descriptor, Lanes Affected, and Effect on Travel elements of the message and need not be displayed separately. However, in other situations, a specific Good Reason for Following the Action message element is needed.
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-15
4.5 WORD AND PHRASE MEANINGS AND CRITERIA SELECTING FROM ALTERNATIVE WORDS AND PHRASES Use, Take and Follow The Action message element requires an action verb. In general, the three verbs USE, TAKE and FOLLOW are synonymous and no strong preference has been found. The verb USE has been employed more often because it is slightly shorter. There are, however, small differences in meaning which make one verb preferable to another when used in a particular DMS message. The verb USE should be selected whenever the advisory in the DMS message is to employ a route that will carry the motorist to his/her destination. The destination could be a major generator or a point of return to the freeway.
USE: A route that will carry motorists to the destination. TAKE: Directive to begin the first “leg” of route. FOLLOW: Motorist will be guided by other signs along the
route. EXIT: Sometimes used as a verb. GO: Not used.
The verb TAKE should be selected whenever the advisory is a directive to begin taking the first highway or “leg” of a route. The verb FOLLOW carries the additional connotation that the motorist will be guided by other signs along the route. FOLLOW should never be used when guidance is not available. The verb EXIT may also be used as a verb in action message statements that are displayed on a freeway. When EXIT is employed as a verb, it should usually be followed by the name of the cross-street or highway associated with the exit ramp. The verb GO is not used in DMS messages for route guidance, but may be used in highway advisory radio messages. It connotes initiation of action, but would be out of place in situations where USE or TAKE is appropriate.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT EXIT 12 USE I-410
BEST ROUTE
TO GALVESTON TAKE NEXT EXIT
Example of “USE”
Example of “TAKE”
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
EXIT AT BASEL FOLLOW DETOUR
Phase 1 Phase 2
Example of “FOLLOW”
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-16
Construction vs. Roadwork Although the relative interpretations of the words CONSTRUCTION and ROADWORK were not studied in Texas, results from studies in New Jersey indicated that ROADWORK can be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION. Human factors studies in New Jersey indicated that 59 percent of the motorists surveyed interpreted the words CONSTRUCTION and ROADWORK to have the same meaning. The other 41 percent stated that the meanings differ. To these 41 percent, CONSTRUCTION implied larger-scale, longer-term work such as building bridges. There are two disadvantages to displaying the word CONSTRUCTION. First, it is a longer and more complex word than ROADWORK and, therefore, will take longer for motorists to read. Second, the word CONSTRUCTION will not fit on an eight-character line of a portable sign and, therefore, must either be abbreviated with CONST or replaced with the word ROADWORK.
ROADWORK may be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION.
Results of human factors studies showed that approximately 85 percent of the motorists surveyed in six major cities in Texas understood the abbreviation CONST to mean CONSTRUCTION. Exit vs. Ramp When referring to an off ramp on DMSs located on a freeway, the word EXIT should be used. The word RAMP should not be used because it has different meanings among motorists. Results of human factors studies indicated that 41 percent of the Texas motorists surveyed believed that the two terms have different meanings. Interpretations included: 1) the term EXIT is for when the motorist gets off the freeway, and RAMP is for when the motorist gets on; and 2) the term EXIT means a motorist can leave the freeway, and RAMP means the motorist will go to a freeway-to-freeway connector. A Dash vs. Thru The dash may be substituted for the term THRU to indicate a set of inclusive days (e.g., TUE – THURS to indicate Tuesday thru Thursday). Eighty-five percent of the motorists surveyed in Texas correctly stated the days of the week when the dash was used; 92 percent of the motorists surveyed in New Jersey correctly stated the days of the week. Nite vs. Night The term NITE may be used in place of NIGHT. Although the term was not specifically studied in Texas, results of human factors studies conducted in New Jersey showed most motorists in that state understand the term NITE as a substitute for NIGHT. For 1 Week Frequently roadwork is performed over a 1-week period (i.e., 7 consecutive days). Although the term FOR 1 WEEK takes less DMS space, it should not be used to indicate the 7-day work
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-17
period. The results of human factor studies in Texas revealed that the term FOR 1 WEEK was ambiguous as to whether the roadwork begins the date the message was viewed, the next day, or from the beginning of the current or next week. Weekend Oftentimes, major lane or roadway closures are necessary on the weekend. Although it is desirable to present the inclusive days and hours (e.g., FRI 6 PM – MON 5 AM), the portable DMS is limited to eight characters per line. If a term such as NEXT WEEKEND can be used rather than days and hours, then the message can be made much shorter in length. The message term WEEKEND should be used only if the work is to start on Saturday morning and end by Sunday evening at midnight. The term should not be used in Texas if either the roadwork begins on Friday evening or ends on Monday morning. The results of human factors studies in Texas indicated that 62 percent of the motorists would believe the work would begin on Saturday morning and 69 percent would believe the work would end on Sunday evening. WORDS AND TERMS WITH LOW MOTORIST UNDERSTANDING The recommendations that follow are based on results of human factors studies conducted in Texas and New Jersey. Calendar Dates It is desirable to notify motorists of upcoming roadwork or of a special event that will impact traffic. In the past, calendar dates have been used (e.g., OCT 10 – OCT 12) to indicate when the roadwork or special event activity begins and/or ends. However, results of human factors studies showed that Texas motorists have difficulty in corresponding calendar dates with specific days of the week. Therefore, use days of the week (e.g., TUE – THUR) rather than calendar dates (OCT 10 – OCT 12). The use of days of the week is preferred over calendar dates. Results of human factors studies showed that 85 and 93 percent gave the correct days of the week when Message 1 was shown. In contrast, only 21 percent and 11 percent of the drivers surveyed in Texas and New Jersey were able to give correct days of the week when calendar dates were displayed even though the days were during the next week (see Message 2).
ROAD CLOSED TUES - THUR
ROAD CLOSED [OCT 10 - OCT 12]
Message 1 Acceptable Message 2
Unacceptable
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-18
Lane Shift, Traffic Shifts, Lanes Change and New Traffic Pattern There are several terms that have sometimes been used in work zones to indicate a temporary alignment change (i.e., all lanes shift left or right). The following terms should not be used: • LANES SHIFT; • TRAFFIC SHIFTS; • LANES CHANGE; and • NEW TRAFFIC PATTERN. Instead, the following term should be used: • LANES SHIFT/STAY IN LANE. The recommendation is based on human factors studies conducted in New Jersey. The results of New Jersey studies revealed that a large majority of the motorists surveyed believed that they would have to merge with traffic in another lane when the terms LANE SHIFT (53 percent), TRAFFIC SHIFTS (52 percent), LANE CHANGES (73 percent), or NEW TRAFFIC PATTERN (42 percent) was displayed. Therefore, these terms would encourage undesirable lane changing. Most of the motorists surveyed (81 percent) understood that they would not have to merge to another lane when the term LANES SHIFT/STAY IN LANE was used.
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-19
4.6 DIVERSION/DETOUR ROUTE DESCRIPTIONS FOR INCIDENT AND ROADWORK SITUATIONS
INTRODUCTION The Action message element that involves traffic diversion is influenced by the type of diversion route that will be used by motorists to travel around the incident. Six diversion route types have been identified for use in this Manual—Types 1 through 6. Based on current practice, only Types 2, 5, and 6 apply to Texas. Type 2 is a diversion route to another freeway, Type 5 is a diversion route documented in an Incident Emergency Route Plan, and Type 6 is a detour route used in a Traffic Control Plan for a roadway closure during construction or maintenance operations. Although only three diversion route types apply to Texas, all six are described in the following Section of the Manual for information purposes. DIVERSION/DETOUR ROUTE TYPES Type 1 Diversion Route Type 1 is the simplest form of diversion route. The diversion route has a major road (e.g., frontage road, arterial, etc.) that is basically parallel and close to the primary freeway and offers opportunities for motorists to either turn toward the freeway and reenter downstream of the incident; or head directly to the major destination. Some form of surveillance (electronic or human) exists on the diversion route and sends information about traffic conditions to the traffic management center (TMC). Therefore, the DMS operator has knowledge of the traffic conditions on both the primary freeway and the diversion route. Guide signs and/or trailblazers to the freeway or major destination may not be present. However, commuters most likely know the crossroads that will allow them to drive back to the freeway once they pass the incident or know the route to the major destination. Police and/or traffic control personnel are not guiding traffic along the diversion route. The Type 1 diversion route is generally applicable when: • Lanes are blocked due to an incident; • Lanes are closed due to an incident; • Freeway is totally blocked due to an incident; • Freeway is closed due to an incident; • Lanes are closed due to roadwork; or • Freeway is closed due to roadwork.
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-20
Type 2 Diversion Route The Type 2 diversion route has one or more primary major roads (e.g., other freeways, arterials, etc.) that offer opportunities for motorists to either 1) exit the primary freeway and reenter downstream of the incident, or 2) head directly to the major destination. Some form of surveillance (electronic or human) exists on the diversion route and sends information about traffic conditions to the TMC. Therefore, the DMS operator has knowledge of the traffic conditions on both the primary freeway and the diversion route. Existing static guide signs and/or trailblazers to the primary freeway or to the major destination are present. Police and/or traffic control personnel are not guiding traffic along the diversion route. The Type 2 diversion route is generally applicable when: • Lanes are blocked due to an incident; • Lanes are closed due to an incident; • Freeway is totally blocked due to an incident; • Freeway is closed due to an incident; • Lanes are closed due to roadwork; or • Freeway is closed due to roadwork. Type 3 Diversion Route The Type 3 diversion route has one or more primary major roads (e.g., arterials, other freeways, etc.) that offer opportunities for motorists to either turn toward the freeway and reenter downstream of the incident or head directly to the major destination. Some form of surveillance (electronic or human) exists on the diversion route and sends information about traffic conditions to the TMC. Therefore, the DMS operator has knowledge of the traffic conditions on both the primary freeway and the diversion route. Static guide signs and/or trailblazers to the freeway or to the major destination are not present. Police and/or traffic control personnel are guiding traffic along the diversion route. The Type 3 diversion route is generally applicable when • Freeway is closed due to an incident. Type 4 Diversion Route The Type 4 diversion route has one or more primary major roads (e.g., arterials, other freeways, etc.) that offer opportunities for motorists to either turn toward the freeway and reenter downstream of the incident or head directly to the major destination. Some form of surveillance (electronic or human) exists on the diversion route and sends information about traffic conditions to the TMC. Therefore, the DMS operator has knowledge of the traffic conditions on both the primary freeway and the diversion route.
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-21
Existing static guide signs and/or trailblazers to the freeway or to the major destination are present. In addition, police and/or traffic control personnel are guiding traffic along the diversion route. The Type 4 diversion route is generally applicable when: • Freeway is closed due to an incident. Type 5 Diversion Route: Incident Emergency Route Plan The Type 5 diversion route has one or more primary major roads (e.g., arterials, other freeways, etc.) that offer opportunities for motorists to either turn toward the freeway and reenter downstream of the incident; or head directly to the major destination. Existing static guide signs and/or trailblazers to the freeway or to the major destination may not be present. Diversion/detour signs are installed after the incident occurs. In addition, police and/or traffic control personnel are guiding traffic along the diversion route. The Type 5 Diversion Route is applicable when: • Freeway is closed due to an incident. Type 6 Detour Route: Traffic Control Plan for Roadwork Closure The Type 6 detour route is a route that has been established and contains the full complement of traffic control devices specified in the traffic control plan for the major roadwork project. The Type 6 detour route is applicable when: • Freeway is closed due to roadwork. Summary of Diversion/Detour Route Types A summary of the characteristics for diversion/detour route types is shown in Table 4.1. The applicable incident or roadwork situation for the various diversion/detour route types based on the location of the DMS relative to the incident/roadwork location is given in Table 4.2.
MO
DU
LE 4 Principles of DM
S Message D
esign
Page 4-22
Table 4.1 Characteristics of Diversion/Detour Routes
Diversion/Detour Route Characteristics Type 1 Type 2 Type 3 Type 4 Type 5 Type 6
Electronic and/or human surveillance are required on diversion route X X X X Existing guide signs and/or trailblazers to freeway or destination on diversion route X X Police and/or traffic control personnel at critical decision points on diversion route X X X Incident Emergency Route Plan signing X Roadwork Traffic Control Plan traffic control devices X
Table 4.2 Incident/Roadwork Situation, DMS Location and Diversion/Detour Route Type Diversion/Detour Route Incident/Roadwork DMS Location
Type 1 Type 2 Type 3 Type 4 Type 5 Type 6 Incident Lane Blockage Same freeway & near incident
Same freeway & far upstream of incident Different freeway
X X X
X X X
Incident Lane Closure Same freeway & near incident Same freeway & far upstream of incident Different freeway
X X X
X X X
Incident Total Freeway Blockage Same freeway & near incident Same freeway & far upstream of incident Different freeway
X X X
X X X
Incident Total Freeway Closure Same freeway & near incident Same freeway & far upstream of incident Different freeway
X X X
X X X
X X
X X
X X
Roadwork Lane Closure Same freeway & near incident Same freeway & far upstream of incident Different freeway
X X X
X X X
Roadwork Total Freeway Closure Same freeway & near incident Same freeway & far upstream of incident Different freeway
X
X
X X
Connector Ramp Closure: Incident on Intersecting Freeway Upstream of connector ramp X X X
Connector Ramp Closure: Roadwork on Intersecting Freeway Upstream of connector ramp X X X
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-23
4.7 DYNAMIC FEATURES ON DMSs INTRODUCTION DMSs are capable of using dynamic features to display messages. Results of research indicate that the use of the following dynamic features should be avoided:
AVOID: • Flashing an entire one-phase message, • Flashing one line of a one-phase message, and • Alternating text on one line of a three-line DMS while
keeping the other two lines of text the same. • Flashing an entire one-phase message;
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED flashing
• Flashing one line of a one-phase message;
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED • Alternating text on one line of a three-line DMS while keeping the other two lines of text the
same.
ACCIDENT
flashing
ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND AT ROWLAND
TUNE TO 530 AM LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED
alternating
FLASHING AN ENTIRE ONE-PHASE MESSAGE Results of research conducted in Texas for TxDOT indicate that flashing a one-phase 3-unit message on a DMS has no significant effect upon motorist comprehension of the information being presented. Furthermore, driver preferences are fairly evenly split between flashing the message or not (i.e., a static message). However, the data show that flashing the message increases the amount of time required to read and comprehend the message. In this particular study, the fact that the message contained only 3 units of information allowed most subjects to correctly comprehend the message. However, this would not be expected to be the case if more information were presented. Given that there does not appear to be strong driver preference for flashing one-phase messages and that such a practice does increase reading times, it is recommended that flashing messages not be used as part of DMS operations. However, if personnel in a TMC choose to use flashing one-phase messages, it is strongly recommended that the message themselves be limited to 3 units of information or less to account for the increased reading and comprehension times.
Revised July 2006
MODULE 4 Principles of DMS Message Design Page 4-24
FLASHING ONE LINE OF A ONE-PHASE MESSAGE Results of research conducted in Texas for TxDOT indicate that flashing one line of a one-phase, 3-unit message on a DMS does reduce the ability of motorists to remember parts of the message that are not flashing. The data further indicate that reading times are significantly increased when a line is flashed. Driver preferences are fairly evenly split between flashing the message line or not (i.e., a static message). In this particular study, the fact that the message contained only 3 units of information allowed most subject drivers to correctly comprehend the message. However, this would not be expected to be the case if more information were presented. Given that there does not appear to be strong driver preference for flashing one line of a one-phase message and that such a practice reduces overall motorist comprehension and increases reading time, it is recommend that this technique not be used as part of DMS operations. ALTERNATING TEXT ON ONE LINE OF A THREE-LINE DMS WHILE KEEPING THE OTHER TWO LINES OF TEXT THE SAME Results of research conducted in Texas for TxDOT indicate that on three-line DMSs including redundant information by repeating the top two lines on both phases of a two-phase message while changing the bottom line does not reduce the ability of motorists to remember parts of the message. However, total message reading times are significantly increased when the sign message includes redundant information. Driver preferences are fairly evenly split between having and not having redundant information in both phases. Given these findings, it is recommended that redundant information on a two-phase, four-unit DMS message should not be displayed such that two lines are kept the same and a third line is changed.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-i
MODULE 5. DESIGNING THE BASE DMS MESSAGE
FOR INCIDENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
5.1 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR LANE-CLOSURE
(BLOCKAGE) INCIDENTS ............................................................................ 5-1
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS ............................................................................ 5-1
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT...... 5-2
Incident Descriptor .................................................................................................... 5-2
Incident Location ....................................................................................................... 5-3
Lanes Closed.............................................................................................................. 5-4
Effect on Travel ......................................................................................................... 5-5
Action......................................................................................................................... 5-6
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message .............................................................................................. 5-6
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ............................................ 5-7
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ...... 5-8
Audience for Action................................................................................................... 5-9
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 5-10
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE INCIDENT ... 5-11
Incident Descriptor .................................................................................................. 5-11
Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-12
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-13
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-14
Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-15
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-15
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) .......................................... 5-16
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-17
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-18
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 5-19
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE INCIDENT..................................... 5-20
Incident Descriptor .................................................................................................. 5-21
Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-22
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-23
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-24
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-ii
Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-25
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-25
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) .......................................... 5-26
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-27
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-28
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 5-29
5.2 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE
CLOSING THE FREEWAY.......................................................................... 5-30
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS .......................................................................... 5-30
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE .... 5-31
Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-32
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-33
Closure Location...................................................................................................... 5-34
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-35
Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-36
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 5-36
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-37
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route ................... 5-38
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-39
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 5-40
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE.... 5-41
Incident Descriptor .................................................................................................. 5-41
Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-42
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-43
Closure Location...................................................................................................... 5-44
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-45
Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-46
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-46
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 5-47
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-48
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route ................... 5-49
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-50
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 5-51
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE CLOSURE ..................................... 5-52
Incident Descriptor .................................................................................................. 5-53
Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-54
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-iii
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-55
Closure Location...................................................................................................... 5-56
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 5-57
Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-58
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-58
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 5-59
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-60
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-61
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 5-62
5.3 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS ON AN
INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT REQUIRE CLOSING
THE CONNECTOR RAMP ........................................................................... 5-63
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS .......................................................................... 5-63
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE................................. 5-64
Incident Descriptor .................................................................................................. 5-64
Incident Location ..................................................................................................... 5-65
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 5-66
Ramp Closure Descriptor......................................................................................... 5-67
Action ...................................................................................................................... 5-68
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 5-68
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 5-69
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .... 5-70
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route ................... 5-71
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 5-72
Good Reason for Following Action......................................................................... 5-73
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-1
MODULE 5. DESIGNING THE BASE DMS MESSAGE
FOR INCIDENTS
5.1 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR LANE-CLOSURE (BLOCKAGE)
INCIDENTS
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
The Base DMS Message for lane-closure
incidents includes the following elements: 1)
Incident Descriptor (situation description),
2) Incident Location, 3) Lanes Closed, 4)
Effect on Travel (e.g., major delay), 5)
Audience for Action, 6) Action, and 7) GoodReason for Following the Action.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
! Incident Descriptor (situation description),
! Incident Location,
! Lanes Closed,
! Effect on Travel (e.g., major delay),
! Audience for Action (when the action is for a specific
group of motorists),
! Action (tells motorists what to do), and
! Good Reason for Following the Action statement
(usually implied by other message elements).
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-2
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT
Incident Descriptor
Warnings of hazardous incidents should be displayed under all traffic conditions in peak or
off-peak periods. Minor off-the-roadway incidents such as grass cutting, stalled vehicles on the
shoulder, etc. should not be displayed.
Terms for the Incident Descriptor message element are shown in Table 5.1
A general message phrase, such as ACCIDENT, is preferred and reduces the need for a large
library of messages for every conceivable incident. Also, credibility is weakened when overly
precise messages are not verified. For example, the terms MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCKACCIDENT is preferred to more exact descriptions such as VEHICLE OVERTURNED. Some
motorists will voluntarily divert in response to either of the terms.
The message phrase MAJOR ACCIDENTimplies to motorists a more serious accident that
may block more than one lane and will result in
extensive delay. To the average Texas motorist,
it implies a delay of more than 45 minutes.
Table 5.1 INCIDENT DESCRIPTORSDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
ACCIDENT ACCIDENT
ACCIDENT AHEAD ACCIDENT | AHEAD
MAJOR ACCIDENT MAJOR | ACCIDENT
MINOR ACCIDENT MINOR | ACCIDENT
TRUCK ACCIDENT TRUCK | ACCIDENT
STALLED VEHICLE STALLED | VEHICLE
VEHICLE FIRE VEHICLE | FIRE
FUEL SPILL FUEL | SPILL
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MAJOR ACCIDENT means delays of 45 minutes or
more to the average Texas motorist.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-3
Incident Location
General principles for the message element Incident Location can be found beginning on page 4-
8.
Terms for the Incident Location message element are shown in Table 5.2.
Table 5.2 TERMS FOR INCIDENT LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
1 MILE (AHEAD) 1 MILE (AHEAD)[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
BEFORE [highway, street name] BEFORE | [highway, street name]BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
PAST [highway, street name] PAST | [highway, street name]PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
ON LEFT SHOULDER ON LEFT | SHOULDER
ON RIGHT SHOULDER ON RIGHT | SHOULDER
ON MAIN LANES ON | MAIN LNS
OVER [highway, street name] OVER | [highway, street name]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-4
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
When the DMS is located on the same freeway as the incident and relatively close to and
upstream of the incident, the DMS message can encourage motorists to leave the closed lane(s)
and move into the open lanes by informing them which specific lanes are closed. This helps the
movement of vehicles through the restricted area.
Terms for the Lanes Closed message element for these cases are shown in Table 5.3.
Table 5.3 TERMS FOR LANES CLOSED DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
CENTER LANE CLOSED CENTER | LANE | CLOSED
CENTER LANES CLOSED CENTER | LANES | CLOSED
CENTER [number] LANES CLOSED CENTER | [number] LANES | CLOSED
LEFT LANE CLOSED LEFT | LANE | CLOSED
LEFT [number] LANES CLOSED LEFT | [number] LANES | CLOSED
RIGHT LANE CLOSED RIGHT | LANE | CLOSED
RIGHT [number] LANES CLOSED RIGHT | [number] LANES | CLOSED
FREEWAY CLOSED FREEWAY | CLOSED
EXIT TO [highway, street name] CLOSED EXIT TO | [highway, street name] | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-5
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page
4-10.
Terms for the Effect on Travel message element when lane-blocking incidents occur are shown
in Table 5.4.
Table 5.4 TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXPECT DELAY EXPECT | DELAY
EXPECT MAJOR DELAY EXPECT | MAJOR | DELAY
EXPECT MINOR DELAY EXPECT | MINOR | DELAY
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-6
Action
General principles for the message element Action statements can be found beginning on
page 4-14.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as “soft” diversion), or
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route
(Type 1, Type 3, Type 4, Type 5 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to
take a specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion
messages are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, motorists should not be encouraged to divert to another route because it would
result in greater travel time than if the motorists were to remain on the primary freeway.
However, it is still important to tell motorists what they need to do.
Terms for the Action message element when lane-blocking incidents occur under this situation
are shown in Table 5.5.
Table 5.5 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | REPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-7
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed for a variety of reasons
including:
! There are no suitable alternative routes that can be recommended because traffic conditions
on the most logical routes would not result in travel time savings to motorists if they diverted
from the primary freeway;
! The DMS operator is unaware of the traffic conditions on the most logical alternative routes
because surveillance does not exist on these routes,
! It is important to display an Action before the DMS operator has had a chance to assess the
full impact of the incident, and/or
! It is important to display an Action before the police have arrived and establish positive
diversion routes.
Terms for the Action message element when lane-blocking incidents occur under this situation
are shown in Table 5.6.
Table 5.6 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-8
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative freeway route
and has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic
control personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table 5-
7.
Table 5.7 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-9
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on page
4-13.
Terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 5.8.
Table 5.8 TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] TRAFFIC [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TRAFFIC
[route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-10
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for displaying to motorists the message element Good Reason for Following the Action are given on page 4-14.
When MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT are displayed, the reason for following the
suggested action is implied and there is no need to display the reason. However, when the incident
descriptors ACCIDENT or MINOR ACCIDENT are displayed, then a reason should displayed. Also,
when it is important to convince motorists to use an alternative route, it is oftentimes advantageous
to display BEST ROUTE TO [destination].
The terms shown in Table 5.9 are acceptable to display.
Table 5.9 TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-11
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE INCIDENT
Incident Descriptor
Warnings of hazardous incidents should be displayed under all traffic conditions in peak or off-
peak periods. Minor off-the-roadway incidents such as grass cutting, stalled vehicles on the
shoulder, etc., should not be displayed.
Terms for the Incident Descriptor message element are shown in Table 5.10.
A general message phrase, such as ACCIDENT, is preferred and reduces the need for a large library
of messages for every conceivable incident. Also, credibility is weakened when overly precise
messages are not verified. For example, the terms MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT is
preferred to more exact descriptions such as VEHICLE OVERTURNED. Some motorists will
voluntarily divert in response to either of the terms.
The message phrase MAJOR ACCIDENT implies
to motorists a more serious accident that may
block more than one lane and will result in
extensive delay. To the average Texas motorist, it
implies a delay of more than 45 minutes.
Table 5.10 INCIDENT DESCRIPTORSDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
ACCIDENT ACCIDENT
ACCIDENT AHEAD ACCIDENT | AHEAD
MAJOR ACCIDENT MAJOR | ACCIDENT
MINOR ACCIDENT MINOR | ACCIDENT
TRUCK ACCIDENT TRUCK | ACCIDENT
STALLED VEHICLE STALLED | VEHICLE
VEHICLE FIRE VEHICLE | FIRE
FUEL SPILL FUEL | SPILL
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MAJOR ACCIDENT means delays of 45 minutes or
more to the average Texas motorist.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-12
Incident Location
General principles for the message element Incident Location can be found beginning on page 4-
8.
Terms for the Incident Location message element are shown in Table 5.11.
Table 5.11 TERMS FOR INCIDENT LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
1 MILE (AHEAD) 1 MILE (AHEAD)[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
BEFORE [highway, street name] BEFORE | [highway, street name]BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
PAST [highway, street name] PAST | [highway, street name]PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
ON LEFT SHOULDER ON LEFT | SHOULDER
ON RIGHT SHOULDER ON RIGHT | SHOULDER
ON MAIN LANES ON | MAIN LNS
OVER [highway, street name] OVER | [highway, street name]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-13
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
Situations arise when the DMS is on the same freeway and upstream of the incident but at a location
far enough upstream of the incident where it is not advisable to encourage lane changing. It is best
to move traffic in all the lanes. Therefore, there is no traffic flow advantage to inform motorists the
specific lanes that are closed. However, it is important to notify motorists the number of lanes
closed so that they can make earlier decisions about whether to take alternative routes.
Terms for Lanes Closed message element for these cases are shown in Table 5.12.
Table 5.12 TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
1 LANE CLOSED 1 LANE | CLOSED
[number] LANES CLOSED [number] LANES | CLOSED
1 LANE OPEN 1 LANE | OPEN
[number] LANES OPEN [number] LANES | OPEN
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-14
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
Terms for the Effect on Travel message element when lane-blocking incidents occur are shown in
Table 5.13.
Table 5.13 TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXPECT DELAY EXPECT | DELAY
EXPECT MAJOR DELAY EXPECT | MAJOR | DELAY
EXPECT MINOR DELAY EXPECT | MINOR | DELAY
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-15
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-14.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as Asoft” diversion), or
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route
(Type 1, Type 3, Type 4, Type 5 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to take a
specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion messages
are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, motorists should not be encouraged to divert to another route because it would
result in greater travel time than if the motorists were to remain on the primary freeway. However, it
is still important to tell motorists what they need to do.
Terms for the Action message element when lane-blocking incidents occur under this situation are
shown in Table 5.14.
Table 5.14 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | REPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-16
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed for a variety of reasons
including:
! There are no suitable alternative routes that can be recommended because traffic conditions
on the most logical routes would not result in travel time savings to motorists if they diverted
from the primary freeway,
! The DMS operator is unaware of the traffic conditions on the most logical alternative routes
because surveillance does not exist on these routes,
! It is important to display an Action before the DMS operator has had a chance to assess the
full impact of the incident, and/or
! It is important to display an Action before the police have arrived and establish positive
diversion routes.
Terms for the Action message element when lane-blocking incidents occur under this situation are
shown in Table 5.15.
Table 5.15 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-17
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative freeway route and
has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic control
personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table 5-
16.
Table 5.16 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-18
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on page
4-13.
Terms for Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 5.17.
Table 5.17 TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] TRAFFIC [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TRAFFIC
[route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-19
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Actionare given on page 4-14.
When MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT are displayed, the reason for following the
suggested action is implied, and there is no need to display the reason. However, when the incident
descriptors ACCIDENT or MINOR ACCIDENT are displayed, then a reason needs to be displayed.
Also, when it is important to convince motorists to use an alternative route, it is oftentimes
advantageous to display BEST ROUTE TO [destination].
The terms shown in Table 5.18 are acceptable to display.
Table 5.18 TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-20
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE INCIDENT
The DMS operational guidelines in this section of the Manual apply when the DMS is on a
different freeway than the incident, but the incident still can have an affect on motorists who are
passing the DMS. For example, westbound I-10 motorists who intend to exit the freeway and enter
northbound I-45 to travel toward Dallas could be affected by incidents that occur on northbound I-45
north of the I-10/I-45 interchange. Messages displayed on DMSs on westbound I-10 concerning
incidents on northbound I-45 can be helpful to those motorists heading toward Dallas.
The major difference between the messages displayed on DMSs located on a different freeway than
the incident in comparison to the messages on DMSs located on the same freeway as the incident but
far upstream of the incident is in the diversion information provided.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-21
Incident Descriptor
Warnings of hazardous incidents should be displayed under all traffic conditions in peak or off-
peak periods. Minor off-the-roadway incidents such as grass cutting, stalled vehicles on the
shoulder, etc. should not be displayed.
Terms for the Incident Descriptor message element are shown in Table 5.19
A general message phrase, such as ACCIDENT, is preferred and reduces the need for a large library
of messages for every conceivable incident. Also, credibility is weakened when overly precise
messages are not verified. For example, the terms MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT is
preferred to more exact descriptions such as VEHICLE OVERTURNED. Some motorists will
voluntarily divert in response to either of the terms.
The message phrase MAJOR ACCIDENT implies
to motorists a more serious accident that may
block more than one lane and will result in
extensive delay. To the average Texas motorist, it
implies a delay of more than 45 minutes.
Table 5.19 INCIDENT DESCRIPTORSDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
ACCIDENT ACCIDENT
MAJOR ACCIDENT MAJOR | ACCIDENT
MINOR ACCIDENT MINOR | ACCIDENT
TRUCK ACCIDENT TRUCK | ACCIDENT
STALLED VEHICLE STALLED VEHICLE
VEHICLE FIRE VEHICLE FIRE
FUEL SPILL FUEL SPILL
A|@ Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MAJOR ACCIDENT means delays of 45 minutes or
more to the average Texas motorist.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-22
Incident Location
General principles for the message element Incident Location can be found beginning on page 4-
8.
Terms for the Incident Location message element are shown in Table 5.20.
Table 5.20 TERMS FOR INCIDENT LOCATIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
AT [highway, street name]* AT | [highway, street name]*
AT [exit ramp name] EXIT* AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
BEFORE [highway, street name]* BEFORE | [highway, street name]*
BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT* BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
PAST [highway, street name]* PAST | [highway, street name]*
PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT* PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
OVER [highway, street name]* OVER | [highway, street name]*
* Insert “ON [route number, highway name or street name][cardinal direction]” in front of the
Incident Location.
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-23
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
When the incident occurs downstream of the DMS but on a different highway, it is not necessary to
inform motorists the specific lanes that are closed. What is important to the motorist is knowledge
of the number of lanes that are closed.
Terms for the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 5.21.
Table 5.21 TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
1 LANE CLOSED 1 LANE | CLOSED
[number] LANES CLOSED [number] LANES | CLOSED
1 LANE OPEN 1 LANE | OPEN
[number] LANES OPEN [number] LANES | OPEN
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-24
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
Terms for the Effect on Travel message element when lane-blocking incidents occur are shown in
Table 5.22.
Table 5.22 TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXPECT DELAY EXPECT | DELAY
EXPECT MAJOR DELAY EXPECT | MAJOR | DELAY
EXPECT MINOR DELAY EXPECT | MINOR | DELAY
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-25
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-14.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are advised to take other routes but the
specific route is not specified in the DMS message (sometimes referred to as Asoft”
diversion), or
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are advised by the DMS message to take a
specific Type 2 freeway diversion route (Type 1, Type 3, Type 4, Type 5 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to take a
specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion messages
are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, motorists should not be encouraged to divert to another route because it would
result in greater travel time than if the motorists were to remain on the primary freeway. However, it
is still important to tell motorists what they need to do.
Terms for the Action message element when lane-blocking incidents occur under this situation are
shown in Table 5.23.
Table 5.23 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | PREPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
STAY ON [route number][cardinal direction] STAY ON | [route number][cardinal direction]STAY ON [highway, street name][cardinal direction] STAY ON | [highway, street name][cardinal direction]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-26
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed for a variety of reasons
including:
! There are no suitable alternative routes that can be recommended because traffic conditions
on the most logical routes would not result in travel time savings to motorists if they diverted
from the primary freeway,
! The DMS operator is unaware of the traffic conditions on the most logical alternative routes
because surveillance does not exist on these routes,
! It is important to display an Action before the DMS operator has had a chance to assess the
full impact of the incident, and/or
! It is important to display an Action before the police have arrived and establish positive
diversion routes.
Terms for the Action message element when lane-blocking incidents occur under this situation are
shown in Table 5.24.
Table 5.24 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-27
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative freeway route and
has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic control
personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table 5-
25.
Table 5.25 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
A|@ Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-28
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on page
4-13.
Terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 5.26.
Table 5.26 TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] TRAFFIC [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TRAFFIC
[route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-29
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Actionare given on page 4-14.
When MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT are displayed, the reason for following the
suggested action is implied, and there is no need to display the reason. However, when the incident
descriptors ACCIDENT or MINOR ACCIDENT are displayed, then a reason needs to be displayed.
Also, when it is important to convince motorists to use an alternative route, it is oftentimes
advantageous to display BEST ROUTE TO [destination].
The terms shown in Table 5.27 below are acceptable to display.
Table 5.27 TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-30
5.2 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE
CLOSING THE FREEWAY
When the police and/or traffic control personnel arrive, the freeway is closed and traffic is
diverted to an alternative route. The freeway closure (the location where traffic is diverted from the
freeway) is in most cases at a different location than the incident. Under these conditions, the
guidelines in this section of the Manual should be used.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
The Base DMS Message for incidents that
block all lanes of the freeway includes the
following elements: 1) Incident Descriptor(situation description), 2) Incident Location,3) Lanes Closed, 4) Closure Location, 5)
Effect on Travel (implied), 6) Audience for Action (implied), 7) Action, and 8) GoodReason for Following the Action (implied).
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS: CLOSURE
! Incident Descriptor (situation description);
! Incident Location,
! Lanes Closed,
! Closure Location,
! Effect on Travel (implied by other message elements)
! Audience for Action (implied by other message
elements),
! Action (tells motorists what to do), and
! Good Reason for Following the Action statement
(implied by other message elements).
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-31
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE
Warnings of road closures due to incidents should be displayed under all traffic conditions in
peak or off-peak periods.
Terms for the Incident Descriptor message element are shown in Table 5.28.
A general message phrase, such as ACCIDENT, is preferred and reduces the need for a large library
of messages for every conceivable incident. Also, credibility is weakened when overly precise
messages are not verified. For example, the terms MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT is
preferred to more exact descriptions such as VEHICLE OVERTURNED. Some motorists will
voluntarily divert in response to either of the terms.
The message phrase MAJOR ACCIDENT implies
to motorists a more serious accident that may
block more than one lane and will result in
extensive delay. To the average Texas motorist, it
implies a delay of more than 45 minutes.
Table 5.28 INCIDENT DESCRIPTORSDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ACCIDENT ACCIDENT
MAJOR ACCIDENT MAJOR | ACCIDENT
TRUCK ACCIDENT TRUCK | ACCIDENT
VEHICLE FIRE VEHICLE | FIRE
FUEL SPILL FUEL | SPILL
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MAJOR ACCIDENT means delays of 45 minutes or
more to the average Texas motorist.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-32
Incident Location
General principles for the message element Incident Location can be found beginning on page 4-
8.
Terms for the Incident Location message element are shown in Table 5.29.
Table 5.29 TERMS FOR INCIDENT LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
1 MILE (AHEAD) 1 MILE (AHEAD)[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
BEFORE [highway, street name] BEFORE | [highway, street name]BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
PAST [highway, street name] PAST | [highway, street name]PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
ON MAIN LANES ON | MAIN LNS
OVER [highway, street name] OVER | [highway, street name]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-33
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
When the DMS is located on the same freeway as the incident and relatively close to and upstream
from the freeway, the DMS message should be used to encourage motorists to leave the freeway and
find alternative routes.
Terms for the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 5.30.
Table 5.30 TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-34
Closure Location
General principles for the message element Closure Location can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
Terms for the Closure Location message element are shown in Table 5.31.
Table 5.31 TERMS FOR CLOSURE LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
1 MILE (AHEAD) 1 MILE (AHEAD)[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS..
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-35
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
There is no need to include the Effect on Travel message element because the effects are implied
from other message elements such as the Lanes Closed (i.e., ALL LANES CLOSED) message
element.
Table 5.32 TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
(Not necessary to display because it is implied by other message elements)
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-36
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-14.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by one of the following:
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as Asoft” diversion),
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route
( Type 1, Type 3, Type 4 diversion routes are not applicable), or
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 5 diversion route (Type 6 diversion route is not applicable.).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to
take a specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion
messages are displayed.
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed prior to the arrival and
positioning of the police or traffic control personnel and/or the traffic control devices along the
planned diversion route.
Terms for the Action message element when lane-blocking incidents occur under this situation are
shown in Table 5.33.
Table 5.33 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-37
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
An Action message element with diversion to a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route might
be displayed prior to the arrival and positioning of the police or traffic control personnel and/or the
traffic control devices along the planned diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element for this situation is given in Table 5.34.
Table 5.34 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
A|@ Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-38
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route
After the arrival of the police and the TxDOT Incident Response Team, traffic control devices
are placed along the route in accordance with the Incident Emergency Route Plan. The Plan may
also include positioning of police or traffic control personnel at critical points. The DMS operator is
aware of the established diversion route(s).
Terms for the Action message element for this situation are given in Table 5.35.
Table 5.35 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONVMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A SPECIFIC TYPE 5 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND FOLLOW DETOUR EXIT AND | FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AND FOLLOW SIGNS EXIT AND | FOLLOW | SIGNS
FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT] | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT |
FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
A|@ Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of VMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-39
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on page
4-13.
Terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 5.36.
Table 5.36 TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] TRAFFIC [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TRAFFIC
[route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-40
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Actionare given on page 4-14.
As a rule, when the freeway is closed and ALL LANES CLOSED or FREEWAY CLOSED is
displayed, the reason for following the suggested action is implied, and there is no need to display
the reason. However, when a recommended diversion route may be perceived by motorists as not
being the most logical route, then a Good Reason for Following the Action should be displayed.
The terms shown in Table 5.37 below are acceptable to display.
Table 5.37 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-41
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE
Incident Descriptor
Warnings of road closures due to incidents should be displayed under all traffic conditions in
peak or off-peak periods.
Terms for the Incident Descriptor message element are shown in Table 5.38.
A general message phrase, such as ACCIDENT, is preferred and reduces the need for a large library
of messages for every conceivable incident. Also, credibility is weakened when overly precise
messages are not verified. For example, the terms MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT is
preferred to more exact descriptions such as VEHICLE OVERTURNED. Some motorists will
voluntarily divert in response to either of the terms.
The message phrase MAJOR ACCIDENT implies
to motorists a more serious accident that may
block more than one lane and will result in
extensive delay. To the average Texas motorist, it
implies a delay of more than 45 minutes.
Table 5.38 INCIDENT DESCRIPTORSDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ACCIDENT ACCIDENT
MAJOR ACCIDENT MAJOR | ACCIDENT
TRUCK ACCIDENT TRUCK | ACCIDENT
VEHICLE FIRE VEHICLE | FIRE
FUEL SPILL FUEL | SPILL
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MAJOR ACCIDENT means delays of 45 minutes or
more to the average Texas motorist.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-42
Incident Location
General principles for the message element Incident Location can be found beginning on page 4-
8.
Terms to use for the Incident Location are shown in Table 5.39.
Table 5.39 TERMS FOR INCIDENT LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
BEFORE [highway, street name] BEFORE | [highway, street name]BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
PAST [highway, street name] PAST | [highway, street name]PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
ON MAIN LANES ON | MAIN LNS
OVER [highway, street name] OVER | [highway, street name]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-43
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
When the DMS is located on the same freeway as the incident and relatively close to and upstream
of the incident, the DMS message should be used to encourage motorists to leave the freeway and
find alternative routes.
Terms for the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 5.40.
Table 5.40 TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-44
Closure Location
General principles for the message element Closure Location can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
Terms for the Closure Location message element are shown in Table 5.41.
Table 5.41 TERMS FOR CLOSURE LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-45
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
There is no need to include the Effect on Travel message element because the effects are implied
from other message elements such as the Lanes Closed (i.e., ALL LANES CLOSED) message
element.
Table 5.42 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
(Not necessary to display because it is implied by other message elements)
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-46
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-13.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by one of the following:
! Motorists are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as “soft” diversion),
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route
(Type 1, Type 3, Type 4 diversion routes are not applicable.), or
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 5 diversion route (Type 6 diversion route is not applicable).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to take a
specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion messages
are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, motorists should not be encouraged to divert to another route because it would
result in greater travel time than if the motorists were to remain on the primary freeway. However, it
is still important to tell motorists what they need to do.
Terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 5.43.
Table 5.43 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | PREPARED | TO |STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-47
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed for a variety of reasons
including:
! There are no suitable freeway alternative routes that can be recommended, and/or.
! It is important to display an Action before the DMS operator has had a chance to assess the
full impact of the incident.
Terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 5.44.
Table 5.44 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-48
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
An Action message element with diversion to a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route might
be displayed if an alternative freeway is available that will result in savings in travel time
Acceptable terms for the Action message element for this situation are given in Table 5.45.
Table 5.45 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
A|@ Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-49
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route
After the arrival of the police and the TxDOT Incident Response Team, traffic control devices
are placed along the route in accordance with the Incident Emergency Route Plan. The Plan may
also include positioning of police or traffic control personnel at critical points. The DMS operator is
aware of the established diversion route(s).
Terms for the Action message element for this situation are given in Table 5.46.
Table 5.46 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A SPECIFIC TYPE 5 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT] | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT |
FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
A|@ Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-50
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on page
4-13.
Terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 5.47.
Table 5.47 TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] TRAFFIC [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TRAFFIC
[route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-51
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Actionare given on page 4-14.
As a rule, when the freeway is closed and ALL LANES CLOSED or FREEWAY CLOSED is
displayed, the reason for following the suggested action is implied, and there is no need to display
the reason. However, when a recommended diversion route may be perceived by motorists as not
being the most logical route, then a Good Reason for Following the Action should be displayed.
Terms shown in Table 5.48 below are acceptable to display.
Table 5.48 TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-52
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE CLOSURE
The DMS operational guidelines in this section of the Manual apply when the DMS is on a
different freeway than the incident, but the incident still can have an affect on motorists who are
passing the DMS. For example, westbound I-10 motorists who intend to exit the freeway and enter
northbound I-45 to travel toward Dallas could be affected by incidents that occur on northbound I-45
north of the I-10/I-45 interchange. Messages displayed on DMSs on westbound I-10 concerning
incidents on northbound I-45 can be helpful to those motorists heading toward Dallas.
The major difference between the messages displayed on DMSs located on a different freeway than
the closure in comparison to the messages on DMSs located on the same freeway as the closure but
far upstream of the closure is in the diversion information provided.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-53
Incident Descriptor
Warnings of road closures due to incidents should be displayed under all traffic conditions in
peak or off-peak periods.
Terms for the Incident Descriptor message element are shown in Table 5.49.
A general message phrase, such as ACCIDENT, is preferred and reduces the need for a large library
of messages for every conceivable incident. Also, credibility is weakened when overly precise
messages are not verified. For example, the terms MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT is
preferred to more exact descriptions such as VEHICLE OVERTURNED. Some motorists will
voluntarily divert in response to either of the terms.
The message phrase MAJOR ACCIDENT implies
to motorists a more serious accident that may
block more than one lane and will result in
extensive delay. To the average Texas motorist, it
implies a delay of more than 45 minutes.
Table 5.49 INCIDENT DESCRIPTORSDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
ACCIDENT ACCIDENT
MAJOR ACCIDENT MAJOR | ACCIDENT
TRUCK ACCIDENT TRUCK | ACCIDENT
VEHICLE FIRE VEHICLE | FIRE
FUEL SPILL FUEL | SPILL
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MAJOR ACCIDENT means delays of 45 minutes or
more to the average Texas motorist.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-54
Incident Location
General principles for the message element Incident Location can be found beginning on page 4-
8.
Terms for the Incident Location message element are shown in Table 5.50.
Table 5.50 TERMS FOR INCIDENT LOCATIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AT [highway, street name]* AT | [highway, street name]*
AT [exit ramp name] EXIT* AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
BEFORE [highway, street name]* BEFORE | [highway, street name]*
BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT* BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
PAST [highway, street name]* PAST | [highway, street name]*
PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT* PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
OVER [highway, street name]* OVER | [highway, street name]*
* Insert AON [route number, highway name or street name][cardinal direction]@ in front of the
Incident Location.
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-55
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
When the DMS is located on a different freeway than the incident, it is oftentimes advantageous to
advise motorists of the freeway closure. Acceptable terms for the Lanes Closed message element are
shown in Table 5.51.
Table 5.51 TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-56
Closure Location
General principles for the message element Closure Location can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
Acceptable terms for the Closure Location message element are shown in Table 5.52.
Table 5.52 TERMS FOR CLOSURE LOCATIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AT [highway, street name]* AT | [highway, street name]*
AT [exit ramp name] EXIT* AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
* Insert AON [route number, highway name or street name][cardinal direction]@ in front of the
Incident Location.
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-57
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
There is no need to include the Effect on Travel message element because the effects are implied
from other message elements such as Lanes Closed (i.e., ALL LANES CLOSED) message element.
Table 5.53 TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
(Not necessary to display because it is implied by other message elements)
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-58
Action
General principles for Action message element can be found beginning on page 4-13.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are advised to take other routes but the
specific route is not specified in the DMS message (sometimes referred to as “soft”
diversion), or
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are advised by the DMS message to take a
specific Type 2 freeway diversion route (Type 1, Type 3, Type 4, Type 5 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable.).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to take a
specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion messages
are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, it may be best for the motorists to stay on the current freeway rather than turning
onto the freeway that is affected by the closure.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 5.54.
Table 5.54 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | PREPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-59
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed for a variety of reasons
including:
! The DMS operator is unaware of the traffic conditions on the most logical alternative routes
because surveillance does not exist on these routes,
! It is important to display an Action before the DMS operator has had a chance to assess the
full impact of the incident, and/or
! It is important to display an Action before the police have arrived and establish positive
diversion routes.
Terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 5.55.
Table 5.55 TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-60
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative freeway route and
has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic control
personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table
5.56.
Table 5.56 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
A|@ Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-61
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on page
4-13.
Terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 5.57.
Table 5.57 TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] TRAFFIC [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TRAFFIC
[route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-62
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Actionare given on page 4-14.
As a rule, when the freeway is closed and ALL LANES CLOSED or FREEWAY CLOSED is
displayed, the reason for following the suggested action is implied, and there is no need to display
the reason. However, when a recommended diversion route may be perceived by motorists as not
being the most logical route, then a Good Reason for Following the Action should be displayed.
Terms shown in Table 5.58 below are acceptable to display.
Table 5.58 TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-63
5.3 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR INCIDENTS ON AN
INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT REQUIRE CLOSING
THE CONNECTOR RAMP
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
The Base DMS Message for closure of a
freeway-to-freeway connector during incidents
includes the following: 1) Incident Descriptor,2) Incident Location, 3) Lanes Closed, 4)
Ramp Closure Descriptor, 5) Audience for Action, 6) Action, and 7) Good Reason for Following the Action.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
! Incident Descriptor (situation description),
! Incident Location,
! Lanes Closed,
! Ramp Closure Descriptor,
! Audience for Action (when the action is for a specific
group of motorists),
! Action (tells motorists what to do), and
! Good Reason for Following the Action statement
(usually implied by other message elements)
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-64
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Incident Descriptor
Acceptable terms for the Incident Descriptor message element are given in Table 5.59.
A general message phrase, such as ACCIDENT, is preferred and reduces the need for a large library
of messages for every conceivable incident. Also, credibility is weakened when overly precise
messages are not verified. For example, the terms MAJOR ACCIDENT or TRUCK ACCIDENT is
preferred to more exact descriptions such as VEHICLE OVERTURNED. Some motorists will
voluntarily divert in response to either of the terms.
The message phrase MAJOR ACCIDENT implies
to motorists a more serious accident that may
block more than one lane and will result in
extensive delay. To the average Texas motorist, it
implies a delay of more than 45 minutes.
Table 5.59 ACCEPTABLE INCIDENT DESCRIPTORSDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
MAJOR ACCIDENT MAJOR | ACCIDENT
TRUCK ACCIDENT TRUCK | ACCIDENT
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MAJOR ACCIDENT means delays of 45 minutes or
more to the average Texas motorist.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-65
Incident Location
General principles for the message element Incident Location can be found beginning on page 4-
8.
Acceptable terms for the Incident Location message element are shown in Table 5.60.
Table 5.60 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR INCIDENT LOCATIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AT [highway, street name]* AT | [highway, street name]*
AT [exit ramp name] EXIT* AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
BEFORE [highway, street name]* BEFORE | [highway, street name]*
BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT* BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
PAST [highway, street name]* PAST | [highway, street name]*
PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT* PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
OVER [highway, street name]* OVER | [highway, street name]*
* Insert “ON [route number, highway name or street name][cardinal direction]” in front of the
Incident Location.
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-66
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 5.61.
Table 5.61 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-67
Ramp Closure Descriptor
Acceptable terms for the Ramp Closure Descriptor message element are shown in Table 5.62.
Table 5.62 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR RAMP CLOSURE DESCRIPTORSDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
RAMP CLOSED | RAMP | CLOSED |
TO [intersecting fwy number] [card. direction] TO [intersecting fwy number] [card. direction] RAMP CLOSED |
TO [intersecting freeway name] FREEWAY
[intersecting fwy number] CLOSED [intersecting fwy number] | CLOSED
[intersecting fwy number] [card. direction] CLOSED [intersecting fwy number] [card. direction] CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s).
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-68
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-13.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as Asoft” diversion),
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected ramp are advised by the DMS message to take a
specific Type 1 or Type 2 diversion route (Type 3, Type 4 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable.), or
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected ramp are advised by the DMS message to take the
Type 5 diversion (detour) route.
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to take a
specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion messages
are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, it may be best for the motorists to stay on the current freeway rather than turning
onto the freeway that is affected by the closure.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 5.63.
Table 5.63 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | PREPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-69
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed when it is not possible for the
DMS operator to specify a specific route the motorist should use.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 5.64.
Table 5.64 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-70
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative route and has real-
time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic control personnel are
not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table
5.65.
Table 5.65 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
A|@ Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-71
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 5 Diversion Route
There are times when the Incident Emergency Route Plan has been implemented. Guide signs,
trailblazers, and police and/or traffic control personnel are guiding motorists at critical locations
along the route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when this condition exists are shown in Table
5.66.
Table 5.66 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE THE TYPE 5 DIVERSION (DETOUR) ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW DETOUR
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW SIGNS
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW SIGNS
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-72
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on page
4-13.
Acceptable terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 5.67.
Table 5.67 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 5 Designing the Base DMS Message for Incidents Page 5-73
Good Reason for Following Action
General guidelines for displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Actionare given on page 4-14.
The terms shown in Table 5.68 are acceptable to display.
Table 5.68 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONCLOSURE DMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-i
MODULE 6. DESIGNING THE BASE DMS MESSAGE
FOR ROADWORK
TABLE OF CONTENTS
6.1 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR LANE CLOSURES DURING
ROADWORK .......................................................................................................... 6-1
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS ............................................................................ 6-1
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE ROADWORK . 6-2
Roadwork Descriptor ................................................................................................. 6-2
Roadwork Location.................................................................................................... 6-3
Lanes Closed.............................................................................................................. 6-4
Effect on Travel ......................................................................................................... 6-5
Action ........................................................................................................................ 6-6
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message .............................................................................................. 6-6
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ..................................... 6-7
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route .............................................................................................................. 6-8
Audience for Action................................................................................................... 6-9
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 6-10
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE
ROADWORK .......................................................................................................... 6-11
Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-11
Roadwork Location.................................................................................................. 6-12
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-13
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-14
Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-15
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 6-15
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-16
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-17
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-18
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 6-19
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK................................ 6-20
Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-20
Roadwork Location.................................................................................................. 6-21
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-22
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-ii
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-23
Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-24
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 6-24
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-25
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-26
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-27
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 6-28
6.2 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK THAT
REQUIRES CLOSING THE FREEWAY .............................................. 6-29
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS .......................................................................... 6-29
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE .... 6-30
Base DMS Message Elements ................................................................................. 6-30
Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-31
Closure Location...................................................................................................... 6-32
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-33
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-34
Action....................................................................................................................... 6-35
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-36
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 6-37
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE.... 6-38
Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-38
Closure Location...................................................................................................... 6-39
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-40
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-41
Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-42
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 6-42
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-43
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-44
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 6 Diversion Route ................... 6-45
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-46
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 6-47
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE ... 6-48
Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-49
Closure Location...................................................................................................... 6-50
Lanes Closed............................................................................................................ 6-51
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-iii
Effect on Travel ....................................................................................................... 6-52
Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-53
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message ............................................................................................ 6-53
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-54
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-55
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-56
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 6-57
6.3 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK ON AN
INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT REQUIRES CLOSING
THE CONNECTOR RAMP ........................................................................... 6-58
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS .......................................................................... 6-58
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE................................. 6-59
Roadwork Descriptor ............................................................................................... 6-59
Closure Location...................................................................................................... 6-60
Ramp Closure Descriptor......................................................................................... 6-61
Action ...................................................................................................................... 6-62
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion) ................................... 6-62
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route ............................................................................................................ 6-63
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 6 Diversion Route ................... 6-64
Audience for Action................................................................................................. 6-65
Good Reason for Following the Action................................................................... 6-66
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-1
MODULE 6. DESIGNING THE BASE DMS MESSAGE
FOR ROADWORK
6.1 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR LANE CLOSURES DURING
ROADWORK
This section of the Manual applies to roadwork that requires closure of some of the lanes of
the freeway while other lanes are open to traffic. When the roadwork requires closure of all the
lanes on the freeway, Section 6.2 Base DMS Message for Roadwork That Requires Closing the Freeway should be used to develop the Base DMS Message.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
The Base DMS Message for roadwork
includes the following: 1) RoadworkDescriptor (situation description), 2)
Roadwork Location, 3) Lanes Closed, 4)
Effect on Travel (e.g., major delay), 5)
Audience for Action, 6) Action, and 7) GoodReason for Following the Action.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
! Roadwork Descriptor (situation description),
! Roadwork Location,
! Lanes Closed,
! Effect on Travel (e.g., major delay),
! Audience for Action (when the action is for a specific
group of motorists),
! Action (tells motorists what to do), and
! Good Reason for Following the Action statement
(usually implied by other message elements).
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-2
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE ROADWORK
Roadwork Descriptor
Warnings of lane closures due to roadwork should be displayed under all traffic conditions in
peak or off-peak periods. Minor off-the-roadway work such as grass mowing should not be
displayed.
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Descriptor message element are given in Table 6.1.
The word ROADWORK may be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION. Motorist
interpretations of both words are described on page 4-16. In addition, CONST is an acceptable
abbreviation for CONSTRUCTION.
Table 6.1 ACCEPTABLE ROADWORK DESCRIPTORSDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
CONSTRUCTION* CONST or ROADWORK*
ROADWORK ROADWORK
* The word CONSTRUCTION will not fit on an eight-character line of a portable DMS. Therefore,
the word must either be abbreviated or replaced with the word ROADWORK.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-3
Roadwork Location
General principles for the message element Roadwork Location can be found under LanesClosed on page 4-10.
Acceptable terms to use for the Roadwork Location message element are shown in Table 6.2.
Note that portable DMSs cannot be used when it is desirable to inform motorists about the length
of the closure for the roadwork (e.g., 2 LANES CLOSED FROM EXIT 42 TO EXIT 43).
Table 6.2 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ROADWORK LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
1 MILE (AHEAD) 1 MILE (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD)AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
BEFORE [highway, street name] BEFORE | [highway, street name]BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
PAST [highway, street name] PAST | [highway, street name]PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
OVER [highway, street name] OVER | [highway, street name] FROM [highway, street name] | TO [highway, street name] FROM [highway, street name] | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT
FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT
TO [highway, street name] FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-4
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-
10.
When the DMS is located on the same freeway as the roadwork and relatively close to and
upstream of the lane closure, the DMS message can encourage motorists to leave the closed
lane(s) and move into the open lanes by informing them of which specific lanes are closed. This
helps the movement of vehicles through the restricted lane closure area.
Acceptable terms for the Lanes Closed message element for these cases are shown in Table 6.3.
Table 6.3 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
CENTER LANE CLOSED CENTER | LANE | CLOSED
CENTER LANES CLOSED CENTER | LANES | CLOSED
CENTER [number] LANES CLOSED CENTER | [number] LANES| CLOSED
LEFT LANE CLOSED LEFT | LANE | CLOSED
LEFT [number] LANES CLOSED LEFT | [number] LANES | CLOSED
RIGHT LANE CLOSED RIGHT | LANE | CLOSED
RIGHT [number] LANES CLOSED RIGHT | [number] LANES | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-5
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page
4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Effect on Travel message element are shown in Table 6.4.
Table 6.4 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXPECT DELAY EXPECT | DELAY
EXPECT MAJOR DELAY EXPECT | MAJOR | DELAY
EXPECT MINOR DELAY EXPECT | MINOR |DELAY
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-6
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-13.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as “soft” diversion), or
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route
(Type 1, Type 3, Type 4, Type 5 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to
take a specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion
messages are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, motorists should not be encouraged to divert to another route because it would
result in greater travel time than if the motorists were to remain on the primary freeway.
However, it is still important to tell motorists what they need to do.
Acceptable terms for the Action when lane-blocking incidents occur under this situation are
shown in Table 6.5.
Table 6.5 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | PREPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-7
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed for a variety of reasons
including:
! There are no suitable alternative routes that can be recommended because traffic conditions
on the most logical routes would not result in travel time savings to motorists if they diverted
from the primary freeway,
! The DMS operator is unaware of the traffic conditions on the most logical alternative routes
because surveillance does not exist on these routes, and/or
! No specific alternative route has been selected by the work crew where police, traffic control
personnel and/or traffic control devices are available to provide positive guidance to
motorists.
Acceptable terms for the Action when lane-blocking incidents occur under these situations are
shown in Table 6.6.
Table 6.6 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-8
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative route and has
real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Guide signs or trailblazers
may or may not be present. Police or traffic control personnel are not positioned at critical
decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table
6.7.
Table 6.7 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-9
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on
page 4-13.
Acceptable terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 6.8.
Table 6.8 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.]ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-10
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for a displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Action are given on page 4-14.
The terms shown in Table 6.9 are acceptable to display.
Table 6.9 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-11
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE ROADWORK
Roadwork Descriptor
Warnings of lane closures due to roadwork should be displayed under all traffic conditions in
peak or off-peak periods. Minor off-the-roadway work such as grass mowing should not be
displayed.
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Descriptor message element are given in Table 6.10.
The word ROADWORK may be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION. Motorist
interpretations of both words are described on page 4-14. In addition, CONST is an acceptable
abbreviation for CONSTRUCTION.
Table 6.10 ACCEPTABLE ROADWORK DESCRIPTORSDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
CONSTRUCTION* CONST or ROADWORK*
ROADWORK ROADWORK
* The word CONSTRUCTION will not fit on an eight-character line of a portable DMS. Therefore,
the word must either be abbreviated or replaced with the word ROADWORK.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-12
Roadwork Location
General principles for the message element Roadwork Location can be found under LanesClosed on page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Location message element are shown in Table 6.11.
Table 6.11 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ROADWORK LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
BEFORE [highway, street name] BEFORE | [highway, street name]BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
PAST [highway, street name] PAST | [highway, street name]PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
OVER [highway, street name] OVER | [highway, street name] FROM [highway, street name] | TO [highway, street name] FROM [highway, street name] | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT
FROM [highway, street name] | FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT
TO [highway, street name] FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT |FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-13
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
Situations arise when the DMS is on the same freeway and upstream of the roadwork but at a
location far enough upstream of the lane closure where it is not advisable to encourage lane
changing. It is best to move traffic in all the lanes. Therefore, there is no traffic flow advantage
to inform motorists the specific lanes that are closed. However, it is important to notify
motorists the number of lanes closed so that they can make earlier decisions about whether to
take alternative routes.
Acceptable terms for the Lanes Closed message element for these cases are shown in Table 6.12.
Table 6.12 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
1 LANE CLOSED 1 LANE | CLOSED
[number] LANES CLOSED [number] LANES | CLOSED
1 LANE OPEN 1 LANE | OPEN
[number] LANES OPEN [number] LANES | OPEN
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-14
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page
4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Effect on Travel message element are shown in Table 6.13.
Table 6.13 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXPECT DELAY EXPECT DELAY
EXPECT MAJOR DELAY EXPECT | MAJOR | DELAY
EXPECT MINOR DELAY EXPECT | MINOR | DELAY
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-15
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-13.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as “soft” diversion), or
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route
(Type 1, Type 3, Type 4, Type 5 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to
take a specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion
messages are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, motorists should not be encouraged to divert to another route because it would
result in greater travel time than if the motorists were to remain on the primary freeway.
However, it is still important to tell motorists what they need to do.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 6.14.
Table 6.14 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
PREPARE TO STOP PREPARE | TO | STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-16
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed for a variety of reasons
including:
! There are no suitable alternative routes that can be recommended because traffic conditions
on the most logical routes would not result in travel time savings to motorists if they diverted
from the primary freeway,
! The DMS operator is unaware of the traffic conditions on the most logical alternative routes
because surveillance does not exist on these routes, and/or
! No specific alternative route has been selected by the work crew where police, traffic control
personnel and/or traffic control devices are available to provide positive guidance to
motorists.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in these situations are shown in Table 6.15.
Table 6.15 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-17
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable freeway alternative route
and has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic
control personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table
6.16.
Table 6.16 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-18
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on
page 4-13.
Acceptable terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 6.17.
Table 6.17 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.]ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-19
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for a displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Action are given on page 4-14.
The terms shown in Table 6.18 are acceptable to display.
Table 6.18 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-20
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK
The DMS operational guidelines in this section of the Manual apply when the DMS is on a
different freeway than the incident, but the incident still can have an affect on motorists who are
passing the DMS. For example, westbound I-10 motorists who intend to exit the freeway and
enter northbound I-45 to travel toward Dallas could be affected by incidents that occur on
northbound I-45 north of the I-10/I-45 interchange. Messages displayed on DMSs on westbound
I-10 concerning incidents on northbound I-45 can be helpful to those motorists heading toward
Dallas.
The major difference between the messages displayed on DMSs located on a different freeway
than the roadwork in comparison to the messages on DMSs located on the same freeway as the
work but far upstream of the work is in the diversion information provided.
Roadwork Descriptor
Warnings of lane closures due to roadwork should be displayed under all traffic conditions in
peak or off-peak periods. Minor off-the-roadway work such as grass mowing should not be
displayed.
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Descriptor message elements are given in Table 6.19.
The word ROADWORK may be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION. Motorist
interpretations of both words are described on page 4-16. In addition, CONST is an acceptable
abbreviation for CONSTRUCTION.
Table 6.19 ACCEPTABLE ROADWORK DESCRIPTORSDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
CONSTRUCTION* CONST or ROADWORK*
ROADWORK ROADWORK
* The word CONSTRUCTION will not fit on an eight-character line of a portable DMS. Therefore,
the word must either be abbreviated or replaced with the word ROADWORK.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-21
Roadwork Location
General principles for the message element Roadwork Location can be found under LanesClosed on page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Location message element are shown in Table 6.20.
Table 6.20 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ROADWORK LOCATIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
AT [highway, street name]* AT | [highway, street name]*
AT EXIT [exit ramp number]* AT EXIT [exit ramp number]*
BEFORE [highway, street name]* BEFORE | [highway, street name]*
BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT* BEFORE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
PAST [highway, street name]* PAST | [highway, street name]*
PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT* PAST | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
OVER [highway, street name]* OVER | [highway, street name]*
* Insert “ON [route number, highway name or street name][cardinal direction]” in front of the
Roadwork Location.
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-22
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
It is not important to inform motorists on another freeway about the specific lanes that are
closed. However, it is important to notify motorists about the number of lanes closed so that they
can make earlier decisions about whether to take alternative routes.
Acceptable terms for the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 6.21.
Table 6.21 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
1 LANE CLOSED 1 LANE | CLOSED
[number] LANES CLOSED [number] LANES | CLOSED
1 LANE OPEN 1 LANE | OPEN
[number] LANES OPEN [number] LANES | OPEN
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-23
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page
4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Effect on Travel message element are shown in Table 6.22.
Table 6.22 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXPECT DELAY EXPECT | DELAY
EXPECT MAJOR DELAY EXPECT | MAJOR | DELAY
EXPECT MINOR DELAY EXPECT | MINOR | DELAY
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of
DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-24
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-14.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are advised to take other routes but the
specific route is not specified in the DMS message (sometimes referred to as “soft”
diversion), or
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are advised by the DMS message to take a
specific Type 2 freeway diversion route (Type 1, Type 3, Type 4, Type 5 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to
take a specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion
messages are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, it may be best for the motorists to stay on the current freeway rather than
turning onto the freeway that is affected by the roadwork.
Acceptable terms for the Action when lane closures are on another freeway under this situation
are shown in Table 6.23.
Table 6.23 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | PREPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
STAY ON [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] STAY ON | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction]STAY ON [route number] [cardinal direction] STAY | ON [route number] [cardinal direction]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-25
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed for a variety of reasons
including:
! There are no suitable alternative routes that can be recommended because traffic conditions
on the most logical routes would not result in travel time savings to motorists if they diverted
from the primary freeway,
! The DMS operator is unaware of the traffic conditions on the most logical alternative routes
because surveillance does not exist on these routes, and/or
! No specific alternative route has been selected by the work crew where police, traffic control
personnel and/or traffic control devices are available to provide positive guidance to
motorists.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 6.24.
Table 6.24 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-26
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative freeway route
and has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic
control personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table
6.25.
Table 6.25 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-27
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on
page 4-13.
Acceptable terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 6.26.
Table 6.26 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-28
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for a displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Action are given on page 4-14.
The terms shown in Table 6.27 are acceptable to display.
Table 6.27 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN ROADWORK
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-29
6.2 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK THAT REQUIRES
CLOSING THE FREEWAY
When construction or maintenance roadwork requires closure of the entire freeway, a traffic
control plan is implemented. The traffic control plan includes installation of traffic control
devices to divert traffic off the primary freeway and to give positive guidance to the motorists
along the diversion route and then back to the primary freeway. The closure of the primary
freeway will take place at an exit ramp upstream of the roadwork.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
The Base DMS Message for
roadwork that requiring a total freeway
closure usually includes the following:
1) Roadwork Descriptor (situation
description), 2) Closure Location, 3)
Lanes Closed, 4) Effect on Travel (e.g.,
major delay), 5) Audience for Action,6) Action, and 7) Good Reason for Following the Action.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS:
! Roadwork Descriptor (situation description),
! Closure Location,
! Lanes Closed,
! Effect on Travel (e.g., major delay),
! Audience for Action (when the action is for a specified
group of motorists),
! Action (tells motorists what to do), and
! Good Reason for Following the Action statement (usually
implied by other message elements.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-30
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE
Base DMS Message Elements
In contrast to other situations, the Base Message
when the DMS is located upstream on the same freeway
and near the freeway closure will only include the
following four elements: 1) Roadwork Descriptor, 2)
Closure Location, 3) Lanes Closed, and 4) Action.
The Effect on Travel, Audience for Action and GoodReason for Following the Action are implied by the Lanes Closed and diversion Action message
elements and are not displayed on the DMS that is near the freeway closure location.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS FOR
DMS NEAR CLOSURE:
! Roadwork Descriptor,
! Closure Location,
! Lanes Closed, and
! Action.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-31
Roadwork Descriptor
Warnings of freeway closures due to roadwork should be displayed under all traffic
conditions in peak or off-peak periods.
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Descriptor message element are given in Table 6.28.
The word ROADWORK may be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION. Motorist
interpretations of both words are described on page 4-16. In addition, CONST is an acceptable
abbreviation for CONSTRUCTION.
Table 6.28 ACCEPTABLE ROADWORK DESCRIPTORSDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
CONSTRUCTION* CONST or ROADWORK*
ROADWORK ROADWORK
* The word CONSTRUCTION will not fit on an eight-character line of a portable DMS. Therefore,
the word must either be abbreviated or replaced with the word ROADWORK.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-32
Closure Location
General principles for the message element Closure Location can be found beginning on
page 4-10.
Acceptable terms to use for the Closure Location message element are shown in Table 6.29.
Note that portable DMSs cannot be used when it is desirable to inform motorists the length of
the closure for the roadwork (e.g., FREEWAY CLOSED FROM MCCART TO WESTCREEK).
Table 6.29 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR CLOSURE LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
1 MILE (AHEAD) 1 MILE (AHEAD)[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD) AHEAD AHEAD
AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
FROM [highway, street name] | TO [highway, street name] FROM [highway, street name] | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT
FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT
TO [highway, street name] FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-33
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 6.30.
Table 6.30 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-34
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page
4-10.
The Effect on Travel is implied to motorists by the Lanes Closed and Action message elements
and is not required in the message.
Table 6.31 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
(Not necessary to display because it is implied by other message elements)
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-35
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-14.
Because a Type 6 diversion (detour) route has been set up, acceptable terms for the Actionmessage element are shown in Table 6.32.
Table 6.32 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A SPECIFIC TYPE 6 DIVERSION (DETOUR) ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND FOLLOW DETOUR EXIT AND | FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AND FOLLOW SIGNS EXIT AND | FOLLOW | SIGNS
FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-36
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on
page 4-13.
The Audience for Action is implied to motorists by the Lanes Closed and Action message
elements to mean all traffic passing the DMS and is not required in the message.
Table 6.33 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTION DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
(Not necessary to display because it is implied by other message elements)
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-37
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for a displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Action are given on page 4-14.
The Good Reason for Following the Action is implied to motorists by the Lanes Closed and
Action message elements and is not required in the message.
Table 6.34 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO CLOSURE
(Not necessary to display because it is implied by other message elements)
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-38
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE
Roadwork Descriptor
Warnings of freeway closures due to roadwork should be displayed under all traffic
conditions in peak or off-peak periods.
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Descriptor message element are given in Table 6.35.
The word ROADWORK may be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION. Motorist
interpretations of both words are described on page 4-16. In addition, CONST is an acceptable
abbreviation for CONSTRUCTION.
Table 6.35 ACCEPTABLE ROADWORK DESCRIPTORSDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
CONSTRUCTION* CONST or ROADWORK*
ROADWORK ROADWORK
* The word CONSTRUCTION will not fit on an eight-character line of a portable DMS. Therefore,
the word must either be abbreviated or replaced with the word ROADWORK.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-39
Closure Location
General principles for the message element Closure Location can be found beginning on
page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Closure Location message element are shown in Table 6.36. Note that
portable DMSs cannot be used when it is desirable to inform motorists the length of the closure
for the roadwork (e.g., FREEWAY CLOSED FROM MCCART TO WESTCREEK).
Table 6.36 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR CLOSURE LOCATIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[number] MILES (AHEAD) [number] MILES (AHEAD)AT [highway, street name] AT | [highway, street name]AT [exit ramp name] EXIT AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT
FROM [highway, street name] | TO [highway, street name] FROM [highway, street name] | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT
FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT
TO [highway, street name] FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-40
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 6.37.
Table 6.37 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-41
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page
4-10.
The Effect on Travel is implied to motorists by the Lanes Closed and Action message elements
and is not required in the message.
Table 6.38 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
(Not necessary to display because it is implied by other message elements)
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-42
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-13.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as “soft” diversion),
! Motorists are advised by the DMS message to take a specific Type 2 freeway diversion route
(Type 1, Type 3, Type 4 and Type 5 diversion routes are not applicable), or
! Motorists are advised by the DMS to take the specific Type 6 diversion (detour) route.
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to
take a specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion
messages are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
In some cases, it may be best for the motorists to stay on the current freeway rather than
turning onto the freeway that is affected by the roadwork.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when lane closures are on another freeway
under this situation are shown in Table 6.39.
Table 6.39 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | PREPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-43
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed when it is advantageous for
motorists to leave the freeway far upstream of the closure rather than exiting at the detour
location where severe congestion may be present.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 6.40.
Table 6.40 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-44
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative freeway route
and has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic
control personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table
6.41.
Table 6.41 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-45
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 6 Diversion Route
There are times when it is best to send the motorists at the DMS location to the diversion
(detour) route that has been set up downstream.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when this condition exists are shown in Table 6.42.
Table 6.42 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE THE TYPE 6 DIVERSION (DETOUR) ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT |
FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT |
FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-46
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on
page 4-13.
Acceptable terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 6.43.
Table 6.43 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-47
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for a displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Action are given on page 4-14.
As a rule, when the freeway is closed and ALL LANES CLOSED or FREEWAY CLOSED is
displayed, the reason for following the suggested action is implied, and there is no need to
display the reason. However, when a recommended diversion route may be perceived by
motorists as not being the most logical route, then a Good Reason for Following the Action should be displayed.
The terms shown in Table 6.44 below are acceptable to display.
Table 6.44 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-48
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE
The DMS operational guidelines in this section of the Manual apply when the DMS is on a
different freeway than the incident, but the incident still can have an affect on motorists who are
passing the DMS. For example, westbound I-10 motorists who intend to exit the freeway and
enter northbound I-45 to travel toward Dallas could be affected by incidents that occur on
northbound I-45 north of the I-10/I-45 interchange. Messages displayed on DMSs on westbound
I-10 concerning incidents on northbound I-45 can be helpful to those motorists heading toward
Dallas.
The major difference between the messages displayed on DMSs located on a different freeway
than the closure in comparison to the messages on DMSs located on the same freeway as the
closure but far upstream of the work is in the diversion information provided.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-49
Roadwork Descriptor
Warnings of freeway closures due to roadwork should be displayed under all traffic
conditions in peak or off-peak periods.
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Descriptor message element are given in Table 6.45.
The word ROADWORK may be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION. Motorist
interpretations of both words are described on page 4-16. In addition, CONST is an acceptable
abbreviation for CONSTRUCTION.
Table 6.45 ACCEPTABLE ROADWORK DESCRIPTORSDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
CONSTRUCTION* CONST or ROADWORK*
ROADWORK ROADWORK
* The word CONSTRUCTION will not fit on an eight-character line of a portable DMS. Therefore,
the word must either be abbreviated or replaced with the word ROADWORK.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-50
Closure Location
General principles for the message element Closure Location can be found beginning on
page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Closure Location message element are shown in Table 6.46. Note that
portable DMSs cannot be used when it is desirable to inform motorists the length of the closure
for the roadwork (e.g., FREEWAY CLOSED FROM MCCART TO WESTCREEK).
Table 6.46 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR CLOSURE LOCATIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AT [highway, street name]* AT | [highway, street name]*
AT [exit ramp name] EXIT* AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
FROM [highway, street name] | TO [highway, street name]*
FROM [highway, street name] | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT*
FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT
TO [highway, street name]*
FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT*
* Insert “ON [route number, highway or street name] [cardinal direction] in front of Closure
Location.
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-51
Lanes Closed
General principles for the message element Lanes Closed can be found beginning on page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 6.47.
Table 6.47 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR LANES CLOSEDDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
ALL LANES CLOSED ALL | LANES | CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-52
Effect on Travel
General principles for the message element Effect on Travel can be found beginning on page
4-10.
The Effect on Travel is implied to motorists by the Lanes Closed and Action message elements
and is not required in the message.
Table 6.48 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR EFFECT ON TRAVELDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
(Not necessary to display because it is implied by other message elements)
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-53
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-13.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are not advised to take an alternative route,
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are advised to take other routes but the
specific route is not specified in the DMS message (sometimes referred to as “soft”
diversion), or
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected freeway are advised by the DMS message to take a
specific Type 2 freeway diversion route (Type 1, Type 3, Type 4, Type 5 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable).
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to
take a specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion
messages are displayed.
Motorists Are Not Advised to Take an Alternative Route – No Diversion Action Message
There may be situations when it is better for the motorists intending to turn onto the freeway
with the closure to stay on the existing freeway.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when closures occur under this situation are
shown in Table 6.49.
Table 6.49 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE NOT ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- NO DIVERSION ACTION
Large Signs Portable Signs
BE PREPARED TO STOP BE | PREPARED | TO STOP
USE CAUTION USE | CAUTION
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-54
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed when it is advantageous for
motorists to leave the existing freeway rather than turning onto the freeway with the closure and
exiting at the detour location where severe congestion may be present.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 6.50.
Table 6.50 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTE
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-55
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative freeway route
and has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic
control personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table
6.51.
Table 6.51 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-56
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on
page 4-13.
Acceptable terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 6.52.
Table 6.52 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-57
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for a displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Action are given on page 4-14.
As a rule, when the freeway is closed and ALL LANES CLOSED or FREEWAY CLOSED is
displayed, the reason for following the suggested action is implied, and there is no need to
display the reason. However, when a recommended diversion route may be perceived by
motorists as not being the most logical route, then a Good Reason for Following the Action should be displayed.
The terms shown in Table 6.53 below are acceptable to display.
Table 6.53 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-58
6.3 BASE DMS MESSAGE FOR ROADWORK ON AN
INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT REQUIRES CLOSING
THE CONNECTOR RAMP
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
The Base DMS Message for closure of a
freeway-to-freeway connector during
roadwork includes the following: 1)
Roadwork Descriptor (situation description), 2) Closure Location, 3) LanesClosed, 4) Ramp Closure Descriptor, 5)
Audience for Action, 6) Action, and 7) GoodReason for Following the Action.
BASE DMS MESSAGE ELEMENTS
! Roadwork Descriptor (situation description),
! Closure Location,
! Lanes Closed,
! Ramp Closure Descriptor,
! Audience for Action (when the action is for a specific
group of motorists),
! Action (tells motorists what to do), and
! Good Reason for Following the Action statement
(usually implied by other message elements).
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-59
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Roadwork Descriptor
Acceptable terms for the Roadwork Descriptor message element are given in Table 6.54.
The word ROADWORK may be substituted for the longer word CONSTRUCTION. Motorist
interpretations of both words are described on page 4-16. In addition, CONST is an acceptable
abbreviation for CONSTRUCTION.
Table 6.54 ACCEPTABLE ROADWORK DESCRIPTORSDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
CONSTRUCTION* CONST or ROADWORK*
ROADWORK ROADWORK
* The word CONSTRUCTION will not fit on an eight-character line of a portable DMS. Therefore,
the word must either be abbreviated or replaced with the word ROADWORK.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-60
Closure Location
General principles for the message element Closure Location can be found beginning on
page 4-10.
Acceptable terms for the Closure Location message element are shown in Table 6.55. Note that
portable DMSs cannot be used when it is desirable to inform motorists the length of the closure
for the roadwork (e.g., I-20 EAST CLOSED FROM MCCART TO WESTCREEK).
Table 6.55 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR CLOSURE LOCATIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AT [highway, street name]* AT | [highway, street name]*
AT [exit ramp name] EXIT* AT | [exit ramp name] | EXIT*
FROM [highway, street name] | TO [highway, street name]*
FROM [highway, street name] | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT*
FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT
TO [highway, street name]*
FROM [exit ramp name] EXIT | TO [exit ramp name] EXIT*
TO [landmark]*
* Insert “ON [route number, highway or street name] [cardinal direction]” in front of Closure
Location.
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-61
Ramp Closure Descriptor
Acceptable terms for the Ramp Closure Descriptor Message Element are shown in Table 6.56.
Table 6.56 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR RAMP CLOSURE DESCRIPTORS DMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
RAMP CLOSED | RAMP | CLOSED |
TO [intersecting fwy number] [card. direction]) TO [intersecting fwy number] [card. direction] RAMP CLOSED |
TO [intersecting freeway name] FREEWAY
[intersecting fwy number] CLOSED [intersecting fwy number] | CLOSED
[intersecting fwy number] [card. direction]) CLOSED [intersecting fwy number] [card. direction]) CLOSED
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s).
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-62
Action
General principles for the message element Action can be found beginning on page 4-13.
The Action message element displayed to motorists will be dictated by whether:
! Motorists are advised to take other routes but the specific route is not specified in the DMS
message (sometimes referred to as “soft” diversion),
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected ramp are advised by the DMS message to take a
specific Type 2 freeway diversion route (Type 1, Type 3, Type 4 and Type 6 diversion routes are not applicable), or
! Motorists who will turn onto the affected ramp are advised by the DMS message to take the
Type 5 diversion (detour) route.
Each TxDOT district has an established policy that defines when motorists can be advised to
take a specific alternative route. The DMS operator should review this policy before diversion
messages are displayed.
Motorists Are Advised to Take Other Routes but the Specific Route Is Not Specified in the DMS Message (Soft Diversion)
A “Soft” Diversion Action message element might be displayed when it is not possible for
the DMS operator to specify a specific route the motorist should use.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element in this situation are shown in Table 6.57.
Table 6.57 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE AN ALTERNATIVE ROUTE- SOFT DIVERSION
Large Signs Portable Signs
USE OTHER ROUTES USE | OTHER | ROUTES
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-63
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route
There are times when the DMS operator is aware of an acceptable alternative freeway route
and has real-time information about the conditions on the alternative route. Police or traffic
control personnel are not positioned at critical decision points along the diversion route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when these conditions exist are shown in Table
6.58.
Table 6.58 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE A TYPE 2 DIVERSION ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AND USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] EXIT | AND USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]USE [freeway] [cardinal direction] USE | [freeway] [cardinal direction]TUNE RADIO TO [number] AM TUNE | RADIO | TO [number] AM
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-64
Motorists Are Advised to Take a Specific Type 6 Diversion Route
There are times when the Incident Emergency Route Plan has been implemented. Thus
guide signs, trailblazers, and police and/or traffic control personnel are guiding motorists at
critical locations along the route.
Acceptable terms for the Action message element when this condition exists are shown in Table
6.59.
Table 6.59 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
MOTORISTS ARE ADVISED TO TAKE THE TYPE 6 DIVERSION (DETOUR) ROUTE
Large Signs Portable Signs
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | EXIT | AT [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT |
FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT | TAKE | [exit ramp name] | EXIT |
FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | TAKE | [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW DETOUR FOLLOW | DETOUR
TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] | FOLLOW SIGNS FOLLOW | SIGNS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-65
Audience for Action
General principles for the message element Audience for Action can be found beginning on
page 4-13.
Acceptable terms for the Audience for Action message element are shown in Table 6.60.
Table 6.60 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR AUDIENCE FOR ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
[highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction] [route number] [cardinal direction][name of city or state] [name of city or state][name of event, tourist attraction] [name of event, tourist attraction] [name of stadium, park, etc.] [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [highway, street name][cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction] TO [route number] [cardinal direction]TO [name of city or state] TO [name of city or state]TO [name of event, tourist attraction] TO [name of event, tourist attraction]TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] TO [name of stadium, park, etc.] ALL TRAFFIC ALL | TRAFFIC
ALL TRUCKS ALL | TRUCKS
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 6 Designing the Base DMS Message for Roadwork Page 6-66
Good Reason for Following the Action
General guidelines for a displaying the message element Good Reason for Following the Action are given on page 4-14.
The terms shown in Table 6.61 are acceptable to display.
Table 6.61 ACCEPTABLE TERMS FOR GOOD REASON FOR FOLLOWING THE ACTIONDMS UPSTREAM OF CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Large Signs Portable Signs
AVOID DELAY AVOID | DELAY
AVOID MAJOR DELAY AVOID | MAJOR | DELAY
SAVE [number] MINUTES SAVE | [number] MIN
BEST ROUTE TO [destination] BEST | ROUTE TO | [destination]
“|” Indicates that the next portion of the message will be displayed on the next line(s) of DMS.
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-i
MODULE 7. ESTABLISHING THE MAXIMUM
MESSAGE LENGTH
TABLE OF CONTENTS
7.1 MESSAGE LENGTH AND DMS VIEWING DISTANCE
REQUIREMENTS ....................................................................................................7-1
7.2 MAXIMUM DMS LEGIBILITY DISTANCES FOR DAY AND
NIGHT OPERATIONS ..........................................................................................7-4
7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL
CURVES – LED DMSs ...........................................................................................7-6 INTRODUCTION...............................................................................................................7-6 REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVE DESIGN SPEEDS 45 MPH AND ABOVE ............................................................................................................................7-6 REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVE DESIGN SPEEDS BELOW 45 MPH...........7-6 EXAMPLES........................................................................................................................7-6 Example 1 .........................................................................................................................7-6 Example 2 .........................................................................................................................7-7
7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL
CURVES – LED DMSs .........................................................................................7-10 INTRODUCTION.............................................................................................................7-10 REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES FOR PERMANENT DMSs................7-10 REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES FOR PORTABLE DMSs....................7-10 EXAMPLES......................................................................................................................7-10 Example 1 .......................................................................................................................7-10 Example 2 .......................................................................................................................7-11
7.5 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN AND
FOG ................................................................................................................................7-18 REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN ..............................................................................................7-18 REDUCTIONS FOR FOG................................................................................................7-18 EXAMPLE ........................................................................................................................7-19
7.6 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS WHEN LARGE
TRUCKS ARE PRESENT ..................................................................................7-20 INTRODUCTION.............................................................................................................7-20 EFFECT OF LARGE TRUCKS ON DMS VIEWING ....................................................7-20
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-1
MODULE 7. ESTABLISHING THE MAXIMUM
MESSAGE LENGTH
7.1 MESSAGE LENGTH AND DMS VIEWING DISTANCE
REQUIREMENTS
The maximum length of message that can be displayed on a DMS at a location depends not only on the perception and information processing capabilities of motorists, but also on how far away they can adequately view the message. Stated another way, available viewing distance (coupled with the speed that the motorist is traveling) dictates the amount of time that the motorist has available to read a DMS. The viewing distance from a motorist to a DMS viewed straight on that is necessary to read a message of a given length (in terms of units of information presented) is illustrated in Figure 7.1. Any obstruction that comes between the motorist and the sign within this viewing distance will hinder the motorist from reading the entire message. At higher speeds, distances as great as 800 feet are needed for messages that contain 4 units of information.
Figure 7.1 Required Viewing Distances to a DMS
The values in Figure 7.1 are for DMSs mounted directly over the travel lanes. However, for DMSs positioned off to the side of the roadway (either permanent-mounted or portable), additional sight distance is required to ensure that the message is read entirely while still within
Available viewing distance to the DMS (coupled with
traveling speed) dictates the amount of time the
motorist has to read the sign.
Any obstruction that comes between the motorist and
the DMS within this viewing distance will hinder the
motorist from reading the entire message.
0
250
500
750
1000
0 1 2 3 4
Number of Units of Information
Re
qu
ire
d V
iew
ing
Dis
tan
ce
(ft)
35 mph
55 mph
65 mph
75 mph
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-2
the driver’s field of vision (assumed to be 10° right or left of head-on viewing). The distances that should be added to the values in Figure 7.1 for a given lateral offset between the motorist and the center of the DMS are shown in Figure 7.2. Note that the additional sight distance required can be quite significant for larger offsets, adding 300 feet or more to the necessary sight distance between the motorist and the DMS.
Figure 7.2 Additional Sight Distance Required For Lateral DMS Offset
The maximum distance at which a motorist can first correctly identify letters and words on a DMS is termed the legibility distance of the sign. In some situations, a motorist may not be able to utilize the maximum possible legibility distance (and thus, viewing time) from a DMS. Lighting conditions (day vs. night and position of the sun) can reduce the legibility distance to the DMS. Roadway geometric features such as vertical or horizontal curvature (around sight obstructions) can restrict a motorist’s sight distance to a DMS. Spot obstructions such as overpasses and sign bridges can also restrict DMS viewing distances, particularly for signs mounted over the travel lanes. A number of environmental factors or conditions also impact DMS visibility. Rain and fog (and even snow) all scatter and block light rays from a DMS as that light travels through the atmosphere. Finally, the presence of a significant number of trucks on the roadway will likewise limit the ability of motorists to adequately view a DMS positioned on the side of the roadway.
Just as factors such as reduced lane widths and sharp grades reduce the ideal traffic-carrying capacity of a roadway, one or more of these conditions can constrain the available DMS viewing
THE LEGIBILITY DISTANCE TO A DMS MAY
BE LESS THAN EXPECTED BECAUSE OF:
• Lighting conditions,
• Sun position,
• Vertical curvature,
• Horizontal curvature,
• Spot obstructions,
• Rain or fog, and
• Trucks in the traffic stream.
THERFORE, THE MAXIMUM ALLOWABLE
NUMBER OF UNITS OF INFORMATION MAY
HAVE TO BE REDUCED.
0
100
200
300
400
0 20 40 60
Offset Between Motorist and VMS (ft)
Ad
dit
ion
al S
igh
t D
ista
nc
e
Re
qu
ire
d (
ft)
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-3
distances to values lower than what are ideal. This means that there may not always be enough viewing time for a motorist to read a DMS message providing 4 units of information (5 units on lower speed roadways), and so shorter messages may have to be used.
Adjustments that may need to be made to the Base Maximum Message Length assumed to be available for a particular type of DMS are described in the following sections for five major conditions:
• Day and night operations, • Vertical curves, • Horizontal curves, • Presence of a large proportion of trucks, and • Presence of rain or fog.
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-4
7.2 MAXIMUM DMS LEGIBILITY DISTANCES FOR DAY
AND NIGHT OPERATIONS
The maximum distance at which a motorist can first correctly identify letters and words on a DMS is termed the legibility distance of the sign. This distance depends on the design characteristics of the sign. Key design parameters are the type of display technology (light-emitting, light-reflecting, etc.), height and width of the characters, the stroke width of the characters, and the type of font displayed. Legibility distances proposed for use in DMS message design (based on results of several studies) are presented in Table 7.1. These distances represent standard font (all uppercase), 18-inch character heights, 13-inch (approximate) character widths, and about 2.5-inch stroke (pixel) widths. Smaller characters would yield shorter distances.
The legibility distances shown in Table 7.1 affect the maximum number of units of information that should be displayed on a DMS which will allow motorists to read and comprehend the message at prevailing highway operating speeds. Based on these distances, the maximum number of informational units that motorists can actually read and comprehend in a DMS message is summarized in Table 7.2. These numbers establish the Base Maximum Message Length.
Table 7.1 Suggested DMS Legibility Distances for Use in Message Design (ft)
Condition
Light-Emitting
DiodeA
Fiberoptic
Incandescent
Bulb Reflective Disk
Mid-Day 800 700 700 700 Washout 800 700 700 400 Backlight 600 400 400 200 Nighttime 600 600 600 350 A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs
MO
DU
LE 7 Establishing the Maxim
um M
essage Length Page 7-5
Table 7.2 Maximum Number of Units of Information in DMS Message
(Base Maximum Message Length)
Light-Emitting DiodeA
Fiberoptic Incandescent Bulb Reflective Disk Condition
0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units 5 units 4 units 3 units 5 units 4 units 3 units 5 units 4 units 3 units Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units 5 units 4 units 3 units 5 units 4 units 3 units 4 units 3 units 2 units Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units 4 units 3 units 2 units 4 units 3 units 2 units 2 units 1 unit 1 unit Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units 4 units 3 units 3 units 4 units 3 units 3 units 3 units 2 units 1 unit
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-6
7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR
VERTICAL CURVES - LED DMSs
INTRODUCTION
Generally speaking, permanent DMSs mounted above the travel lanes are not affected by the presence of crest vertical curves. Vertical curvature is established based on safe stopping sight distances to a rather small (i.e., 6-inch) object located on the roadway, based on the design speed of the roadway. The high (20 to 25 ft) typical mounting heights of permanent DMSs provide viewing distances over the curve which usually exceed the visual capabilities of the signs themselves. However, this is often not the case for portable DMS positioned on the shoulder of the roadway. Furthermore, conditions where actual operating speeds are higher than the design speed of the vertical curve can sometimes provide less viewing time than is normally assumed to exist.
A procedure for determining the potential influence of the vertical curve on the maximum number of information units that should be displayed on a DMS is given in Appendix A.
REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVE DESIGN SPEEDS 45 MPH AND ABOVE
No reductions in the number of units of information are required for LED DMSs. Therefore, use the Base Maximum Message Length shown in Table 7.2 for the traffic operating speed on the highway.
REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVE DESIGN SPEEDS BELOW 45 MPH
Vertical curve design speeds lower than 45 mph require that the number of informational units be reduced to account for the lower legibility. The number of units that must be subtracted from the Base Maximum Message Length shown in Table 7.2 when LED signs are used are given in Tables 7.3 and 7.4 for PERMANENT DMSs with mounting heights of 20 and 25 feet and offsets of 0, 20 and 60 feet. The number of units that must be subtracted from the Base Maximum Message Length shown in Table 7.2 when LED signs are used are given in Tables 7.5and 7.6 for PORTABLE DMSs with mounting heights of 7 and 10 feet and offsets of 20 and 60 feet.
EXAMPLES
Example 1
Question
A permanent LED DMS mounted 20 feet above the roadway is located to the right of a six-lane urban arterial. The sign is positioned such that the offset from the DMS to the motorist in the left lane is approximately 60 feet. It is located at the downstream end of a 600-foot crest vertical curve that is designed for 35 mph. Does the Base Maximum Message Length have to be reduced in this situation?
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-7
Answer
Yes. Using Table 7.3 for a 60-foot offset and 35 mph operating speed, the Base Maximum Message Length must be reduced by 3 units in all viewing conditions (mid-day, washout, backlight, and nighttime).
Example 2
Question
A portable LED DMS that is 7 feet high is located in the middle of a 20-foot median on a four-lane freeway with a 6-foot inside paved shoulder. The sign is placed on the downstream end of a 1200-foot crest vertical curve. The design speed of the curve is 60 mph. Does the curve constrain the amount of information that can be presented on the DMS?
Answer
Since the design speed of the curve is greater than 45 mph, a sight distance restriction is not expected for the portable DMS. No reduction in Base Maximum Message Length is necessary.
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-8
Table 7.3 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Vertical Curve
PERMANENT LED DMSA
Mounting Height: 20 feet
Vertical Curve Design Speed
Overhead 20-foot Offset 60-foot Offset
Condition 30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
Mid-Day 1 unit 0 unit 0 unit 2 units 0 unit 0 unit 5 units 3 units 1 unit Washout 1 unit 0 unit 0 unit 2 units 0 unit 0 unit 5 units 3 units 1 unit Backlight 0 unit 0 unit 0 unit 1 unit 0 unit 0 unit 4 units 3 units 1 unit Nighttime 0 unit 0 unit 0 unit 1 unit 0 unit 0 unit 4 units 3 units 1 unit
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs.
Table 7.4 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Vertical Curve
PERMANENT LED DMSA
Mounting Height: 25 feet
Vertical Curve Design Speed
Overhead 20-foot Offset 60-foot Offset
Condition 30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
Mid-Day 0 unit 0 unit 0 unit 2 units 1 unit 0 unit 5 units 4 units 1 unit Washout 0 unit 0 unit 0 unit 2 units 1 unit 0 unit 5 units 4 units 1 unit Backlight 0 unit 0 unit 0 unit 1 unit 0 unit 0 unit 4 units 3 units 1 unit Nighttime 0 unit 0 unit 0 unit 1 unit 0 unit 0 unit 4 units 3 units 1 unit
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs.
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-9
Table 7.5 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted
from Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Vertical Curve
PORTABLE LED DMSA
Mounting Height: 7 feet
Vertical Curve Design Speed
20-foot Offset 60-foot Offset
Condition 30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
Mid-Day 3 units 2 units 1 unit 5 units 5 units 3 units Washout 3 units 2 units 1 unit 5 units 5 units 3 units Backlight 2 units 1 unit 1 unit 4 units 4 units 2 units Nighttime 2 units 1 unit 1 unit 4 units 4 units 2 units
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs.
Table 7.6 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted
from Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Vertical Curve
PORTABLE LED DMSA
Mounting Height: 10 feet
Vertical Curve Design Speed
20-foot Offset 60-foot Offset
Condition 30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
30
mph
35
mph
40
mph
Mid-Day 2 units 2 units 1 unit 5 units 4 units 3 units Washout 2 units 2 units 1 unit 5 units 4 units 3 units Backlight 1 unit 1 unit 0 unit 4 units 3 units 2 units Nighttime 1 unit 1 unit 0 unit 4 units 3 units 2 units
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs.
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-10
7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR
HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs
INTRODUCTION
Whereas vertical curvature design is based on stopping sight distance, design criteria for horizontal curvature is based on driver comfort and the friction between the tires and the roadway. With respect to DMS visibility and viewing time, horizontal curvature generally does not impact permanent DMSs mounted over travel lanes. Likewise, permanent DMS mounted adjacent to the travel lanes (in the median or off to the right) will extend above most obstructions that may exist on the roadside and so are not affected by any horizontal curvature (although certain spot obstructions such as overhead signs or luminaires may be more problematic to DMS viewing on horizontal curves).
However, the situation is different for portable DMSs placed on the side of the road within the curve (on the right side of a right-hand curve, on the left side of a left-hand curve). If an object (construction vehicle, tree, etc.) is located close to the edge of a roadway on the same side as the DMS, a driver in the closest lane may not be able to see around the object and fully read and comprehend the message. The detailed process to assess whether an obstruction may constrain the reading time of a portable DMS around a horizontal curve is described in Appendix B.
REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES FOR PERMANENT DMSs
No reduction is necessary for permanent DMSs.
REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES FOR PORTABLE DMSs
Tables 7.7 through 7.9 give the number of units of information that must be subtracted from the Basic Maximum Message Length when LED signs are used and the portable DMS is offset 2 feet. Similar numbers to subtract when the portable DMS is offset 10 feet are given in Tables 7.10 through 7.12.
EXAMPLES
Example 1
Question
A portable LED DMS is to be placed 2 feet from the edge of travel lanes on a rural highway upstream of a work zone toward the end of a long (2500 ft) horizontal curve. Traffic speeds on the roadway average 65 mph. A bridge overpass abutment is located upstream of the DMS along the curve as well. The abutment is 50 feet from the edge of the travel lane. The curve radius is 1500 feet. The DMS will not be in washout or backlighted conditions during the day, and will not have overhead lighting present at night. Does the Base Maximum Message Length have to be reduced in this situation?
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-11
Answer
For the characteristics identified, go to Table 7.9. A curve radius of 1500 feet and obstruction offset of 50 feet does not require a reduction in Base Maximum Message Length for either the backlight overhead or nighttime viewing conditions. However, it does require a 1 unit reduction for mid-day and washout.
Example 2
Question
A portable DMS is to be used to assist in providing trailblazer information along a detour route for a section of freeway. The sign will be placed 10 feet from the travel lanes. The diversion route is an urban arterial with vehicle operating speeds about 40 mph. The operating agency is contemplating the location of the sign towards the end of the 750-foot horizontal curve with curve radius of 500 feet. A brick wall located 20 feet from the roadway is used to separate the roadway from the adjacent neighborhood. Does the curve constrain the amount of information that can be presented on the DMS?
Answer
For the characteristics identified, go to Table 7.11. A curve radius of 500 feet and obstruction offset of 20 feet does require the Base Maximum Message Length to be reduced by 4 units in the mid-day and washout viewing conditions, and reduced by 3 units under backlight and nighttime viewing conditions. In effect, not enough sight distance is available at this location to provide any information on a portable DMS. An alternative location for the DMS should be found.
MO
DU
LE 7 Establishing the Maxim
um M
essage Length Page 7-12
Table 7.7 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Horizontal Curve
PORTABLE LED DMSA
Offset: 2 feet
Traffic Operating Speeds: 0-35 mph
Mid-Day and Washout Backlight and Nighttime
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Curve
Radii (ft)
10 20 50 100 150 200 250 10 20 50 100 150 200 250 250500750
1000
1250150017502000
2250250027503000
400050007500
10000
4 units 4 units 4 units 3 units
3 units 3 units 3 units 3 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
4 units 3 units 2 units 2 units
2 units 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit
2 units 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 3 units 3 units 3 units 2 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1unit
3 units 2 units 2 units 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs.
MO
DU
LE 7 Establishing the Maxim
um M
essage Length Page 7-13
Table 7.8 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Horizontal Curve
PORTABLE LED DMSA
Offset: 2 feet
Traffic Operating Speeds: 36-55 mph
Mid-Day and Washout Backlight and Nighttime
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Curve
Radii (ft)
10 20 50 100 150 200 250 10 20 50 100 150 200 250 250500750
1000
1250150017502000
2250250027503000
400050007500
10000
N/A 3 units 3 units 3 units
3 units 3 units 3 units 3 units
3 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
2 units 2 units 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 3 units 3 units 2 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 2 units 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 1 unit
N/A N/A N/A N/A 3 units 3 units 3 units
3 units 3 units 3 units 3 units
3 units 2 units 2 units 2units
2 units 2 units 1 unit
N/A 3 units 3 units 2 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 2 units 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 1 unit
N/A N/A N/A
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs. N/A Adequate sight distance not available for any message.
MO
DU
LE 7 Establishing the Maxim
um M
essage Length Page 7-14
Table 7.9 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Horizontal Curve
PORTABLE LED DMSA
Offset: 2 feet
Traffic Operating Speeds: 56-70 mph
Mid-Day and Washout Backlight and Nighttime
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Curve
Radii (ft)
10 20 50 100 150 200 250 10 20 50 100 150 200 250 250500750
1000
1250150017502000
2250250027503000
400050007500
10000
N/A N/A
3 units 3 units
3 units 3 units 3 units 3 units
3 units 3 units 3 units 3 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
N/A N/A
3 units 3 units
3 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
1 unit
N/A N/A
2 units 2 units
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
N/A N/A
1 unit
N/A N/A
N/A N/A N/A N/A
2 units 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
N/A N/A
1 unit 1 unit
1 unit
N/A N/A
N/A N/A
N/A N/A
N/A N/A
N/A N/A
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs. N/A Adequate sight distance not available for any message.
MO
DU
LE 7 Establishing the Maxim
um M
essage Length Page 7-15
Table 7.10 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Horizontal Curve
PORTABLE LED DMSA
Offset: 10 feet
Traffic Operating Speeds: 0-35 mph
Mid-Day and Washout Backlight and Nighttime
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Curve
Radii (ft)
10 20 50 100 150 200 250 10 20 50 100 150 200 250 250500750
1000
1250150017502000
2250250027503000
400050007500
10000
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
4 units 3 units 3 units 3 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit
2 units 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 4 units 4 units 4 units 4 units
4 units 4 units 4 units 4 units
4 units 4 units 4 units 4 units
4 units 4 units 4 units 4 units
3 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs.
MO
DU
LE 7 Establishing the Maxim
um M
essage Length Page 7-16
Table 7.11 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Horizontal Curve
PORTABLE LED DMSA
Offset: 10 feet
Traffic Operating Speeds: 36-55 mph
Mid-Day and Washout Backlight and Nighttime
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Curve
Radii (ft)
10 20 50 100 150 200 250 10 20 50 100 150 200 250 250500750
1000
1250150017502000
2250250027503000
400050007500
10000
N/A 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
N/A 4 units 4 units 4 units
3 units 3 units 3 units 3 units
3 units 3 units 2 units 2 units
2 units 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 3 units 2 units 2 units
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit
N/A 2 units 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 1 unit
N/A N/A 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
N/A 3 units 3 units 3 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
2 units 2 units 1 unit 1 unit
N/A 2 units
N/A 1 unit
N/A N/A N/A
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs. N/A Adequate sight distance not available for any message.
MO
DU
LE 7 Establishing the Maxim
um M
essage Length Page 7-17
Table 7.12 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Horizontal Curve
PORTABLE LED DMSA
Offset: 10 feet
Traffic Operating Speeds: 56-70 mph
Mid-Day and Washout Backlight and Nighttime
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Offset of Sight Obstruction from Edge of
Travel Lanes (feet)
Curve
Radii (ft)
10 20 50 100 150 200 250 10 20 50 100 150 200 250 250500750
1000
1250150017502000
2250250027503000
400050007500
10000
N/A N/A
5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
5 units 5 units 5 units 5 units
N/A N/A
4 units 4 units
4 units 4 units 4 units 3 units
3 units 3 units 3 units 3 units
3 units 2 units 2 units 1 unit
N/A N/A
3 units 3 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
1 unit
N/A N/A
2 units 1 unit
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
N/A N/A
1 unit 1 unit
1 unit
N/A 1 unit
N/A N/A N/A
4 units 4 units
4 units 4 units 4 units 4 units
4 units 4 units 4 units 4 units
4 units 4 units 4 units 4 units
N/A N/A
3 units 3 units
3 units 3 units 3 units 2 units
2 units 2 units 2 units 2 units
2 units 1 unit 1 unit
N/A N/A
2 units 2 units
1 unit 1 unit 1 unit
N/A N/A
1 unit
N/A N/A
N/A N/A
N/A N/A
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs. N/A Adequate sight distance not available for any message.
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-18
7.5 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN AND
FOG
Rain and fog are additional factors that can influence the amount of information that can be presented on a DMS. Both conditions deteriorate the amount of light that is coming from the DMS (either direct illumination from the light pixels on the DMS or reflected by the DMS from other light sources such as the sun, overhead lighting, or automobile headlights). This reduces the contrast between the sign legend and its background. If the contrast becomes too low, motorists cannot read the DMS message.
For light-emitting DMSs, contrast ratios are at their minimums on bright, sunny days because the sun increases the background luminance of the signs. Under cloudy conditions, the luminance of the legend will be much greater than the background and can create very large contrast ratios. Unfortunately, data on typical DMS background luminance or contrast ratios on cloudy, rainy, or foggy days are not available (in actuality, there may not be a true “typical” cloudy day anyway). Conversely, contrast ratios for light-reflecting DMSs decrease as external lighting levels decrease, becoming zero (or nearly so) as the amount of light falling on the sign reaches zero. A procedure for determining the effects of rain and fog on the number of units of information that can be displayed is given in Appendix C.
Because the majority of DMSs are light-emitting technologies, the following section is provided for those signs. The DMS operator should apply the detailed procedure in Appendix C forconsideration of light-reflecting DMS.
REDUCTIONS FOR RAIN
The effect of rainfall on desired DMS message lengths is believed to be relatively insignificant under most operating conditions. The exception to this situation is when rainfall intensities exceed 2 inches per hour. Under these conditions, the DMS operator should reduce the units of information on a portable LED DMS by one if the operating speed on the roadway exceeds 55 mph. Portable LED DMSs generally utilize fewer numbers of LEDs per pixel and so typically generate lower character luminance levels than permanent DMSs. The higher character luminance levels of permanent LED DMSs now in use is believed to provide significant contrast even under heavy rain.
REDUCTIONS FOR FOG
The effect of fog is more significant. The reductions in the base number of information units that can be displayed on a portable LED DMS under daytime conditions under various operating speed and DMS offset scenarios are presented in Table 7.13. As noted previously, reductions for permanent LED DMSs are not suggested due to their much higher character luminance values (and thus much higher contrast ratios).
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-19
EXAMPLE
Question
A portable LED DMS is being used in the median of a divided rural highway (offset between DMS and right lane motorist is 60 feet). A heavy fog is present that limits visibility to approximately 0.5 mile. Does this condition require a reduction in the Base Maximum Message Length? Answer
Using Table 7.13 for a 60-foot offset and an assumed traffic speed of greater than 56 mph (since it is a rural highway) and a 0.5-mi visibility, no reduction is necessary. If the fog had been thicker and reduced visibility to 0.25 mile, then the Base Maximum Message Length would have to be reduced by 2 units.
Table 7.13 Number of Units of Information that Must Be Subtracted from
Number Given in Table 7.2 Due to Effects of Fog in Daytime Conditions
PORTABLE LEDA DMS
No Offset 20-ft Offset 60-ft Offset Visibility
Range in
Fog 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
0.5 mi 0.25 mi 0.1 mi
00
2 units
00
2 units
01 unit 2 units
00
3 units
01 unit 3 units
01 unit 3 units
02 units 5 unitsB
02 units 4 unitsB
02 units 4 unitsB
A Valid only for the newer aluminum indium gallium phosphide (or equivalent) LEDs. B Adequate sight distance not available for any message under this viewing condition.
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-20
7.6 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS WHEN LARGE
TRUCKS ARE PRESENT
INTRODUCTION
Large trucks can be a major cause of sight obstructions to DMSs. Motorists in vehicles travelling closely behind or adjacent to a truck may be limited in the amount of time they have to read a DMS. If they follow too closely, they may not be able to see the DMS at all. This can occur in some instances for permanent overhead DMSs as well. However, the majority of concerns relating to trucks pertain to portable DMSs located off to the side of the travel lanes.
Evaluating truck obstructions of DMSs requires a slightly different analysis approach than that used for horizontal and vertical curvature. This is because a motorist has the ability to adjust his or her speed slightly relative to that of a truck and find a travel position that allows for adequate viewing. However, as the number of trucks on the roadway increases, the amount of roadway space that a motorist can travel in with an unobstructed view decreases. If the number of vehicles traveling on the facility approaches or exceeds the number that can “fit” into the unobstructed viewing spaces, then some motorists will not be able to read all of a DMS message. Depending on the specific message being presented, this can begin to create operational problems on the facility.
EFFECT OF LARGE TRUCKS ON DMS VIEWING
A detailed procedure to assess the impact of large trucks on DMS viewing time is given in Appendix D. This procedure computes the amount of roadway space available for adequate DMS viewing and compares it to the amount of traffic on the roadway that needs to use that space. In this section, this analysis is simplified to a series of tables designed to assist the operator in determining the influence of large trucks on the ability of motorists in the overall traffic stream to adequately read a DMS message containing the maximum base number of information units.
Tables 7.14 through 7.17 present the estimated percentage of motorists on the roadway who would likely be able to read an entire DMS message that consists of the maximum base number of units of information. Separate tables are provided for four major roadway cross-sections (two-lane, two-way highway; four-lane roadway; six-lane roadway; and eight-lane roadway). The numbers represent average conditions for messages on high-quality LED DMSs. Assumptions have been made regarding the distribution of large trucks across the various travel lanes in a given direction. These assumptions are noted at the bottom of the tables. The percentages also assume that all truck drivers will be able to adequately see the DMS (since they sit higher than a typical automobile).
The tables illustrate how quickly viewing conditions can degrade as truck volumes increase. The point of the tables is not to define a specific threshold between acceptable and unacceptable viewing conditions for DMSs. Rather, the information contained in the tables should be used in deciding when less information should be presented on a DMS, or where a redundant DMS may be needed. If redundant DMS are used, consideration should also be given to placing them on
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-21
the left side of the roadway (the percentages in the tables assume the DMS is placed on the right side of the roadway 10 feet from the travel lanes).
Table 7.14 Percent of Motorists Able to Fully Read a DMS Message
with Maximum Base Number of Units (Two-Lane, Two-Way Highway)
Operating Speed Range
0-35 mph 36-55 mph 56-70 mph Percent
Trucks500
vph
1000
vph
1500
vph
500
vph
1000
vph
1500
vph
500
vph
1000
vph
1500
vph
5 10 20 30 50
9595909085
9590807570
9085706555
10095909085
9590858075
9585756560
10095909090
9590858075
90807060
50** Under these conditions, only truck drivers are assumed to be able to see the DMS. vph = vehicles per hour.
Table 7.15 Percent of Motorists Able to Fully Read a DMS Message
with Maximum Base Number of Units (Four-Lane Roadway: Two Lanes in Each Direction)
Operating Speed Range
0-35 mph 36-55 mph 56-70 mph Percent
Trucks1000
vph
2000
vph
3000
vph
1000
vph
2000
vph
3000
vph
1000
vph
2000
vph
3000
vph
5 10 20 30 50
9590807570
90806550
50*
857045
30*50*
9590807570
90806555
50*
85704530
50*
9590857575
90806555
50*
806540
30*50*
Note: Assumes an 85%/15% split of truck traffic in shoulder and median travel lanes. * Under these conditions, only truck drivers are assumed to be able to see the DMS. vph = vehicles per hour
MODULE 7 Establishing the Maximum Message Length Page 7-22
Table 7.16 Percent of Motorists Able to Fully Read a DMS Message
with Maximum Base Number of Units (Six-Lane Roadway: Three Lanes in Each Direction)
Operating Speed Range
0-35 mph 36-55 mph 56-70 mph Percent
Trucks2000
vph
4000
vph
6000
vph
2000
vph
4000
vph
6000
vph
2000
vph
4000
vph
6000
vph
5 10 20 30 50
90806050
50*
755525
30*50*
6535
20*30*50*
90806550
50*
806025
30*50*
6535
20*30*50*
90806550
50*
806025
30*50*
6540
20*30*50*
Note: Assumes an 85%/15%/0% split of truck traffic in shoulder, center, and median travel lanes, respectively. * Under these conditions, only truck drivers are assumed to be able to see the DMS. vph = vehicles per hour.
Table 7.17 Percent of Motorists Able to Fully Read a DMS Message
with Maximum Base Number of Units (Eight-Lane Roadway: Four Lanes in Each Direction)
Operating Speed Range
0-35 mph 36-55 mph 56-70 mph Percent
Trucks2000
vph
4000
vph
6000
vph
2000
vph
4000
vph
6000
vph
2000
vph
4000
vph
6000
vph
5 10 20 30 50
90806560
50*
806035
30*50*
7045
20*30*50*
90807060
50*
806535
30*50*
7045
20*30*50*
90806555
50*
806535
30*50*
7045
20*30*50*
Note: Assumes a 70%/20%/10%/0% split of truck traffic in shoulder, right center, left center, and median travel lanes, respectively.
* Under these conditions, only truck drivers are assumed to be able to see the DMS. vph = vehicles per hour.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-i
MODULE 8. DEALING WITH LONG MESSAGES
TABLE OF CONTENTS
8.1 SPLITTING MESSAGES ................................................................................... 8-1 NO MORE THAN TWO PHASES SHOULD BE USED................................................ 8-1 EACH PHASE MUST BE UNDERSTOOD BY ITSELF................................................ 8-1 COMPATIBLE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON THE SAME PHASE ............................................................................................................ 8-2 A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATION ...................................................................................... 8-3 NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS .................. 8-3 8.2 APPROACHES TO REDUCING MESSAGE LENGTH ................... 8-5 DELETING “DEAD” WORDS ....................................................................................... 8-5 Street, Avenue or Boulevard ....................................................................................... 8-5 Ahead........................................................................................................................... 8-5 FORMATTING MESSAGES........................................................................................... 8-6 Messages WITH Incident Descriptor Message Element............................................. 8-6 Messages WITH Roadwork Descriptor Message Element ......................................... 8-7 Messages WITHOUT Incident Descriptor Message Element .................................... 8-8 Messages WITHOUT Roadwork Descriptor Message Element................................. 8-9 USING ABBREVIATIONS............................................................................................ 8-10 Acceptable Abbreviations ......................................................................................... 8-10 Unacceptable Abbreviations ..................................................................................... 8-10 8.3 REDUCING MESSAGE UNITS OF INFORMATION..................... 8-13 REFORMATTING THE MESSAGE ............................................................................. 8-13 8.4 REDUCING UNITS OF INFORMATION FROM THE BASE DMS MESSAGE .................................................................................................... 8-14 INITIAL REDUCTION APPROACHES ....................................................................... 8-14 Reducing Redundancy in Incident and Roadwork Messages ................................... 8-14 Omitting Reference to Same Freeway as Incident/Roadwork and DMS ............ 8-14 Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages.............................................. 8-15 Combining Incident Descriptor, Location and Lanes Closed Message Elements .......................................................................................................... 8-15 Combining Location of Closure Message Element and Action Message Element ........................................................................................................... 8-16
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-ii
Combining Message Elements for Roadwork Messages .......................................... 8-17 Combining Roadwork Descriptor Message Element with Lanes Closed Message Element ............................................................................................ 8-17 Combining Roadwork Descriptor, Closure Location and Lanes Closed Message Elements........................................................................................... 8-18 Combining Location of Closure Message Element and Action Message Element ........................................................................................................... 8-18 SECONDARY REDUCTION APPROACH ................................................................. 8-19 Reducing the Number of Definitions in the Action Message Element ..................... 8-19 PRIORITY REDUCTION PRINCIPLES ....................................................................... 8-20
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-1
MODULE 8. DEALING WITH LONG MESSAGES After the DMS message designer selects the necessary elements of the Base DMS Message, in many cases the message will be too long. That is, it may exceed the number of message units that motorists can read and understand while traveling at the prevailing freeway speeds, or it may exceed the physical limitations of the DMS itself. Guidelines and helpful hints for reducing the length of messages are presented in this section of the Manual. 8.1 SPLITTING MESSAGES When a DMS message is too long to fit on one phase, it can be split and displayed on multiple phases that are shown sequentially. The DMS is best formatted into a horizontal rectangular space consisting of two lines on one message phase and two lines on the second phase. On large overhead signs, each line typically has two words (or three if within line capacity). On portable DMSs, each line typically has one word when abbreviations are not used. When it is necessary to divide a message and display it on multiple phases, the five principles below must be used. 1. NO MORE THAN TWO PHASES SHOULD BE USED Research has shown that for the typical three- or four-line DMSs, motorists have difficulty in reading messages displayed on more than two phases. 2. EACH PHASE MUST BE UNDERSTOOD BY ITSELF Each message phase must be understood by itself because either phase may be read first by the passing motorist. Typically, the problem and location appear on the first phase and the advisory and attention statement (if needed) on the second phase. The following two examples help illustrate Principle 2. Example of an UNACCEPTABLE MESSAGE SPLIT with a phase that is not understood by itself
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT I-10
GALVESTON TRAFFIC
USE I-610 EAST
Phase 1
Phase 2
MESSAGE SPLITTING PRINCIPLES: ! No more than two phases should be used; ! Each phase must be understood by itself; ! Compatible units of information should be displayed
on the same phase; ! A message line should not contain portions of two
different units of information; and ! No more than three units of information should be
displayed on a single phase at high freeway speeds.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-2
In Phase 1, the message MAJOR ACCIDENT/ AT I-10/ GALVESTON TRAFFIC is not understood by itself. This is because the Audience (GALVESTON TRAFFIC) is not compatible with the Incident Descriptor and Incident Location message elements. The Audience message element should be combined with the Action (USE I-610 EAST) so that the two terms GALVESTON and USE I-610 EAST are on the same message phase as shown below. Example of an ACCEPTABLE MESSAGE SPLIT with each phase understood by itself
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT I-10
GALVESTON USE I-610 EAST
Phase 1
Phase 2
3. COMPATIBLE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON THE
SAME PHASE Compatible units of information should be displayed on the same phase. The previous examples shown for Principle 2 also help to illustrate Principle 3. The Incident Descriptor (MAJOR ACCIDENT) and the Incident Location (AT I-10) message elements are compatible and can be displayed on the same phase. Also, the Audience (GALVESTON) and Action (USE I-610 EAST) message elements are compatible and can be displayed on the same phase. In contrast, the Audience (GALVESTON) message element is not compatible with the Incident Descriptor (MAJOR ACCIDENT) and the Incident Location (USE I-610 EAST). Additional illustrations of the violation of Principle 3 and the corrected message are shown in the examples below. The first example (UNACCEPTABLE MESSAGE SPLIT) shows two Action message elements that are split. One action is on the first phase and the second action on the second phase. The two Action message elements should be displayed on the same message phase as shown in the second example (ACCEPTABLE MESSAGE SPLIT). Example of an UNACCEPTABLE MESSAGE SPLIT with phase that is not compatible
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER DR EXIT AT RT 20
USE
OTHER ROUTES
Phase 1
Phase 2
Example of an ACCEPTABLE MESSAGE SPLIT with each phase compatible
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER DR
EXIT AT RT-20 USE
OTHER ROUTES
Phase 1
Phase 2
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-3
(Note: The above message is used for illustrative purposes. It is common practice in TxDOT Districts not to suggest specific ramps, highways, or streets to motorists other than freeways.) 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT
UNITS OF INFORMATION Sometimes, two interrelated units of information are too long for each to fit on one line when it is desirable to display both in the same message phase. The temptation, at times, is to “squeeze” both units of information on the same phase by splitting each unit and displaying portions of each unit on the same line. This should be avoided because it confuses motorists and increases reading time. An example of an unacceptable message split is shown below. Note the unacceptable splitting and combining of portions of the two message units of information in Phase 2 (i.e., combining DRIVE and USE on the second line of Phase 2 from the two units of information EXIT AT RIVER DRIVE and USE OTHER ROUTES). Example of an UNACCEPTABLE SPLITTING AND COMBINING PORTIONS OF TWO MESSAGE UNITS
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RT-20
EXIT AT RIVER DRIVE USE
OTHER ROUTES
Phase 1
Phase 2
(Note: The above message is used for illustrative purposes. It is common practice in TxDOT Districts not to suggest specific ramps, highways, or streets to motorists other than freeways.) In most cases, the unacceptable message can be corrected by using better terms in the message phase or by using abbreviations. In the example above, the unacceptable message can be corrected by using abbreviations as shown in the acceptable message below. Example of an ACCEPTABLE MESSAGE SPLIT
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RT-20
EXIT AT RIVER DR USE
OTHER ROUTES
Phase 1
Phase 2
5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED
ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS Research has shown that, at typical freeway speeds, no more than three units of information should be displayed on a single message phase. Phase 2 in the example below has the following four units of information that motorists destined to Dallas and to I-35 East (two Audiences) must read in order to make a diversion decision:
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-4
! Unit 1 – BEST ROUTE TO; ! Unit 2 – DALLAS; ! Unit 3 – I-35 E; and ! Unit 4 – USE I-30. The four-unit message phase is too complex for motorists to read and understand while traveling at high freeway speeds. Example of an UNACCEPTABLE MESSAGE PHASE with four units of information (Phase 2)
3 LANES CLOSED AT US-377
BEST ROUTE TO DALLAS/ I-35 E
USE I-30
Phase 1
Phase 2
One alternative solution is to direct the Action message element to only one of the two Audiences. The decision would need to be made whether it is best to advise motorists destined to Dallas or destined to I-35 East. In the acceptable message below, the Action is directed to the Dallas-bound motorists. Example of an ACCEPTABLE MESSAGE PHASE with three units of information (Phase 2)
3 LANES CLOSED AT US-377
BEST ROUTE TO DALLAS USE I-30
Phase 1
Phase 2
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-5
8.2 APPROACHES TO REDUCING MESSAGE LENGTH Always look for ways to reduce the message length without losing the intent of the message by: ! Deleting “dead” words, and/or ! Reformatting the message. DELETING “DEAD” WORDS “Dead” words should be deleted whenever possible. “Dead” words are ones that 99 percent of local motorists would assume without being told. Street, Avenue or Boulevard One example of a “dead” word is the use of “street,” “avenue,” or “boulevard” following a familiar arterial name. These words are not required and could be omitted. There are exceptions to this principle that are discussed on page 4-9. Ahead Another “dead” word is “ahead.” It is not necessary to tell motorists that an incident or roadwork is “ahead” when the DMS is on the same freeway as the event because it will be understood by motorists that the event is ahead.
MESSAGE LENGTH CAN BE REDUCED BY: ! Omitting “dead” words; and/or ! Reformatting the message. MESSAGE LENGTH CAN ALSO BE REDUCED BY ! Using abbreviations.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-6
FORMATTING MESSAGES The order of information is dependent upon whether: ! An Incident Descriptor or Roadwork Descriptor message element is part of the message; or ! The Incident Descriptor or Roadwork Descriptor message element is replaced by or
combined with a Lanes Closed message element. (See Module 12 Modifying Messages to Improve Effectiveness for reformatting examples.) Messages WITH Incident Descriptor Message Element The format order for messages that contain an Incident Descriptor message element (e.g., ACCIDENT) is summarized in Table 8.1 for the cases when lane-closure (blockage) incidents occur or when incidents occur that require closing the freeway.
Table 8.1 Format Order When Incident Descriptor Message Element is Used for Incidents
Message Elements for Lane Closure Incidents
Message Elements for Freeway Closure Incidents
1. Incident Descriptor 2. Incident Location 3. Lanes Closed (Blocked) 4. Audience for Action (if needed) 5. Action 6. Good Reason for Following ActionA
1. Incident Descriptor 2. Incident Location 3. Lanes Closed (Blocked) 4. Audience for Action (if needed) 5. Action
A When BEST ROUTE TO is used as the Good Reason, then the Good Reason for Following Action message element is placed before the Action message element. When the message is split into two phases, then the combinations of formatting shown in Table 8.2 should be used:
Table 8.2 Format Order for Two-Phase Messages When Incident Descriptor Message Element is Used for Incidents
Message Phase 1 Message Phase 2 1. Incident Descriptor 2. Incident Location
3. Lanes Closed (Blocked) 4. Action
1. Incident Descriptor 2. Incident Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action
1. Incident Descriptor 2. Incident Location 3. Lanes Closed (Blocked)
4. Audience for Action 5. Action
1. Incident Descriptor 2. Incident Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action 5. Good Reason for Following ActionA
A When BEST ROUTE TO is used as the Good Reason, then the Good Reason for Following Action message element is placed before the Action message element.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-7
Messages WITH Roadwork Descriptor Message Element The format order for messages that contain a Roadwork Descriptor message element (e.g., ROADWORK) is summarized in Table 8.3 for the cases when lane closures occur due to roadwork and when the roadwork requires closing the freeway.
Table 8.3 Format Order When Roadwork Descriptor Message Element is Used for Roadwork
Message Elements for Lane Closures
Message Elements for Freeway Closures
1. Roadwork Descriptor 2. Lane Closure Location 3. Lanes Closed 4. Audience for Action (if needed) 5. Action 6. Good Reason for Following ActionA
1. Roadwork Descriptor 2. Closure Location 3. Lanes Closed 4. Audience for Action (if needed) 5. Action
A When BEST ROUTE TO is used as the Good Reason, then the Good Reason for Following Action message element is placed before the Action message element. When the message is split into two phases, then the combinations of formatting shown in Table 8.4 should be used.
Table 8.4 Format Order for Two-Phase Messages When Roadwork Descriptor Message Element is Used for Roadwork
Message Phase 1 Message Phase 2 1. Roadwork Descriptor 2. Lane Closure Location
3. Lanes Closed 4. Action
1. Roadwork Descriptor 2. Lane Closure Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action
1. Roadwork Descriptor 2. Lane Closure Location 3. Lanes Closed
4. Audience for Action 5. Action
1. Roadwork Descriptor 2. Lane Closure Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action 5. Good Reason for Following ActionA
A When BEST ROUTE TO is used as the Good Reason, then the Good Reason for Following Action message element is placed before the Action message element.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-8
Messages WITHOUT Incident Descriptor Message Element The format order for messages in which the Incident Descriptor message element is replaced by or combined with a Lanes Closed message element is shown in Table 8.5.
Table 8.5 Format Order When Incident Descriptor Message Element is Replaced By or Combined With the Lanes Closed Message Element
for Incidents Message Elements for
Lane Closure Incidents Message Elements for
Freeway Closure Incidents 1. Lanes Closed (Blocked) 2. Lane Closure (Blockage) Location 3. Audience for Action (if needed) 4. Action 5. Good Reason for Following ActionA
1. Freeway Closure (Blocked) 2. Location of Closure 3. Audience for Action (if needed) 4. Action 5. Good Reason for Following ActionA
A When BEST ROUTE TO is used as the Good Reason, then the Good Reason for Following Action message element is placed before the Action message element. When the message is split into two phases, then the combinations of formatting shown in Table 8.6 should be used.
Table 8.6 Format Order for Two-Phase Messages When Incident Descriptor Message Element is Replaced By or Combined With the
Lanes Closed Message Element for Incidents Message Phase 1 Message Phase 2
1. Lanes Closed (Blocked) 2. Lane Closure (Blockage) Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action
1. Lanes Closed (Blocked) 2. Lane Closure (Blockage) Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action 5. Good Reason for Following ActionA
1. Freeway Closed (Blocked) 2. Location of Closure
3. Audience for Action 4. Action
A When BEST ROUTE TO is used as the Good Reason, then the Good Reason for Following Action message element is placed before the Action message element.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-9
Messages WITHOUT Roadwork Descriptor Message Element The format order for messages in which the Roadwork Descriptor message element is replaced by or combined with a Lanes Closed message element is shown in Table 8.7.
Table 8.7 Format Order When Incident Descriptor Message Element is Replaced By or Combined With the Lanes Closed Message Element
for Roadwork Message Elements for
Lane Closures Message Elements for
Freeway Closures 1. Lanes Closed 2. Lane Closure Location 3. Audience for Action (if needed) 4. Action 5. Good Reason for Following ActionA
1. Freeway Closed 2. Closure Location 3. Audience for Action (if needed) 4. Action
A When BEST ROUTE TO is used as the Good Reason, then the Good Reason for Following Action message element is placed before the Action message element. When the message is split into two phases, then the combinations of formatting shown in Table 8.8 should be used.
Table 8.8 Format Order for Two-Phase Messages When Roadwork Descriptor Message Element is Replaced By or
Combined With the Lanes Closed Message Element for Roadwork
Message Phase 1 Message Phase 2 1. Lanes Closed 2. Lane Closure Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action
1. Lanes Closed 2. Lane Closure Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action 5. Good Reason for Following ActionA
1. Freeway Closed 2. Closure Location
3. Audience for Action 4. Action
A When BEST ROUTE TO is used as the Good Reason, then the Good Reason for Following Action message element is placed before the Action message element.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-10
USING ABBREVIATIONS Acceptable Abbreviations Table 8.9 shows the message words and terms with abbreviations that were understood by 85 percent or more of either Texas drivers tested in 1997 and 2000, or drivers in a study conducted in 1983 by Dudek and his colleagues. These abbreviations are acceptable for use on DMSs for Texas drivers. Unacceptable Abbreviations Results of human factors studies revealed a group of abbreviations that were not understood by 85 percent or more of the drivers tested in Texas, and are therefore unacceptable for use on DMSs in Texas. A list of these abbreviations is shown in Table 8.10.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-11
Table 8.9 ACCEPTABLE Abbreviation Terms For Texas Drivers
Word or Phrase ACCEPTABLE Abbreviation Term Word or Phrase ACCEPTABLE
Abbreviation Term Access Access Road Accident At Ahead Aquarium Avenue Blocked Boulevard Bridge Center Center Lane Chemical Spill Closed Construction Downtown East Emergency Emergency Vehicle Exit Express Lanes Expressway Freeway Freeway Blocked Freeway Closed Friday Hazardous Highway Information Interstate Lane Left Left Lane Level
NO ACCS ACCES RD ACCDT AT [incident, distance ,etc.] AHD [name] AQRM AVE LANE BLKD FREEWAY BLKD [name] BLVD [name] BRDG CNTR CNTR LANE ARTS CNTR ARTS CTR CNTR LN CHEM SPILL EXPRESSWAY CLSD FREEWAY CLSD LANE CLSD LN CLSD CONST TO DWNTN E EMER EMER VEHICLE EMER VEH NEXT EXT EXP LANES EXP LNS [name] EXPWY [name] FWY [name] FRWY FWY BLKD FWY CLSD FRI HAZ DRIVING HWY HWY [number] [name] HWY INFO I-[number] IH-[number] CENTER LN LEFT LN RIGHT LN LFT KEEP LFT LFT LANE MERGE LFT LFT LN LOWER LVL UPPER LVL
Lower Level Maintenance Major Major Accident Mile(s) Minor Minor Accident Minute(s) Monday National Park North Oversized Parking Parking Lot Prepare Pavement Quality Right Right Lane Road Route Saturday Service Road Shoulder Slippery South Speed Street Sunday Thursday Traffic Traffic Clear Travelers Truck Stop Tuesday Turnpike Vehicle Upper Upper Level Warning Wednesday Weight West
LOWR LVL MAINT MAINT WORK MAJ ACCIDENT MAJ ACCDT [number] MI MNR ACCIDENT MNR ACCDT [number] MIN MON [name] NATL PRK N OVRSZ LOAD PKING PRK LOT PKING LOT PREP TO STOP WET PVMT AIR QLTY RGT KEEP RGT MERGE RGT RGT LANE RGT LN [name] RD BEST RTE TO RT [number] SAT SERV ROAD SERV RD ON SHLDR SOFT SHLDR SLIP S SPD LIMIT ST SUN THURS TRAF TRAF CLR TRVLRS TRK STOP TUES TO TRNPK [name] TRNPK STALLED VEH UPR LEVEL UPR LVL WARN WED WT LIMIT W
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-12
Table 8.10 UNACCEPTABLE Abbreviation Terms
Word/Phrase Abbreviation Tested Recommended Alternatives
Alternate Route Detour Route Feeder Road Frontage Road High Occupancy
Vehicle Lane Interchange 14 Incident at Major Congestion Road Work Vicinity of Eastbound Traffic Northbound Traffic Southbound Traffic Westbound Traffic [route] Eastbound [route] Northbound [route] Southbound [route]Westbound
ALT RT DETOUR RT FEED RD FRNTG RD HOV LANE INTCH 14 INCDT AT INCID AT MAJ CONG RD WK VIC OF EB TRAFFIC NB TRAFFIC SB TRAFFIC WB TRAFFIC [route] SB [route] EB [route] NB [route] WB
OTHER RTE DETOUR RTE FEEDER RD FRONTAGE RD Investigate other terms Use full word: INTERCHANGE 14 ACCDT AT ACCDT AT MAJ CONGESTION ROADWORK BEFORE, PAST, AT [route] E [route] N [route] S [route] W [route] E [route] N [route] S [route] W
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-13
8.3 REDUCING MESSAGE UNITS OF INFORMATION DMS messages should be as short as possible. Therefore, the message designer should look for ways to reduce long messages or Base DMS Messages that exceed the maximum number of information units that can be displayed for the given situation. Units of information can be reduced without losing information content or the important information required by motorists to make decision by: ! Omitting unimportant information; ! Omitting redundant information; and/or ! Combining Base DMS Message elements. REFORMATTING THE MESSAGE The message designer can sometimes be reduce units of information in a message by reformatting the message. At times it is possible to use alternative phrases that are understandable by motorists and have the same meaning as the original. The following example illustrates how message length can be reduced by reformatting.
The Original Message:
ROAD CLOSED AHEAD DUE TO CONSTRUCTION
FOLLOW DETOUR ROUTE
Can Be Shortened To:
ROAD CLOSED 1 MILE
FOLLOW DETOUR
With Better Results.
In the above, the most important message elements are the road is closed and the location of the closure. The reason DUE TO CONSTRUCTION is not necessary to display and can be omitted. In addition, the word AHEAD can be omitted because it is obvious to motorists by simply stating ROAD CLOSED.
UNITS OF INFORMATION CAN BE REDUCED BY: ! Omitting unimportant information; ! Omitting redundant information; and/or ! Combining Base DMS Message elements.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-14
8.4 REDUCING UNITS OF INFORMATION FROM THE BASE DMS MESSAGE
In most cases a Base DMS Message required for the incident or roadwork situation will contain more units of information than is acceptable to display for the prevailing freeway speed. Therefore, the number of units of information must be reduced. The DMS message designer should first use the Initial Reduction Approaches that are discussed in the section that follows. After these approaches are applied, then the message designer should follow the principles set discussed in Priority Reduction Principles on page 8-20. INITIAL REDUCTION APPROACHES The first step that the message designer should take to reduce the units of information of the Base DMS Message to an acceptable level is to apply the approaches discussed in this section. Approaches to reducing the number of units of information for both incidents and roadwork are presented in the sections that follow. Reducing Redundancy in Incident and Roadwork Messages Omitting Reference to Same Freeway as Incident/Roadwork and DMS It is not necessary nor is it desirable to make reference to the freeway if the DMS is on the same freeway as the incident/roadwork. For example, if a major accident occurs on northbound I-276 just past I-80 which blocks all the lanes, reference to ON I-276 NORTH should be omitted since this information is evident to motorists and increases the units of information and the length of the message.
Table 8.11 Example of Omitting Reference to Same Freeway as Incident/Roadwork and DMS
Message Elements Revised Message Elements Incident on Same Freeway (US-75 North) as DMS (US-75 North) Incident Descriptor MAJOR ACCIDENT ON US-75 NORTH Location PAST I-635 Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED
MAJOR ACCIDENT PAST I-635 ALL LANES CLOSED
THE NUMBER OF UNITS OF INFORMATION CONTAINED IN A BASE DMS MESSAGE CAN BE REDUCED BY: ! First applying the Initial Reduction Approaches; ! Then applying the Priority Reduction Principles.
INCIDENT AND ROADWORK MESSAGES CAN BE REDUCED BY: ! Omitting reference to same freeway as incident/
roadwork and DMS.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-15
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Combining Incident Descriptor, Location and Lanes Closed Message Elements In an effort to reduce the length of DMS messages, it is sometimes necessary and, in most cases, useful to combine the Incident Descriptor, Incident Location, and Lanes Closed message elements. For example, when a major accident occurs that blocks all of the lanes, the term FREEWAY BLOCKED can be used in place of the longer combination of MAJOR ACCIDENT and ALL LANES BLOCKED. Examples of combining Incident Descriptor, Incident Location and Lanes Closed message elements are shown in Table 8.12.
Table 8.12 Examples of Combining Incident Descriptor, Incident Location and Lanes Closed Message Elements
Message Elements Revised Message Elements Incident on Same Freeway (US-75 North) as DMS (US-75 North) Incident Descriptor MAJOR ACCIDENT Location AT ARAPAHO RD Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED
FREEWAY CLOSED AT ARAPAHO RD
Incident on Another Freeway (I-635 West) than DMS (US-75 North) Incident Descriptor MAJOR ACCIDENT Location ON I-635 WEST AT HILLSIDE RD Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED
I-635 WEST CLOSED AT HILLSIDE RD
Closed Roadway Due to Incident on Same Freeway (US-75 North) as DMS (US-75 North) Incident Descriptor TRUCK ACCIDENT Location PAST ARAPAHO RD Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED Location of Closure AT ARAPAHO RD Audience for Action US-75 NORTH TRAFFIC Action EXIT AT ARAPAHO RD FOLLOW DETOUR
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT ARAPAHO FOLLOW DETOUR
Closed Exit Ramp at Major Interchange (I-635) on Same Freeway (US-75 North) as DMS (US-75 North) Incident Descriptor MAJOR ACCIDENT Location ON I-635 WEST RAMP Lanes Closed RAMP CLOSED Location of Closure TO I-635 WEST Audience for Action I-635 WEST TRAFFIC Action EXIT FORREST LANE FOLLOW DETOUR
RAMP CLOSED TO I-635 WEST EXIT AT FORREST LANE FOLLOW DETOUR
INCIDENT MESSAGES CAN BE REDUCED BY: ! Combining Incident Descriptor, Incident Location,
and Lanes Closed message elements.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-16
Combining Location of Closure Message Element and Action Message Element When the freeway is closed and a detour route set in place with signs, police, and/or traffic control personnel, and the DMS is on the same freeway and close to the closure, then the Location of Closure message element becomes unnecessary to display because it will be contained in the Action message element. One of the examples in Table 8.12 is repeated here to illustrate the concept. In the table below, the Location of Closure (PAST ARAPAHO RD) is combined with the Action (EXIT AT ARAPAHO RD/ FOLLOW DETOUR) and should be omitted because it is redundant.
Table 8.13 Example of Combining Location of Closure Message Element With Action Message Element
Message Elements Revised Message Elements Closed Roadway Due to Incident on Same Freeway (US-75 North) as DMS (US-75 North) Incident Descriptor TRUCK ACCIDENT Location PAST ARAPAHO RD Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED Location of Closure AT ARAPAHO RD Audience for Action US-75 NORTH TRAFFIC Action EXIT AT ARAPAHO RD FOLLOW DETOUR
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT ARAPAHO RD FOLLOW DETOUR
WHEN THE FREEWAY IS CLOSED, INCIDENT MESSAGES CAN BE REDUCED FURTHER BY: ! Combining Location of Closure message element
and Action message element.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-17
Combining Message Elements for Roadwork Messages Combining Roadwork Descriptor Message Element with Lanes Closed Message Element When motorists are about to encounter roadwork on the freeway, it is more important for them to know that lanes are closed and, more specifically, which lanes are closed rather than be given information on a DMS that roadwork is taking place on the freeway. The information about the roadwork will ordinarily be displayed on static signs as part of the work zone traffic control plan, and displaying the information on a DMS is redundant and takes up space for more relevant information. For example, if roadwork requires closure of the two left freeway lanes, the Roadwork Descriptor (ROADWORK) can be omitted on the first line of the DMS and replaced with the Lanes Closed message element 2 LEFT LANES CLOSED. Examples of how the Roadwork Descriptor message element can be replaced with the Lanes Closed message element are shown in Table 8.14.
Table 8.14 Examples of Combining Roadwork Descriptor Message Element with Lanes Closed Message Element
Message Elements Revised Message Elements Roadwork on Same Freeway (US-75 North) as DMS (US-75 North) Roadwork Descriptor ROADWORK Lane Closure Location PAST ARAPAHO RD Lanes Closed LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED
LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED PAST ARAPAHO RD
Closed Roadway Due to Roadwork on Same Freeway (US-75 North) as DMS (US-75 North) Roadwork Descriptor ROADWORK Lane Closure Location PAST ARAPAHO RD Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED Location of Closure AT ARAPAHO RD Audience for Action US-75 NORTH TRAFFIC Action EXIT AT ARAPAHO RD FOLLOW DETOUR
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT ARAPAHO RD FOLLOW DETOUR
ROADWORK MESSAGES CAN BE REDUCED BY: ! Combining Roadwork Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element; or ! Combining Roadwork Descriptor, Closure Location, and
Lanes Closed message elements.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-18
Combining Roadwork Descriptor, Closure Location and Lanes Closed Message Elements When the DMS gives information about roadwork closures on an intersecting freeway that many motorists will use to get to their destinations, it is oftentimes desirable and necessary to combine the Roadwork Descriptor, Closure Location, and Lanes Closed message elements. An example is shown in Table 8.15.
Table 8.15 Example of Combining Roadwork Descriptor, Closure Location and Lanes Closed Message Elements
Message Elements Revised Message Elements Roadwork on Different Highway (I-635 West) than DMS (US-75 North) Roadwork Descriptor ROADWORK Closure Location ON I-635 WEST FROM HILLCREST RD TO PRESTON RD Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED
I-635 WEST CLOSED FROM HILLCREST TO PRESTON
Combining Location of Closure Message Element and Action Message Element When the freeway is closed and a detour route set in place with signs, police and/or traffic control personnel, and the DMS is on the same freeway and close to the closure, then the Location of Closure message element becomes unnecessary to display because it will be contained in the Action message element. One of the examples in Table 8.14 is repeated here to illustrate the concept. In the table below, the Location of Closure (PAST ARAPAHO RD) is combined with the Action (EXIT AT ARAPAHO RD/ FOLLOW DETOUR) and should be omitted because it is redundant.
Table 8.16 Example of Combining Location of Closure Message Element and Action Message Element
Message Component and Message Revised Message Closed Roadway Due to Roadwork on Same Freeway as DMS Roadwork Descriptor ROADWORK Lane Closure Location PAST ARAPAHO RD Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED Location of Closure AT ARAPAHO RD Audience for Action US-75 NORTH TRAFFIC Action EXIT AT ARAPHO RD FOLLOW DETOUR
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT ARAPAHO FOLLOW DETOUR
WHEN THE FREEWAY IS CLOSED, ROADWORK MESSAGES CAN BE REDUCED FURTHER BY: ! Combining Location of Closure message element and
Action message element.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-19
SECONDARY REDUCTION APPROACH Reducing the Number of Destinations in the Action Message Element After the Initial Reduction Approaches have been applied to the Base DMS Message, it may still be possible to reduce the number of informational units, if required, when the Action message element contains more than two Audiences. A decision will have to be made by the message designer concerning which of the two Audiences should be addressed in the message. The second Audience must then be omitted from the Action message element. In the example shown in Table 8.17, a Base DMS Message with eight units of information was reduced to the message shown on the left side.
Table 8.17 Example of Reducing Number of Destinations in the Action Message Element Reduced Message After Applying Initial Reduction
Approaches Revised Message
Roadwork on Same Highway (I-20 East) as DMS (I-20 East) I-20 BEST ROUTE TO CLOSED DALLAS/ I-35 E USE I-30 Phase 1 Phase 2
I-20 BEST ROUTE TO CLOSED DALLAS USE I-30 Phase 1 Phase 2
The reduced message on the left side has the following five units of information: ! I-20 CLOSED 1 unit ! BEST ROUTE TO 1 unit ! DALLAS/ I-35 E 2 units ! USE I-30 1 unit Five units of information exceed the maximum number of units that motorists can read and comprehend while traveling at high freeway speeds. The message must therefore be reduced to four units of information shown on the right side. In the revised message, the destination I-35 E is omitted in preference to DALLAS, resulting in an acceptable four-unit message.
MODULE 8 Dealing with Long Messages Page 8-20
PRIORITY REDUCTION PRINCIPLES After the Initial Reduction Approaches and the Secondary Reduction Approach are applied and the Base DMS Message still has more units of information than should be displayed to motorists at the prevailing freeway speed, then the Priority Reduction Principles discussed in this section should be applied. There is a priority of information that motorists need in order to make driving decisions when incidents occur or lanes are closed due to roadwork. The information needed by motorists in order of priority for incidents and roadwork is shown in Tables 8.18 and 8.19.
Table 8.18 Information Order of Priority for Incidents
Message Elements For Lane Closure Incidents
Message Elements for Freeway Closure Incidents
1. Lane Closure (Blockage 2. Lane Closure Location 3. Diversion Action 4. Audience for Action (if needed)
1. Freeway Closure (Blocked) 2. Location of Closure 3. Diversion Action 4. Audience for Action (if needed)
Table 8.19 Information Order of Priority for Roadwork
Message Elements For Lane Closure for Roadwork
Message Elements for Freeway Closure for Roadwork
1. Lane Closure (Blockage) 2. Lane Closure Location 3. Action Concerning Speed Reductions 4. Diversion Action 5. Audience for Action (if needed)
1. Freeway Closure (Blocked) 2. Location of Closure 3. Action Concerning Speed Reductions 4. Diversion Action 5. Audience for Action (if needed)
Although the Incident Descriptor and the Roadwork Descriptor are useful to motorists, these message elements can be replaced with the Lanes Closed message element. When the number of information units exceeds the maximum that should be displayed under prevailing speeds and the Initial Reduction Approaches and the Secondary Reduction Approach have been applied, then the message designer must begin eliminating informational units. This is done by eliminating units of information starting with the lowest priority.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-i
MODULE 9. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR
INCIDENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
9.1 LANE CLOSURE (BLOCKAGE) INCIDENTS ..................................... 9-1
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT....... 9-1
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................... 9-1
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS................................................................ 9-1
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog................................ 9-2
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................... 9-2
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs..................... 9-2
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................... 9-4
Format the Message..................................................................................................... 9-5
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS..................................................................... 9-5
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................... 9-5
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................... 9-6
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ................................................................................................................. 9-6
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE INCIDENT ...... 9-7
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ........................... 9-7
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS................................................................ 9-7
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog................................ 9-8
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................... 9-8
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs..................... 9-8
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................. 9-10
Format the Message................................................................................................... 9-10
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................... 9-10
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................. 9-11
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................. 9-12
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................... 9-12
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE INCIDENT...................................... 9-13
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ......................... 9-13
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS.............................................................. 9-13
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-ii
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.............................. 9-14
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................. 9-14
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................... 9-14
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................. 9-16
Format the Message................................................................................................... 9-16
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................... 9-16
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................. 9-17
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................. 9-18
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................... 9-18
9.2 INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY ...... 9-19
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE ..... 9-19
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ......................... 9-19
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS.............................................................. 9-19
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.............................. 9-20
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................. 9-20
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................... 9-20
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................. 9-21
Format the Message................................................................................................... 9-22
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................... 9-22
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................. 9-23
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................. 9-24
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................... 9-24
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE ..... 9-25
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ......................... 9-25
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS.............................................................. 9-25
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.............................. 9-26
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................. 9-26
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................... 9-26
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................. 9-28
Format the Message................................................................................................... 9-28
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................... 9-28
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................. 9-29
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................. 9-30
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................... 9-30
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-iii
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE CLOSURE....................................... 9-31
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ......................... 9-31
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS.............................................................. 9-31
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.............................. 9-32
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................. 9-32
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................... 9-32
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................. 9-33
Format the Message................................................................................................... 9-34
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................... 9-34
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................. 9-35
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................. 9-36
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................... 9-36
9.3 INCIDENTS ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT
REQUIRE CLOSING THE CONNECTOR RAMP............................ 9-37
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE .................................. 9-37
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ......................... 9-37
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS.............................................................. 9-37
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.............................. 9-38
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................. 9-38
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................... 9-38
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................. 9-40
Format the Message................................................................................................... 9-40
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................... 9-40
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................. 9-41
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................. 9-42
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................... 9-42
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-1
MODULE 9. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR
INCIDENTS
9.1 LANE CLOSURE (BLOCKAGE) INCIDENTS
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when an incident occurs that blocks
one or more lanes of traffic and the DMS is located on the same freeway and relatively close to
the incident. When a major incident occurs that blocks all of the lanes, use Section 9.2INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY, page 9-19.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-2
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12– Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.1, page 5-2.
Step 13 – Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.2, page 5-3.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-3
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.3, page 5-4.
Step 15 – Establish Whether the Effect on Travel Message Element Is Implied by the Lanes Closed Message Element.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Note: Statements in the Lanes Closed message element such as RIGHT 3 LANES CLOSEDimply to motorists that, depending upon the time of day, they will experience delay or major
delay. Thus, an Effect on Travel message element does not have to be included in the Base
DMS Message.
Step 16 – Select Effect on Travel Message Element from Table 5.4, page 5-5.
Step 17 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 18.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 19.
Step 18 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.5, page 5-6 or Omit ActionMessage Element.
GO TO Step 27.
Step 19 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 21.
If “yes” Continue to Step 20.
Step 20 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.6, page 5-7.
GO TO Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.7, page
5-8. (TxDOT practice is to divert traffic only to another freeway.)
Step 22 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 24.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
Step 23 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 5.8, page 5-9.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-4
Step 24 – Establish Whether a Good Reason for Following Action Is Implied in Lanes Closedand Incident Location Message Elements.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 26.
If “yes” Continue to Step 25.
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route Will Be Perceived By Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
If “no” Continue to Step 26.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 27.
Step 26 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 5.9, page 5-
10.
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 33.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit All but One Audience for Action
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 33.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-5
Step 33 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITY REDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 34 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
Step 36 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 39 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 40.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 40 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 43.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-6
Step 42 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 47.
If “yes” Continue to Step 44.
Step 44 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
Step 45 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 46.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 47.
Step 46 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 48 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-7
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE INCIDENT
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when an incident occurs that blocks
one or more lanes of traffic and the DMS is on the same freeway but relatively far from the
incident. When a major incident occurs that blocks all of the lanes, use Section 9.2 INCIDENTSTHAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY, page 9-19.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-8
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12– Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.10, page 5-11.
Step 13 – Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.11, page 5-12.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.12, page 5-13.
Step 15 – Establish Whether the Effect on Travel Message Element Is Implied by the Lanes Closed Message Element.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Note: Statements in the Lanes Closed message element such as RIGHT 3 LANES CLOSEDimply to motorists that, depending upon the time of day, they will experience delay or major
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-9
delay. Thus, an Effect on Travel message element does not have to be included in the Base
DMS Message.
Step 16 – Select Effect on Travel Message Element from Table 5.13, page 5-14.
Step 17 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 18.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 19.
Step 18 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.14, page 5-15 or Omit
Action Message Element.
GO TO Step 27.
Step 19 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 21.
If “yes” Continue to Step 20.
Step 20 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.15, page 5-16.
GO TO Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 2 Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.16, page 5-17.
(TxDOT practice is to divert traffic only to another freeway.)
Step 22 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 24.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
Step 23 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 5.17, page 5-18.
Step 24 – Establish Whether a Good Reason for Following Action Is Implied in Lanes Closedand Incident Location Message Elements.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 26.
If “yes” Continue to Step 25.
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route Will Be Perceived By Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
If “no” Continue to Step 26.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 27.
Step 26 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 5.18, page 5-
19.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-10
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 33.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit All but One Audience for Action.
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 33.
Step 33 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITY REDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 34 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-11
Step 36 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 39 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 40.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 40 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 43.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 47.
If “yes” Continue to Step 44.
Step 44 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-12
Step 45 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 46.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 47.
Step 46 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITY REDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 48 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-13
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE INCIDENT
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when an incident occurs that blocks
one or more lanes of traffic and the DMS is located on a different freeway than the incident.
When a major incident occurs that blocks all of the lanes, use Section 9.2 INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY, page 9-19.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-14
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12– Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.19, page 5-21.
Step 13 – Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.20, page 5-22.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.21, page 5-23.
Step 15 – Establish Whether the Effect on Travel Message Element Is Implied by the Lanes Closed Message Element.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Note: Statements in the Lanes Closed message element such as RIGHT 3 LANES CLOSEDimply to motorists that, depending upon the time of day, they will experience delay or major
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-15
delay. Thus, an Effect on Travel message element does not have to be included in the Base
DMS Message.
Step 16 – Select Effect on Travel Message Element from Table 5.22, page 5-24.
Step 17 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 18.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 19.
Step 18 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.23, page 5-25 or Omit
Action Message Element.
GO TO Step 27.
Step 19 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 21.
If “yes” Continue to Step 20.
Step 20 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.24, page 5-26.
GO TO Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 2 Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.25, page 5-27.
(TxDOT practice is to divert traffic only to another freeway.)
Step 22 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 24.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
Step 23 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 5.26, page 5-28.
Step 24 – Establish Whether a Good Reason for Following Action Is Implied in Lanes Closedand Incident Location Message Elements.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 26.
If “yes” Continue to Step 25.
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route Will Be Perceived By Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
If “no” Continue to Step 26.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 27.
Step 26 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 5.27, page 5-
29.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-16
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to the Guidelines in the Section
on Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 33.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit All but One Audience for Action.
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 33.
Step 33 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 34 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-17
Step 36 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 39 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 40.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 40 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 43.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 47.
If “yes” Continue to Step 44.
Step 44 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-18
Step 45 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 46.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 47.
Step 46 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 48 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-19
9.2 INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY
DMS ON THE SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when an incident occurs that blocks
all lanes of traffic and requires closing the freeway using signs, police or traffic control
personnel. The procedure is for situations when the DMS is on the same freeway and relatively
close to the closure.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-20
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.28, page 5-31.
Step 13 – Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.29, page 5-32.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.30, page 5-33.
Step 15 – Select Closure Location Message Element from Table 5.31, page 5-34.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-21
Step 16 – Determine Whether Diversion Traffic Control Is in Place on the Selected Diversion
Route (i.e., police, traffic control personnel and/or guide signs/trailblazers providing positive
guidance).
If “no” Continue to Step 17.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 20.
Step 17. – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 19.
If “yes” Continue to Step 18.
Step 18. – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.33, page 5-36.
GO TO Step 21.
Step 19. – Select Type 2, Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.34,
page 5-37.
GO TO Step 21.
Step 20 – Select Type 5 Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.35, page 5-38.
Step 21 – Establish Whether Action Message Element Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 23.
If “yes” Continue to Step 22.
Step 22 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 5.36, page 5-39.
Step 23 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route Will Be Perceived By Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
If “no” Continue to Step 24.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 25.
Step 24 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 5.37, page 5-
40.
Reduce the Number of Message Units if Necessary
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 26.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-22
Step 26 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages beginning on page 8-15.
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 31.
If “yes” Continue to Step 29.
Step 29 – Omit All but One Audience for Action
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 32 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 33 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 34.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 35.
Step 34 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 35.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-23
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 35 – Determine Whether the Message can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
Step 36 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 37 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 39 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 41.
If “yes” Continue to Step 40.
Step 40 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 45.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 44.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 45.
Step 44 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITY REDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-24
Finalize DMS Message
Step 45 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 46 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-25
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE
The steps discussed below should be used to create a new DMS message when an incident
occurs that blocks all lanes and requires closing the freeway using static signs, police or traffic
control personnel. The procedure is for situations when the DMS is on the same freeway but
relatively far from the closure.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-26
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.38, page 5-41.
Step 13 – Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.39, page 5-42.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.40, page 5-43.
Step 15 – Select Closure Location Element from Table 5.41, page 5-44.
Step 16 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 17.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 18.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-27
Step 17 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.43, page 5-46, or Omit
Action Message Element
GO TO Step 27.
Step 18 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 20.
If “yes” Continue to Step 19.
Step 19 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.44, page 5-47.
GO TO Step 23.
Step 20 – Determine Whether Diversion Traffic Control is in Place on the Selected Alternative
Route (i.e., police, traffic control personnel and/or guide signs/trailblazers providing positive
guidance).
If “no” Continue to Step 21.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.45,
page 5-48.
GO TO Step 23.
Step 22 – Select Type 5 Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.46, page 5-49.
Step 23 – Establish Whether Action Message Element Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 25.
If “yes” Continue to Step 24.
Step 24 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 5.47, page 5-50.
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route Will Be Perceived By Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
If “no” Continue to Step 26.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 27.
Step 26 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 5.48, page 5-
51.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-28
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Continue to Step 31.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 33.
Step 31 – Omit All but One Audience for Action
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Continue to Step 33.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 34.
Step 33 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITY REDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 34 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-29
Step 36 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 39 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 40.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 40 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 43.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 47.
If “yes” Continue to Step 44.
Step 44 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-30
Step 45 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 46.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 47.
Step 46 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 48 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-31
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE CLOSURE
The steps discussed below should be used to create a new DMS message when an incident
occurs that blocks all lanes and requires closing the freeway using static signs, police or traffic
control personnel. The procedure is for situations when the DMS is on a different freeway than
the closure.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-32
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.49, page 5-53.
Step 13 – Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.50, page 5-54.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.51, page 5-55.
Step 15 – Select Closure Location Message Element from Table 5.52, page 5-56.
Step 16 – Determine Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 17.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 18.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-33
Step 17 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.54, page 5-58 or Omit
Action Message Element.
GO TO Step 25.
Step 18 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 20.
If “yes” Continue to Step 19.
Step 19 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.55, page 5-59.
GO TO Step 21.
Step 20 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.56,
page 5-60.
Step 21 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 23.
If “yes” Continue to Step 22.
Step 22 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 5.57, page 5-61.
Step 23 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route May Be Perceived by Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
If “no” Continue to Step 24.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 25.
Step 24 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 5.58, page 5-
62.
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 26.
Step 26 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages beginning on page 8-15.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-34
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 30.
If “yes” Continue to Step 29.
Step 29 – Omit All but One Audience for Action
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 32 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 33 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 34.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 35.
Step 34 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 35.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-35
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 35 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 36 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 37 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 39 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 41.
If “yes” Continue to Step 40.
Step 40 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 45.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 44.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 45.
Step 44 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-36
Finalize DMS Message
Step 45 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 46 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-37
9.3 INCIDENTS ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT
REQUIRE CLOSING THE CONNECTOR RAMP
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when an incident occurs on an
intersecting freeway and the connector ramp from the DMS freeway to the intersecting freeway
is closed.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-38
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.59, page 5-64.
Step 13 – Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.60, page 5-65.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.61, page 5-66.
Step 15 – Select Ramp Closure Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.62, page 5-67.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-39
Step 16 – Determine Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 17.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 18.
Step 17 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.63, page 5-68 or Omit
Action Message Element.
GO TO Step 27.
Step 18 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 20.
If “yes” Continue to Step 19.
Step 19 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.64, page 5-69.
GO TO Step 23.
Step 20 – Determine Whether Diversion Traffic Control Is in Place on the Selected Alternative
Route (i.e., police, traffic control personnel and/or guide signs/trailblazers providing
guidance).
If “no” Continue to Step 21.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.65,
page 5-70.
GO TO Step 23.
Step 22 – Select Type 5 Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 5.66, page 5-71.
Step 23 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 25.
If “yes” Continue to Step 24.
Step 24 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 5.67, page 5-72.
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route May Be Perceived by Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
If “no” Continue to Step 26.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 27.
Step 26 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 5.68, page 5-
73.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-40
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 33.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit All but One Audience for Action
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 33.
Step 33 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 34 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-41
Step 36 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 38 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 39 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 40.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 40 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 43.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 47.
If “yes” Continue to Step 44.
Step 44 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
MODULE 9 Designing DMS Messages for Incidents Page 9-42
Step 45 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 46.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 47.
Step 46 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 48 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 pages 7-21
and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see the
DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS message
because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will help the
DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in communicating
the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-i
MODULE 10. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR
ROADWORK
TABLE OF CONTENTS
10.1 LANE CLOSURE DURING ROADWORK............................................ 10-1
DMS ON THE SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE
ROADWORK ........................................................................................................... 10-1
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ......................... 10-1
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS.............................................................. 10-1
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.............................. 10-2
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................. 10-2
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs.................. 10-2
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................. 10-4
Format the Message................................................................................................... 10-5
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................... 10-5
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................. 10-5
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................. 10-6
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................... 10-6
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE
ROADWORK ........................................................................................................... 10-7
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ......................... 10-7
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS.............................................................. 10-7
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog.............................. 10-8
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................. 10-8
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs.................. 10-8
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary............................................... 10-10
Format the Message................................................................................................. 10-10
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 10-10
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 10-11
Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 10-12
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................. 10-12
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK ............................... 10-13
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ....................... 10-13
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-ii
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS............................................................ 10-13
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog............................ 10-14
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message................ 10-14
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................ 10-14
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary............................................... 10-16
Format the Message................................................................................................. 10-16
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 10-16
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 10-17
Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 10-18
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................. 10-18
10.2 ROADWORK THAT REQUIRES CLOSING THE
FREEWAY ............................................................................................................. 10-19
DMS ON THE SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE
CLOSURE............................................................................................................... 10-19
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ....................... 10-19
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS............................................................ 10-19
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog............................ 10-20
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message................ 10-20
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................ 10-20
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary............................................... 10-21
Format the Message................................................................................................. 10-21
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 10-21
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 10-22
. Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 10-23
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................. 10-23
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE ... 10-24
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ....................... 10-24
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS............................................................ 10-24
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog............................ 10-25
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message................ 10-25
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................ 10-25
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary............................................... 10-26
Format the Message................................................................................................. 10-27
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 10-27
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 10-28
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-iii
Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 10-29
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................. 10-29
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE .. 10-30
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ....................... 10-30
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS............................................................ 10-30
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog............................ 10-31
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message................ 10-31
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................ 10-31
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary............................................... 10-32
Format the Message................................................................................................. 10-33
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 10-33
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 10-33
Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 10-34
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................. 10-35
10.3 ROADWORK ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT
REQUIRES CLOSING THE CONNECTOR RAMP....................... 10-36
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE ................................ 10-36
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ....................... 10-36
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS............................................................ 10-36
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog............................ 10-37
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message................ 10-37
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs................ 10-37
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary............................................... 10-39
Format the Message................................................................................................. 10-39
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 10-39
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 10-40
Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 10-41
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS
Message ............................................................................................................. 10-41
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-1
MODULE 10. DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES FOR
ROADWORK
10.1 LANE CLOSURE DURING ROADWORK
The DMS message design process described in this section of the Manual applies to
roadwork that requires closure of some of the lanes of the freeway while other lanes are open to
traffic. When the roadwork requires closure of all the lanes on the freeway, Section 10.2ROADWORK THAT REQUIRES CLOSING THE FREEWAY on page 10-19 should be used.
DMS ON THE SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE ROADWORK
The steps discussed below should be used to create a new DMS message when it is necessary
to close one or more lanes while other lanes are open to traffic and the DMS is located on the
same freeway and relatively close to the roadwork.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-2
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Roadwork Descriptor Message Element from Table 6.1, page 6-2.
Step 13 – Select Roadwork Location Message Element from Table 6.2, page 6-3.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-3
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 6.3, page 6-4.
Step 15 – Establish Whether Effect on Travel Message Element Is implied by the Lanes Closed Message Element.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Note: Statements in the Lanes Closed message element such as RIGHT 3 LANES CLOSEDimply to motorists that, depending upon the time of day, they will experience delay or major
delay. Thus, an Effect on Travel message element does not have to be included in the Basic
DMS Message.
Step 16 – Select Effect on Travel Message Element from Table 6.4, page 6-5.
Step 17 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 18.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 19.
Step 18 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.5, page 6-6 or Omit Action Message Element.
GO TO Step 27.
Step 19 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 21.
If “yes” Continue to Step 20.
Step 20 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.6, page 6-7.
GO TO Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 6.7, page
6-8.
Step 22 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 24.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
Step 23 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 6.8, page 6-9.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-4
Step 24 – Establish Whether a Good Reason for Following Action Is Implied in Lanes Closedand Roadwork Location Message Elements.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 26.
If “yes” Continue to Step 25.
Step 25 – Determine Whether Motorists Will Be Advised to Take a Route That May Be
Perceived by Them as Not Being Logical.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 27.
If “yes” Continue to Step 26.
Step 26 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 6.9, page 6-
10.
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages beginning on page 8-15.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit All but One Audience for Action.
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 33.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-5
Step 33 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 34 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
Step 36 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 39 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 40.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 40 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 43.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-6
Step 42 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 47.
If “yes” Continue to Step 44.
Step 44 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
Step 45 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 46.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 47.
Step 46 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 48 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-7
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE ROADWORK
The steps discussed below should be used to create a new DMS message when it is necessary
to close one or more lanes while other lanes are open to traffic and the DMS is on the same
freeway but relatively far from the roadwork.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-8
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Roadwork Descriptor Message Element from Table 6.10, page 6-11.
Step 13 – Select Roadwork Location Message Element from Table 6.11, page 6-12.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 6.12, page 6-13.
Step 15 – Establish Whether Effect on Travel Message Element Is Implied by the Lanes Closed Message Element.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Note: Statements in the Lanes Closed message element such as RIGHT 3 LANES CLOSEDimply to motorists that, depending upon the time of day, they will experience delay or major
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-9
delay. Thus, an Effect on Travel message element does not have to be included in the Basic
DMS Message.
Step 16 – Select Effect on Travel Message Element from Table 6.13, page 6-14.
Step 17 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 18.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 19.
Step 18 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.14, page 6-15 or Omit
Action Message Element.
GO TO Step 27.
Step 19 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 21.
If “yes” Continue to Step 20.
Step 20 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.15, page 6-16.
GO TO Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 6.16,
page 6-17.
Step 22 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 24.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
Step 23 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 6.17, page 6-18.
Step 24 – Establish Whether a Good Reason for Following Action Is Implied in Lanes Closedand Roadwork Location Message Elements.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 26.
If “yes” Continue to Step 25.
Step 25 – Determine Whether Motorists Will Be Advised to Take a Route That May Be
Perceived by Them as Not Being Logical.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 27.
If “yes” Continue to Step 26.
Step 26 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 6.18, page 6-
29.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-10
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit All but One Audience for Action.
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 33.
Step 33 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 34 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 36
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-11
Step 36 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 39 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 40.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 40 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 43.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 47.
If “yes” Continue to Step 44.
Step 44 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-12
Step 45 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 46.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 47.
Step 46 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 48 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-13
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK
The steps discussed below should be used to create a new DMS message when it is necessary
to close one or more lanes while other lanes are open to traffic and the DMS is located on a
different freeway than the roadwork.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-14
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Roadwork Descriptor Message Element from Table 6.19, page 6-20.
Step 13 – Select Roadwork Location Message Element from Table 6.20, page 6-21.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 6.21, page 6-22.
Step 15 – Establish Whether Effect on Travel Message Element Is Implied by the Lanes Closed Message Element.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Note: Statements in the Lanes Closed message element such as RIGHT 3 LANES CLOSEDimply to motorists that, depending upon the time of day, they will experience delay or major
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-15
delay. Thus, an Effect on Travel message element does not have to be included in the Basic
DMS Message.
Step 16 – Select Effect on Travel Message Element from Table 6.22, page 6-23.
Step 17 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 18.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 19.
Step 18 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.23, page 6-24 or Omit
Action Message Element.
GO TO Step 27.
Step 19 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 21.
If “yes” Continue to Step 20.
Step 20 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.24, page 6-25.
GO TO Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 1 or Type 2 Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 6.25,
page 6-26.
Step 22 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 24.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
Step 23 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 6.26, page 6-27.
Step 24 – Establish Whether a Good Reason for Following Action Is Implied in Lanes Closedand Roadwork Location Message Elements.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 26.
If “yes” Continue to Step 25.
Step 25 – Determine Whether Motorists Will Be Advised to Take a Route That May be
Perceived by Them as Not Being Logical.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 27.
If “yes” Continue to Step 26.
Step 26 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 6.27, page 6-
28.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-16
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages beginning on page 8-15.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit All but One Audience for Action.
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 34.
If “yes” Continue to Step 33.
Step 33 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 34 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 36
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 37.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-17
Step 36 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 39 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 40.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 41.
Step 40 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 43.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 47.
If “yes” Continue to Step 44.
Step 44 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-18
Step 45 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 46.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 47.
Step 46 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 48 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-19
10.2 ROADWORK THAT REQUIRES CLOSING THE
FREEWAY
When construction or maintenance roadwork requires closure of the entire freeway, a traffic
control plan is implemented. The traffic control plan includes installation of traffic control
devices to divert traffic off the primary freeway and to give positive guidance to the motorists
along the diversion route and then back to the primary freeway. The closure of the primary
freeway will take place at an exit ramp upstream of the roadwork.
DMS ON THE SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when roadwork requires closure of
all the traffic lanes and the DMS is located on the same freeway and relatively close to the
closure.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-20
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS Because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message..
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Roadwork Descriptor Message Element from Table 6.28, page 6-31.
Step 13 – Select Closure Location Message Element from Table 6.29, page 6-32.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-21
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 6.30, page 6-33.
Step 15 – Select Type 6 Diversion (Detour) Route Action Message Element from Table 6.32,
page 6-35.
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 16 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 20.
If “yes” Continue to Step 17.
Step 17 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages beginning on page 8-15.
Step 18 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 20.
If “yes” Continue to Step 19.
Step 19 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 20 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 21 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 22.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 23.
Step 22 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-22
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 23 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 24.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 25.
Step 24 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 25 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 26.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 27.
Step 26 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 27 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 29.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 33.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
Step 31 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 32.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 33.
Step 32 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-23
Finalize DMS Message
Step 33 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 34 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-24
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when roadwork requires closure of
all the traffic lanes and the DMS is located on the same freeway but relatively far from the
closure.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-25
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Roadwork Descriptor Message Element from Table 6.35, page 6-38.
Step 13 – Select Closure Location Message Element from Table 6.36, page 6-39.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 6.37, page 6-40.
Step 15 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Step 16 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.39, page 6-42.
GO TO Step 26.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-26
Step 17 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 19.
If “yes” Continue to Step 18.
Step 18 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.40, page 6-43.
GO TO Step 22.
Step 19 – Establish Whether Type 6 Diversion (Detour) Route Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 20.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 21.
Step 20 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 6.41,
page 6-44.
GO TO Step 22.
Step 21 – Select Type 6 Diversion (Detour) Route Action Message Element from Table 6.42,
page 6-45.
Step 22 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 24.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
Step 23 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 6.43, page 6-46.
Step 24 – Determine Whether Motorists Will Be Advised to Take a Route That May Be
Perceived by Them as Not Being Logical.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 26.
If “yes” Continue to Step 25.
Step 25 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 6.44 page 6-
47.
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 26 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 33.
If “yes” Continue to Step 27.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-27
Step 27 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages beginning on page 8-15.
Step 28 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 33.
If “yes” Continue to Step 29.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 31.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Omit All but One Audience for Action
Step 32 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 33.
If “yes” Continue to Step 32.
Step 32 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 33 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 34 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 35.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 36.
Step 35 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 36.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-28
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 36 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 37.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 38.
Step 37 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 38 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 39.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 40.
Step 39 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 40 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 42.
If “yes” Continue to Step 41.
Step 41 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 42 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 46.
If “yes” Continue to Step 43.
Step 43 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
Step 44 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 45.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 46.
Step 45 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-29
Finalize DMS Message
Step 46 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 47 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-30
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when roadwork requires closure of
all the traffic lanes and the DMS is located on a different freeway than the closure.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-31
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use This Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Roadwork Descriptor Message Element from Table 6.45, page 6-49.
Step 13 – Select Closure Location Message Element from Table 6.46, page 6-50.
Step 14 – Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 6.47, page 6-51.
Step 15 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Step 16 – Select No Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.49, page 6-53.
GO TO Step 24.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-32
Step 17 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 19.
If “yes” Continue to Step 18.
Step 18 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.50, page 6-54.
GO TO Step 20.
Step 19 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 6.51,
page 6-55.
Step 20 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 22.
If “yes” Continue to Step 21.
Step 21 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 6.52, page 6-56.
Step 22 – Determine Whether Motorists Will Be Advised to Take a Route That May Be
Perceived by Them as Not Being Logical.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 24.
If “yes” Continue to Step 23.
Step 23 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 6.53, page 6-
57.
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 24 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 31.
If “yes” Continue to Step 25.
Step 25 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages beginning on page 8-15.
Step 26 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 31.
If “yes” Continue to Step 27.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-33
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 29.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit All but One Audience for Action.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 31.
If “yes” Continue to Step 30.
Step 30 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 31 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 32 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 33.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 34.
Step 33 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 34.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 34 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 35.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 36.
Step 35 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-34
Step 36 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 37.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 38.
Step 37 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 38 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 40.
If “yes” Continue to Step 39.
Step 39 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 40 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 44.
If “yes” Continue to Step 41.
Step 41 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
Step 42 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 43.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 44.
Step 43 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 44 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 45 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-35
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-36
10.3 ROADWORK ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY THAT
REQUIRES CLOSING THE CONNECTOR RAMP
DMS UPSTREAM OF THE CONNECTOR RAMP CLOSURE
Use the procedure outlined in this section of the Manual when roadwork occurs on an
intersecting freeway and the connector ramp from the DMS freeway to the intersecting freeway
is closed.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speeds.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5. For LED DMSs, these maximum values are as follows:
Maximum Number of Units of Information
Allowed in DMS Message
Light-Emitting Diode DMS
Condition 0-35
mph
36-55
mph
56-70
mph
Mid-Day 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Washout 5 units 4 units 4 units
Sun Backlight 4 units 4 units 3 units
Nighttime 4 units 4 units 3 units
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 5.
If “yes” Continue to Step 4.
Step 4 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Message Units of Information to Compensate
for Lower Legibility to the DMS because of the Vertical Curve Using Tables 7.3 through 7.6
on pages 7-8 and 7-9.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-37
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of a
Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 7.
If “yes” Continue to Step 6.
Step 6 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Lower
Legibility to the DMS Because of the Horizontal Curve Using Tables 7.7 through 7.12 on
pages 7-12 through 7-17.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall Near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 9.
If “yes” Continue to Step 8.
Step 8 – The Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Rain Is 1.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists Near the DMS.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 11.
If “yes” Continue to Step 10.
Step 10 – Identify the Reduction in the Number of Units of Information to Compensate for Fog
Using Table 7.13 on page 7-19.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Select the Largest Reduction in the Number of Units of Information from Among the
Effects of a Vertical Curve (Step 4), a Horizontal Curve (Step 6), Rain (Step 8), or Fog (Step
10), and Use ThIs Number to Subtract from the Maximum Allowable Number of Units of
Information in the Message Shown in Table 7.2 on page 7-5. The new number after the
subtraction represents the final Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the message.
Define the Basic DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 – Select Roadwork Descriptor Message Element from Table 6.54, page 6-59.
Step 13 – Select Closure Location Message Element from Table 6.55, page 6-60.
Step 14 – Select Ramp Closure Descriptor Message Element from Table 6.56, page 6-61.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-38
Step 15 – Determine Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Continue to Step 16.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 17.
Step 16 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 18.
If “yes” Continue to Step 17.
Step 17 – Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 6.57, page 6-62.
GO TO Step 21.
Step 18 – Establish Whether Detour Route Has Been Established as Part of the Traffic Control
Plan.
If “no” Continue to Step 19.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 20.
Step 19 – Select Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 6.58,
page 6-63.
GO TO Step 21.
Step 20 – Select Type 6 Diversion Route Action Message Element from Table 6.59, page 6-64.
Step 21 – Establish Whether Action Message Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 25.
If “yes” Continue to Step 24.
Step 22 – Select Audience for Action Message Element from Table 6.60, page 6-65.
Step 23 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route May Be Perceived by Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
If “no” Continue to Step 24.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 25.
Step 24 – Select a Good Reason for Following Action Message Element from Table 6.61, page 6-
66.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-39
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 26.
Step 26 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the Section on
Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Examine Whether the Message Contains More Than One Audience for Action(Destination) Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 31.
If “yes” Continue to Step 29.
Step 29 – Omit All but One Audience for Action
Step 30 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Basic Message Is Greater
Than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 32.
If “yes” Continue to Step 31.
Step 31 – Omit Other Information According to Guidelines in the Section on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20.
Format the Message
Step 32 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 33 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
If “no” Continue to Step 34.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 35.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-40
Step 34 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 3 Lines.
If “no” MESSAGE CANNOT BE DESIGNED USING THIS PROCEDURE.
If “yes” Continue to Step 35.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 35 – Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
If “no” Continue to Step 36.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 36 – Split Message Into 2 Phases According to Guidelines in Section 8.1 - SPLITTING MESSAGES on page 8-1.
Step 37 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
If “no” Continue to Step 38.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 39.
Step 38 – Omit Information to Reduce Phase to 3 Decision-Relevant Units According to
Guidelines in Item 5. NO MORE THAN THREE UNITS OF INFORMATION SHOULD BE DISPLAYED ON A SINGLE PHASE AT HIGH FREEWAY SPEEDS on page 8-3.
Step 39 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 41.
If “yes” Continue to Step 40.
Step 40 – Separate Message Elements According to Guidelines in Item 4. A MESSAGE LINE SHOULD NOT CONTAIN PORTIONS OF TWO DIFFERENT UNITS OF INFORMATIONon page 8-3.
Step 41 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit in
the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Go Directly to Step 45.
If “yes” Continue to Step 42.
Step 42 – Apply Abbreviations to Selected Words According to Guidelines in the Section on
USING ABBREVIATIONS, page 8-10.
MODULE 10 Designing DMS Messages for Roadwork Page 10-41
Step 43 – Examine Whether the Application of Abbreviation Guidelines Adequately Reduced the
Length of the Message Lines and the Entire Message Can Fit in the Available DMS Space.
If “no” Continue to Step 44.
If “yes” Go Directly to Step 45.
Step 44 – Omit Information According to Guidelines in the Sections on PRIORITYREDUCTION PRINCIPLES on page 8-20 and FORMATTING MESSAGES on page 8-6.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 45 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
Step 46 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
You now should have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
he final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 pages 7-21
and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see the
DMS message (or consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS message
because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will help the
DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in communicating
the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 11 Quick Reference Guide for Designing DMS Messages Page 11-i
MODULE 11. QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE FOR DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES
TABLE OF CONTENTS
11.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 11-1 11.2 LANE CLOSURE (BLOCKAGE) INCIDENTS ................................... 11-2 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT..... 11-2 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT ............. 11-4 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT............................................... 11-6 11.3 INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY ...... 11-8 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE ..... 11-8 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE............ 11-12 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE ............................................. 11-16 11.4 LANE CLOSURES DURING ROADWORK ....................................... 11-19 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE ROADWORK ......................................................................................................... 11-19 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE ROADWORK ......................................................................................................... 11-21 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK ............................... 11-23 11.5 ROADWORK REQUIRING TOTAL FREEWAY CLOSURE .. 11-25 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE ... 11-25 DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE ... 11-27 DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE .. 11-29
MODULE 11 Quick Reference Guide for Designing DMS Messages Page 11-1
MODULE 11. QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE FOR DESIGNING DMS MESSAGES
11.1 INTRODUCTION Details of the DMS message design process for incidents and roadwork were presented in Modules 9 and 10. The objective of Module 11 is to provide a quick reference guide for designing messages. It is intended for supervisory personnel and for DMS operators who have considerable experience with using the guidelines in Modules 9 and 10. As one examines the large number of alternative terms that are available for each of the DMS message elements in Modules 5 and 6, it becomes apparent that there are numerous combinations of messages that can be used—too numerous to list each combination. Therefore, only typical example messages are shown in Module 11 to illustrate specific principles of message design. This Module applies only to DMS messages for situations where a maximum of 4 units of information can be displayed.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-2
11.2 LANE CLOSURE (BLOCKAGE) INCIDENTS DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT
Table 11.1 DMS Message Examples for Lane Closure (Blockage) Incidents DMS Close to IncidentA
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Incident (Blockage) Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND DR
RIGHT LANE CLOSED
ACCIDENT AT
ROWLAND
RIGHT LANE
CLOSED
• “MAJOR ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• No Action message element
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
RIGHT 3 LANES CLOSED
• “TRUCK ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• No Action message element
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
RIGHT 3 LANES CLOSED
• Highway name (number) for Incident (Blockage) Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ACCIDENT PAST I-610
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
ACCIDENT PAST I-610
RIGHT 2 LANES
CLOSED
• Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED PAST I-610
• Action message element. • No diversion.
ACCIDENT PAST ROWLAND
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED BE PREPARED TO STOP
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED PAST ROWLAND
BE PREPARED TO STOP
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element. RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
PAST ROWLAND BE PREPARED TO STOP
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-3
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. ACCIDENT BEFORE ROWLAND
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED USE OTHER ROUTES
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED BEFORE ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element. RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
BEFORE ROWLAND USE OTHER ROUTES
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED USE I-45 NORTH
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element. RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH AVOID MAJOR DELAY
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (MAJOR ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (TRUCK ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
UTOPIA USE I-45 NORTH
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-4
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM INCIDENT
Table 11.2 DMS Message Examples for Lane Closure (Blockage) Incidents DMS Relatively Far from IncidentA
Large DMS Portable DMS Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Incident (Blockage) Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND DR 1 LANE CLOSED
ACCIDENT AT
ROWLAND
RIGHT LANE
CLOSED
• “MAJOR ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
3 LANES CLOSED
• “TRUCK ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
3 LANES CLOSED
• Distance for Incident (Blockage) Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ACCIDENT 1 MILE
2 LANES CLOSED
ACCIDENT 1 MILE
2 LANES CLOSED
• Highway name (number) for Incident (Blockage) Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ACCIDENT PAST I-610
2 LANES CLOSED
ACCIDENT PAST I-610
2 LANES CLOSED
• Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED PAST I-610
• Action message element. • No diversion.
ACCIDENT PAST ROWLAND
2 LANES CLOSED BE PREPARED TO STOP
2 LANES CLOSED PAST ROWLAND
BE PREPARED TO STOP
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element. 2 LANES CLOSED PAST ROWLAND
BE PREPARED TO STOP
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-5
Large DMS Portable DMS Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. ACCIDENT BEFORE ROWLAND
2 LANES CLOSED USE OTHER ROUTES
2 LANES CLOSED BEFORE ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element. 2 LANES CLOSED BEFORE ROWLAND USE OTHER ROUTES
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
2 LANES CLOSED USE I-45 NORTH
2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element. 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH AVOID MAJOR DELAY
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (MAJOR ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND USE I-10 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (TRUCK ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT BELTON RD
UTOPIA USE I-30 EAST
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-6
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN INCIDENT
Table 11.3 DMS Message Examples for Lane Closure (Blockage) Incidents DMS on Different Freeway than IncidentA
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Incident (Blockage) Location message element. • No Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST AT BELTON
• “MAJOR ACCIDENT for Incident Descriptor message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
• “TRUCK ACCIDENT for Incident Descriptor message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
• Highway name (number) for Incident (Blockage) Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST BEFORE I-635
• Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED ON I-20 EAST BEFORE I-635
• Action message element. • No diversion.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
(Does not apply in this case.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-7
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
2LANES CLOSED ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
USE OTHER ROUTES
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
(Requires a five-unit
message.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (MAJOR ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (TRUCK ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
(Requires a five-unit
message.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-8
11.3 INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE
Table 11.4 DMS Message Examples for Incidents that Require Closing the Freeway DMS Close to IncidentA
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Incident (Blockage) Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• “MAJOR ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Lanes Closed message element. • Closure Location message element. • No Action message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
• “TRUCK ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
• Highway name (number) for Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT PAST I-610
ALL LANES CLOSED
• Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED PAST I-610
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
BE PREPARED TO STOP
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED
AT RIVER RD BE PREPARED TO STOP
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages DRAFT
Page 11-8
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-9
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• Action message element. • No diversion.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
BE PREPARED TO STOP
• “Soft” diversion. MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
USE OTHER ROUTES
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE OTHER ROUTES
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
USE I-10 WEST
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
(Good reason is implied by
ALL LANES CLOSED in above message.)
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (MAJOR ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-10
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (TRUCK ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT BELTON RD
UTOPIA USE I-30 EAST
FREEWAY CLOSED AT BELTON RD
USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (ALL LANES CLOSED).
FREEWAY CLOSED AT BELTON RD USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (ALL LANES CLOSED).
FREEWAY CLOSED AT BELTON RD
UTOPIA USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. MAJOR ACCIDENT ALL LANES CLOSED
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
FREEWAY CLOSED
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements..
(Good reason is implied by
FREEWAY CLOSED in above message.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-11
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (MAJOR ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT KENT
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (TRUCK ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT KENT
UTOPIA EXIT AT RIVER RD
FREEWAY CLOSED
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (ALL LANES CLOSED).
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-12
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM CLOSURE
Table 11.5 DMS Message Examples for Incidents that Require Closing the Freeway DMS Relatively Far from IncidentA
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Incident (Blockage) Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• “MAJOR ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Lanes Closed message element. • Closure Location message element. • No Action message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
• “TRUCK ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
• Highway name (number) for Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT PAST I-610
ALL LANES CLOSED
• Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED PAST I-610
• Action message element. • No diversion.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
BE PREPARED TO STOP
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
BE PREPARED TO STOP
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED
AT RIVER RD BE PREPARED TO STOP
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-13
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
USE OTHER ROUTES
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED
AT RIVER RD USE OTHER ROUTES
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
USE I-10 WEST
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Good reason is implied by
FREEWAY CLOSED in above message.)
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (MAJOR ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WESTTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (TRUCK ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT BELTON RD
UTOPIA USE I-30 EAST
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-14
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
FREEWAY CLOSED AT BELTON RD
USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (ALL LANES CLOSED).
FREEWAY CLOSED AT BELTON RD USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (ALL LANES CLOSED).
FREEWAY CLOSED AT BETLTON RD
UTOPIA USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. MAJOR ACCIDENT ALL LANES CLOSED
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
FREEWAY CLOSED
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Good reason is implied by
FREEWAY CLOSED in above message.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-15
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Good reason is implied by
FREEWAY CLOSED in above message.)
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (MAJOR ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (TRUCK ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT AT ROWLAND
UTOPIA EXIT AT RIVER RD
FREEWAY CLOSED
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Diversion to Type 5 Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (ALL LANES CLOSED).
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-16
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN CLOSURE
Table 11.6 DMS Message Examples for Incidents that Require Closing the Freeway DMS on Different Freeway than IncidentA
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Incident (Blockage) Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• “MAJOR ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
• Incident (Blockage) Location message element. • No Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
• “TRUCK ACCIDENT” for Incident Descriptor message element.
TRUCK ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
• Highway name (number) for Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
PAST I-635
• Combining Incident Descriptor and Closure Location message elements.
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST I-635
• Action message element. • No diversion.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Action message element. • No diversion • Combining Incident Descriptor and Closure
Location message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-17
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. MAJOR ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
PAST BELTON
USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Closure
Location message elements.
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST BELTON
USE OTHER ROUTES
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. MAJOR ACCIDENT ON I-20 EAST
PAST BELTON
USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Closure
Location message elements.
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST BELTON USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Closure
Location message elements.
(Good reason is implied by
FREEWAY CLOSED in above message.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (MAJOR ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
MAJOR ACCIDENT ON I-20 WEST PAST BELTON
USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (TRUCK ACCIDENT). • No Lanes Closed message element.
(Requires a five-unit message.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-18
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Closure
Location message elements. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (ALL LANES CLOSED).
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST BELTON USE 30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Combining Incident Descriptor and Closure
Location message elements. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (ALL LANES CLOSED).
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST BELTON
UTOPIA USE I-30 EAST
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-19
11.4 LANE CLOSURES DURING ROADWORK DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE ROADWORK
Table 11.7 DMS Message Examples for Lane Closures during Roadwork DMS Close to Lane ClosureA
Large DMS Portable DMS Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ROADWORK” for Roadwork Descriptor message element.
• Lane Closure Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
ROADWORK AT ROWLAND DR
RIGHT LANE CLOSED
ROADWORK AT
ROWLAND
RIGHT LANE
CLOSED
• Highway name (number) for Lane Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ROADWORK PAST I-635
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
ROADWORK PAST I-635
RIGHT 2 LANES
CLOSED
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED PAST I-635
• Displaying the limits of the Lane Closure Location message element.
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED FROM SPENCE TO ROWLAND
• Action message element. • No diversion.
ROADWORK PAST ROWLAND
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED BE PREPARED TO STOP
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED PAST ROWLAND
BE PREPARED TO STOP
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Replacing Lane Closure Descriptor message
element with Lanes Closed message element. RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
PAST ROWLAND BE PREPARED TO STOP
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-20
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. ROADWORK BEFORE ROWLAND
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED USE OTHER ROUTES
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED BEFORE ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Replacing Lane Closure Descriptor message
element with Lanes Closed message element. RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
BEFORE ROWLAND USE OTHER ROUTES
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element. RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH AVOID MAJOR DELAY
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (2 lanes closed). • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
UTOPIA USE I-45 NORTH
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-21
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE ROADWORK
Table 11.8 DMS Message Examples for Lane Closures during Roadwork DMS Far Upstream of Lane ClosureA
Large DMS Portable DMS Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ROADWORK” for Roadwork Descriptor message element.
• Lane Closure Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
ROADWORK AT ROWLAND DR 1 LANE CLOSED
ROADWORK AT
ROWLAND
1 LANE CLOSED
• Highway name (number) for Lane Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ROADWORK PAST I-635
2 LANES CLOSED
ACCIDENT PAST I-635
2 LANES CLOSED
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED PAST I-635
• Displaying the limits of the Lane Closure Location message element.
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED FROM SPENCE TO ROWLAND
• Action message element. • No diversion.
ROADWORK PAST ROWLAND
2 LANES CLOSED BE PREPARED TO STOP
2 LANES CLOSED PAST ROWLAND
BE PREPARED TO STOP
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Replacing Lane Closure Descriptor message
element with Lanes Closed message element. 2 LANES CLOSED PAST ROWLAND
BE PREPARED TO STOP
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-22
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. ROADWORK BEFORE ROWLAND
2 LANES CLOSED USE OTHER ROUTES
2 LANES CLOSED BEFORE ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Replacing Lane Closure Descriptor message
element with Lanes Closed message element. 2 LANES CLOSED
BEFORE ROWLAND USE OTHER ROUTES
2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element. 2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
USE I-45 NORTH AVOID MAJOR DELAY
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (2 lanes closed). • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED AT ROWLAND
UTOPIA USE I-45 NORTH
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-23
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK
Table 11.9 DMS Message Examples for Lane Closures during Roadwork DMS on Different Freeway Than Lane ClosureA
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ROADWORK” for Roadwork Descriptor message element.
• Lane Closure Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
(Cannot be properly formatted on a three-line
sign.)
• “ROADWORK” for Roadwork Descriptor message element.
• Lane Closure Location message element. • No Action message element.
ROADWORK ON I-20 EAST
BEFORE BELTON
• Highway name (number) for Lane Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ROADWORK ON I-20 EAST BEFORE I-635
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
2 LANES CLOSED ON I-20 EAST BEFORE I-635
• Displaying the limits of the Lane Closure Location message element.
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
(Cannot be properly formatted on a three-line
sign.)
• Action message element. • No diversion.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Replacing Lane Closure Descriptor message
element with Lanes Closed message element.
(Does not apply in this case.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-24
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. (Requires a five-unit
message.)
• “Soft” diversion. • Replacing Lane Closure Descriptor message
element with Lanes Closed message element.
(Cannot be properly
formatted on a three-line sign.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
(Cannot be properly
formatted on a three-line sign.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
(Requires a five-unit
message.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (2 lanes closed). • Replacing Incident Descriptor message element with
Lanes Closed message element.
(Requires a five-unit
message.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-25
11.5 ROADWORK REQUIRING TOTAL FREEWAY CLOSURE DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO THE CLOSURE
Table 11.10 DMS Message Examples for Roadwork Requiring Total Freeway Closure DMS Close to ClosureA
Large DMS Portable DMS Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ROADWORK” for Roadwork Descriptor message element.
• Lane Closure Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
ROADWORK AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
ROADWORK AT
RIVER RD
ALL LANES
CLOSED
• Highway name (number) for Lane Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ROADWORK PAST I-635
ALL LANES CLOSED
ROADWORK NEAR I-287
ALL LANES
CLOSED
• Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED PAST I-635
• Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed message elements.
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
FREEWAY CLOSED FROM SPENCE TO RIVER RD
• Action message element. ROADWORK ALL LANES CLOSED
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Action message element. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Action message element. • No diversion.
(Does not apply in this case.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-26
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. (Does not apply in this case.)
• “Soft” diversion. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (2 lanes closed). • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Diversion to Type 6 Detour Route. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-27
DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM THE CLOSURE
Table 11.11 DMS Message Examples for Roadwork Requiring Total Freeway Closure DMS Far from ClosureA
Large DMS Portable DMS Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ROADWORK” for Roadwork Descriptor message element.
• Lane Closure Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
ROADWORK AT RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED
ROADWORK AT
RIVER RD
ALL LANES
CLOSED
• Highway name (number) for Lane Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
ROADWORK PAST I-610
ALL LANES CLOSED
ROADWORK PAST I-635
ALL LANES
CLOSED
• Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED PAST I-610
• Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed message elements.
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
FREEWAY CLOSED FROM SPENCE TO RIVER RD
• Action message element. ROADWORK ALL LANES CLOSED
EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Action message element. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
• Action message element. • No diversion.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-28
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. ROADWORK BEFORE RIVER RD
ALL LANES CLOSED USE OTHER ROUTES
• “Soft” diversion. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED BEFORE RIVER RD
USE OTHER ROUTES
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements. FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
USE I-10 WEST AVOID MAJOR DELAY
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (FREEWAY CLOSED). • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED AT RIVER RD
UTOPIA USE I-10 WEST
• Diversion to Type 6 Detour Route. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
FREEWAY CLOSED EXIT AT RIVER RD FOLLOW DETOUR
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-29
DMS ON DIFFERENT FREEWAY THAN THE ROADWORK AND CLOSURE
Table 11.12 DMS Message Examples for Roadwork Requiring Total Freeway Closure DMS on Different HighwayA
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “ROADWORK” for Roadwork Descriptor message element.
• Lane Closure Location message element. • Lanes Closed message element. • No Action message element.
(Cannot be properly formatted on a three-line
sign.)
• Highway name (number) for Lane Closure Location message element.
• No Action message element.
(Cannot be properly formatted on a three-line
sign.)
• Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed message elements.
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST I-635
• Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed message elements.
• Replacing Roadwork Descriptor message element with Lanes Closed message element.
I-20 EAST CLOSED FROM SPENCE TO ROWLAND
• Action message element. (Requires a five-unit message.)
• Action message element. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Action message element. • No diversion.
(Does not apply in this case.)
• Action message element. • No diversion. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
Revised July 2006
MO
DU
LE 11 Quick Reference G
uide for Designing D
MS M
essages Page 11-30
Large DMS Portable DMSB Message Characteristics Highlights Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 1 Phase 2
• “Soft” diversion. (Requires a five-unit message.)
• “Soft” diversion. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST BELTON
USE OTHER ROUTES
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST BELTON USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Good reason for following Action message element. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Cannot be properly formatted on a three-line
sign.)
• Diversion to Type 2 Freeway Diversion Route. • Diversion message for specific audience. • Implied good reason for following Action message
element (FREEWAY CLOSED). • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
I-20 EAST CLOSED PAST BELTON
UTOPIA USE I-30 EAST
• Diversion to Type 6 Detour Route. • Combining Roadwork Descriptor and Lanes Closed
message elements.
(Does not apply in this case.)
A Large DMS: 3 lines, 20 characters per line; Portable DMS: 3 lines, 8 characters per line. All messages are for operating speeds above 35 mph and thus are limited to 4 units of information.
B Blank cells indicate that the message cannot be displayed on a portable DMS.
MODULE 12 Modifying Messages to Improve Effectiveness Page 12-i
MODULE 12. MODIFYING MESSAGES TO
IMPROVE EFFECTIVENESS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
12.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 12-1
EXAMPLES OF IMPROVED MESSAGES FOR INCIDENTS ................................... 12-2
EXAMPLES OF IMPROVED MESSAGES FOR ROADWORK................................. 12-7
MODULE 12 Modifying Messages to Improve Effectiveness Page 12-1
MODULE 12. MODIFYING MESSAGES TO
IMPROVE EFFECTIVENESS
12.1 INTRODUCTION
Module 12 contains recommended improvements to several poorly designed DMS messages that
the author has observed in different parts of the United States. Notes that highlight the reasons
for the recommended changes to the observed messages are also provided.
It should be noted that in the examples given the freeway and highway numbers and names have
been changed from the original.
MO
DU
LE 12 Modifying M
essages to Improve Effectiveness
Page 12-2
EXAMPLES OF IMPROVED MESSAGES FOR INCIDENTS
Table 12.1 Incident Messages
Old Message Recommended Message*
First Phase Second Phase First Phase Second Phase
Notes
ACCIDENT AHEAD
USE CAUTION
ACCIDENT
AT [location]
It is best to give the location of the incident. Knowledge of the
incident location is useful to motorists to make diversion and other
driving decisions.
AHEAD is redundant and need not be displayed because it is
understood by motorists that the accident is ahead on the freeway.
ACCIDENT AHEAD
21ST STREET
USE CAUTION
ACCIDENT
AT 21ST STREET
LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED
AT should be displayed before the location of the incident.
Knowledge of the number of lanes closed is useful to motorists to
evaluate the potential amount of delay.
Knowledge of which lanes are closed is useful to motorists to
determine which lanes they should use to travel past the incident.
AHEAD is redundant and need not be displayed because it is
understood by motorists that the accident is ahead on the freeway.
ACCIDENT AHEAD
I-84
EXPECT DELAYS
ACCIDENT
AT [location]
LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED
It is best to give the location of the incident rather than the
information that the accident is on I-84. If the DMS is on I-84, it
will be understood by motorists that the accident is on I-84 and it
need not be displayed.
Knowledge of the incident location is useful to motorists to make
diversion and other driving decisions.
Knowledge of the number of lanes closed is useful to motorists to
evaluate the potential amount of delay.
Knowledge of which lanes are closed is useful to motorists to
determine which lanes they should use to travel past the incident.
AHEAD is redundant and need not be displayed because it is
understood by motorists that the accident is ahead on I-84.
* Assumes 3- or 4-line, 20 character per line DMS.
MO
DU
LE 12 Modifying M
essages to Improve Effectiveness
Page 12-3
Old Message Recommended Message*
First Phase Second Phase First Phase Second Phase
Notes
ACCIDENT AHEAD
RIGHT LANES
USE CAUTION
ACCIDENT
AT [location]
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
It is best to give the location of the incident rather than the
information that the accident is ahead. Knowledge of the incident
location is useful to motorists to make diversion and other driving
decisions.
Knowledge of the number of lanes closed is useful to motorists to
evaluate the potential amount of delay.
AHEAD is redundant and need not be displayed because it is
understood by motorists that the accident is ahead.
ACCIDENT AHEAD
ONE RIGHT LANE
OPEN
ACCIDENT AHEAD
BROOK BRIDGE
EXPECT DELAYS
ACCIDENT
AT BROOK BRIDGE
LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED
The current message has five units of information and can be
reduced to three units.
Knowledge of the number of lanes closed is useful to motorists to
evaluate the potential amount of delay.
Knowledge of which lanes are closed is useful to motorists to
determine which lanes they should use to travel past the incident.
AHEAD is redundant and need not be displayed because it is
understood by motorists that the accident is ahead on the freeway.
ACCIDENT AHEAD
REDUCE SPEED
MERGE LEFT
RIGHT LANE
CLOSED AHEAD
DRIVE CAREFULLY
ACCIDENT
AT [location]
RIGHT LANE CLOSED
The current message has five units of information and can be
reduced to three units.
It is best to give the location of the accident. Knowledge of the
accident location is useful to motorists to make diversion and other
driving decisions.
Knowledge of the number of lanes closed is useful to motorists to
evaluate the potential amount of delay.
AHEAD is redundant and need not be displayed because it is
understood by motorists that the accident is ahead on the freeway.
MERGE LEFT is redundant to RIGHT LANE CLOSED and can be
omitted.
MO
DU
LE 12 Modifying M
essages to Improve Effectiveness
Page 12-4
Old Message Recommended Message*
First Phase Second Phase First Phase Second Phase
Notes
ALL LANES
CLOSED AHEAD
KEEP RIGHT
FREEWAY CLOSED
EXIT AT[location]
FOLLOW DETOUR
FREEWAY CLOSED is used rather than ALL LANES CLOSEDbecause it is shorter and means the same thing to motorists.
Telling motorists where to exit is useful.
Telling motorists to follow a detour that is set up because of the
closure gives motorists the assurance that they will have positive
guidance along the alternative route.
ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
If the DMS is located on I-84 East, the accident is understood to be
on I-84 East and it need not be displayed.
OTHER is used rather than ALTERNATE because it is shorter and
easier to read and will be understood by motorists.
ACCIDENT
IH-84 EAST
AT ROWLAND
USE
ALTERNATE
ROUTES
ACCIDENT
ON I-84 EAST
AT ROWLAND
USE
OTHER
ROUTES
If the DMS is located on a cross freeway to I-84 East, then ON I-84 EAST must be displayed.
I-84 should be used rather than IH-84. Human factors research by
TTI revealed that motorists do not understand “IH.”
IH-84 EAST
ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
USE
ALTERNATE
ROUTES
ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
If the DMS is located on I-84 EAST, the accident is understood to be
on I-84 EAST and it need not be displayed.
The problem ACCIDENT should always be on the top line.
OTHER is used rather than ALTERNATE because it is shorter and
easier to read and will be understood by motorists.
IH-84 EAST
ACCIDENT
DOWNTOWN
TWO RIGHT
LANES
CLOSED
ACCIDENT
PAST DOWNTOWN
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
If the DMS is located on I-84 East, the accident is understood to be
on I-84 East and it need not be displayed.
The problem ACCIDENT should always be on the top line.
2 should be used rather than TWO because it is shorter and more
easily read by motorists.
PAST is displayed in front of DOWNTOWN to reduce possibility of
confusion as to the location of the accident.
MO
DU
LE 12 Modifying M
essages to Improve Effectiveness
Page 12-5
Old Message Recommended Message*
First Phase Second Phase First Phase Second Phase
Notes
IH-84 EB AT
ROWLAND
MAJOR ACCIDENT
MAJOR ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
2 LANES CLOSED
The incident should be displayed on the top line followed by the
location.
The word AT should be separated from the first unit of information
and be placed with the location of the incident (second unit of
information). A message line should not contain portions of two
different units of information.
Knowledge of the number of lanes closed is useful to motorists to
evaluate the potential amount of delay.
Human factors research conducted by TTI revealed that a large
majority of Texas motorists do not understand the meaning of the
abbreviation EB.
IH-84 EAST
CLOSED AT
ROWLAND
USE
ALTERNATE
ROUTES
FREEWAY CLOSED
AT ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
FREEWAY is used rather than I-84 EAST because it is shorter and
easier to read and is well understood to mean the freeway on which
the motorist is traveling.
The word CLOSED from the first unit of information should be
separated from the word AT from the second unit of information. A
message line should not contain portions of two different units of
information.
OTHER is used rather than ALTERNATE because it is shorter and
easier to read.
IH-84 EB AT
ROWLAND
ACCIDENT
LEFT 2 LANES
CLOSED
EXPECT DELAY
ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED
If the DMS is located on I-84 EAST, the accident is understood to be
on I-84 EAST and it need not be displayed.
The word AT should be separated from the first unit of information
and be placed with the location of the incident (second unit of
information). A message line should not contain portions of two
different units of information.
Knowledge of the number of lanes closed is useful to motorists to
evaluate the potential amount of delay.
AHEAD is redundant and need not be displayed because it is
understood by motorists that the accident is ahead on I-84.
The abbreviation EB should not be used. Recent human factors
studies conducted by TTI indicated that a large percentage of Texas
motorists would not understand the abbreviation EB.
When two lanes are closed due to an accident, most motorists will
EXPECT DELAYS. Thus, it can be omitted.
MO
DU
LE 12 Modifying M
essages to Improve Effectiveness
Page 12-6
Old Message Recommended Message*
First Phase Second Phase First Phase Second Phase
Notes
IH-84 EB AT
ROWLAND
FREEWAY CLOSED
AVOID DELAY
USE
ALTERNATE ROUTES
FREEWAY CLOSED
AT ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
The current message has five units of information and can be
reduced to three units.
The incident should be displayed on the top line followed by the
incident location.
Human factors research conducted by TTI revealed that a large
majority of Texas motorists do not understand the meaning of the
abbreviation EB.
OTHER is used rather than ALTERNATE because it is shorter and
easier to read and will be understood by motorists
FREEWAY CLOSED
AT ROWLAND
MAJOR ACCIDENT
ALL TRAFFIC
EXIT
ROWLAND
FREEWAY CLOSED
EXIT AT ROWLAND
USE SERVICE RD
The current message has five units of information and can be
reduced to four units.
FREEWAY CLOSED is used rather than MAJOR ACCIDENTbecause it represents the immediate problem the motorists will face.
If the freeway is closed, the motorists will understand that ALLTRAFFIC must exit. The recommendation is to tell the motorists
that they should EXIT AT WASHINGTON and then USESERVICE ROAD to bypass the incident.
MAJOR ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
ON MAIN LANES
AVOID DELAY
USE
ALTERNATE ROUTE
MAJOR ACCIDENT
AT ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
Information that the accident is ON MAIN LANES will be
understood by motorists and it need not be displayed.
OTHER is used rather than ALTERNATE because it is shorter and
easier to read.
The motorist would assume that if told to use other routes the
motorist would avoid delay. Thus AVOID DELAY need not be
displayed.
MAJOR ACCIDENT AT
ROWLAND
CLEARED AT 5:10
LEFT 2 LANES
CLOSED
EXPECT DELAY
MAJOR ACCIDENT
AT ROWALAND
CLEARED AT 5:10
Conflicting information is given in the current message. The first
message phase states that the accident was cleared at 5:10; the
second phase states that two lanes are closed. The recommended
message is based on the assumption that the former is true.
MO
DU
LE 12 Modifying M
essages to Improve Effectiveness
Page 12-7
EXAMPLES OF IMPROVED MESSAGES FOR ROADWORK
Table 12.2 Roadwork Messages
Old Message Recommended Message*
First Phase Second Phase First Phase Second Phase
Notes
LEFT LANE
CLOSED AHEAD
EXPECT DELAY
LEFT LANE CLOSED
AT [location]
EXPECT DELAY
It is best to give the location of the lane closure. Knowledge of the
lane closure location is useful to motorists to make diversion and
other driving decisions.
AHEAD is redundant and need not be displayed because it is
understood by motorists that the lane closure is ahead on the
freeway.
RIGHT TWO LANES
CLOSED
KEEP LEFT
RIGHT 2 LANES CLOSED
AT [location]
It is best to give the location of the lane closure. Knowledge of the
lane closure location is useful to motorists to make diversion and
other driving decisions.
2 should be used rather than TWO because it is shorter and more
easily read by motorists.
KEEP LEFT is redundant and need not be displayed.
IH 84 REDUCED
TO ONE LANE
AHEAD
RIVERSIDE TO
WOODWARD
EXPECT DELAY
2 LANES CLOSED
FROM RIVERSIDE
TO WOODWARD
The current message has five units of information and can be
reduced to three units.
If the DMS is located on I-84, the lanes closures are understood to be
on I-84 and it need not be displayed.
Giving the limits of the lane closures as was done in the current
message is an excellent means of informing motorists the extent of
the closure and where they may return to the freeway should they
decide to divert.
LANE CLOSURES
BEGIN TUESDAY
8 P.M. - 6 A.M.
LANE CLOSURES
TUES - THURS
8 P.M. - 6 A.M.
1 LANE CLOSED
TUES - THURS
8 PM - 6 AM
The current message has two phases with only the middle line
changing information between phases. Motorists may not notice the
subtle change of only the middle line. The message can be reduced
to a simple one-phase, three-unit message.
TUES - THURS is more descriptive than BEGIN TUESDAY.
However, including it in the message would result in a five-unit
message.
* Assumes 3- or 4-line, 20 character per line DMS.
MO
DU
LE 12 Modifying M
essages to Improve Effectiveness
Page 12-8
Current Message Recommended Message*
First Phase Second Phase First Phase Second Phase
Notes
LEFT TWO LANES
CLOSED AT ROWLAND
CONSIDER DETOUR
LEFT 2 LANES CLOSED
AT ROWLAND
USE OTHER ROUTES
The word CLOSED in the first unit of information should be
separated from the second unit of information and be placed with the
problem (first unit of information). A message line should not
contain portions of two different units of information.
2 should be used rather than TWO because it is shorter and more
easily read by motorists.
USE OTHER ROUTES is used rather than CONSIDER DETOUR.
DETOUR implies to motorists that positive guidance will be
provided along a route in the form of trailblazers for motorists to
follow around the incident and/or police control.
RIGHT TWO
LANES CLOSED
DOWNTOWN
RIGHT 2 LANES
CLOSED
PAST DOWNTOWN
2 should be used rather than TWO because it is shorter and more
easily read by motorists.
PAST is displayed in front of DOWNTOWN to reduce possibility of
confusion as to the location of the lane closure.
CAUTION
INTERSTATE 84
EASTBOUND
RIGHT THREE
LANES CLOSED
AHEAD
3 RIGHT LANES
CLOSED
AT [location]
This current message has five units of information that can be
reduced to three units.
If the DMS is located on I-84 East, the lane closures are understood
to be on I-84 East and it need not be displayed.
3 should be used rather than THREE because it is shorter and more
easily read by motorists.
It is best to give the location of the lane closure. Knowledge of the
lane closure location is useful to motorists to make diversion and
other driving decisions.
The long word INTERSTATE should not be used; instead, use I-.
IH-84
EASTBOUND
RIGHT
THREE LANES
CLOSED
3 RIGHT LANES
CLOSED
AT [location]
If the DMS is located on I-84 EAST, the lane closures are
understood to be on I-84 EAST and it need not be displayed.
3 should be used rather than THREE because it is shorter and more
easily read by motorists.
It is best to give the location of the lane closure. Knowledge of the
lane closure location is useful to motorists to make diversion and
other driving decisions.
MO
DU
LE 12 Modifying M
essages to Improve Effectiveness
Page 12-9
Current Message Recommended Message*
First Phase Second Phase First Phase Second Phase
Notes
IH-84 EAST
DOWNTOWN
ROAD WORK
THRU TRAFFIC
USE LEFT
TWO LANES
ROADWORK
PAST DOWNTOWN
THRU TRAFFIC
USE
LEFT 2 LANES
The problem, ROADWORK should be displayed on the first line.
If the DMS is located on I-84 East, the roadwork is understood to be
on I-84 East and it need not be displayed.
2 should be used rather than TWO because it is shorter and more
easily read by motorists.
The second message phase is reformatted slightly to enhance
readability.
IH-84 EAST
ROAD WORK
AT
ROWLAND
ON RAMP
ROADWORK
AT ROWLAND
2 LANES CLOSED
The problem, ROADWORK should be displayed on the first line.
Since the DMS is located on I-84 East, the roadwork is understood to
be on I-84 East and it need not be displayed.
2 should be used rather than TWO because it is shorter and more
easily read by motorists.
The message should include the number of lanes that are closed.
US-65 SB EXIT
RAMP CLOSED
UNTIL DEC 1998
DETOUR
US-59 NORTH
TO MUNSON
RAMP TO US-65 S
CLOSED
USE
US-65 NORTH
TO MUNSON
The current message has six units of information and must be
reduced to a maximum of four units. This is accomplished by
omitting the least relevant unit of information, namely, UNTIL DEC 1998. About six days prior to the opening of the ramp, the DMS can
display the day of the week when the ramp will be open, if the
agency desires.
The abbreviation SB should not be used. Recent human factors
studies conducted by TTI indicated that a large majority of motorists
do not understand the meaning of the abbreviation SB.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-i
MODULE 13. PRIORITIES WHEN COMPETING
MESSAGE NEEDS ARISE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
13.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 13-1
13.2 BASIC MESSAGE PRIORITIES ................................................................. 13-1
13.3 COMMON TYPES OF COMPETING MESSAGE NEEDS........... 13-1
13.4 RESOLUTION OF COMMON TYPES OF COMPETING
MESSAGE NEEDS............................................................................................... 13-2
TWO EVENTS OCCUR CONCURRENTLY ON THE SAME FREEWAY ............... 13-3
Major Accident with Another Event ......................................................................... 13-3
Minor Accident with Another Event ......................................................................... 13-4
Construction with Another Event.............................................................................. 13-5
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) with Another Event ........................ 13-6
Disabled Vehicle with Another Event....................................................................... 13-7
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure with Another
Event.................................................................................................................... 13-8
Incidents (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Freeway Closures with
Another Event...................................................................................................... 13-9
Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s) with Another Event ...................... 13-10
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closures with Another
Event.................................................................................................................. 13-11
Special Event Exit with Another Event................................................................... 13-12
ONE EVENT OCCURS ON THE PRIMARY FREEWAY AND THE SECOND
OCCURS CONCURRENTLY ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY................ 13-13
Major Accident on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting
Freeway ............................................................................................................. 13-14
Minor Accident on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting
Freeway ............................................................................................................. 13-15
Construction on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting
Freeway ............................................................................................................. 13-16
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) on the Primary Freeway with
Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway ....................................................... 13-17
Disabled Vehicle on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an
Intersecting Freeway ......................................................................................... 13-18
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure on the Primary
Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway ................................ 13-19
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Closure of the Primary
Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway ................................ 13-20
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-ii
Maintenance Operations Requiring a Lane Closure on the Primary Freeway
with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway ............................................... 13-21
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Closure of the Primary Freeway with
Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway ....................................................... 13-22
Special Event Exit on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an
Intersecting Freeway ......................................................................................... 13-23
ONE EVENT OCCURS ON THE PRIMARY FREEWAY AND THE SECOND
OCCURS CONCURRENTLY ON A CONNECTING FREEWAY IN
AN OTHER STATE ................................................................................................ 13-24
TWO EVENTS OCCUR CONCURRENTLY ON AN INTERSECTING
FREEWAY.............................................................................................................. 13-25
Major Accident with Another Event ....................................................................... 13-25
Minor Accident with Another Event ....................................................................... 13-26
Construction with Another Event............................................................................ 13-27
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) with Another Event ...................... 13-28
Disabled Vehicle with Another Event..................................................................... 13-29
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure with Another
Event.................................................................................................................. 13-30
Incidents (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Freeway Closure with
Another Event.................................................................................................... 13-31
Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s) with Another Event ...................... 13-32
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closure with Another
Event.................................................................................................................. 13-33
Special Event Exit with Another Event................................................................... 13-34
ONE EVENT OCCURS ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY AND THE
SECOND OCCURS CONCURRENTLY ON A CONNECTING FREEWAY IN
ANOTHER STATE ...................................................................................................... 13-35
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-1
MODULE 13. PRIORITIES WHEN COMPETING
MESSAGE NEEDS ARISE
13.1 INTRODUCTION
Sometimes the DMS operator is faced with competing message needs when two or more
events take place at the same time. For example, the DMS may contain a message about a
downstream accident when a second accident occurs on the freeway. The DMS operator must
decide which of the two accidents should be presented on the DMS because it is neither possible
nor advisable to display information about two accidents. This Module is intended to provide
information to help the DMS operator resolve the most common types of competing message
needs that might arise.
13.2 BASIC MESSAGE PRIORITIES
There are a number of different combinations of events that can take place on the primary
freeway, on intersecting freeways, and on freeways in an adjoining state. In general, the
following priority principles shall apply:
! Messages about downstream lane closures (blockages) or full closures (blockages) on the
primary freeway receive priority over events on downstream intersecting freeways or on
freeways in other states, and
! Messages about lane closures (blockages) or full closures (blockages) on downstream
intersecting freeways receive priority over events on freeways in other states.
13.3 COMMON TYPES OF COMPETING MESSAGE NEEDS
Competing DMS message needs for incidents that occur downstream of the DMS can be
classified according to whether:
! Two events occur concurrently on the same freeway,
! One event occurs on the primary freeway and the second occurs concurrently on an
intersecting freeway,
! One event occurs on the primary freeway and the second occurs concurrently on a connecting
freeway in another state,
! Two events occur concurrently on an intersecting freeway, or
! One event occurs on an intersecting freeway and the second occurs concurrently on a
connecting freeway in another state.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-2
13.4 RESOLUTION OF COMMON TYPES OF COMPETING
MESSAGE NEEDS
This section provides guidance to the DMS operator about the priority of information display
when two concurrent events occur on the freeway(s) for each of the classifications given in
Section 13.3.
In establishing the priorities in this section, it is
assumed that incidents that occur on the
freeways have a good chance of adversely
affecting a large percentage of motorists on the
freeways. For example, a major incident on an
intersecting freeway may possibly have an
adverse affect on motorists who will turn off the
primary freeway onto the intersecting freeway.
However, if the major incident is downstream
(e.g., 10 miles) of the interchange, then the likelihood that the incident would affect motorists
turning onto the intersecting freeway would greatly diminish. The DMS operator should consult
with the TMC manager when the operator is uncertain about possible adverse affects to motorists
on the primary freeway.
THE DMS MESSAGE PRIORITIES ASSUME:
! Motorists who travel past the DMS will be
adversely affected by the incidents, and
! A high majority of motorists normally remain
on the primary freeway rather than turning
onto an intersecting freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-3
TWO EVENTS OCCUR CONCURRENTLY ON THE SAME FREEWAY
Major Accident with Another Event
The priorities of messages when a major accident occurs on the same freeway concurrently
with another event are summarized in Tables 13.1 and 13.2.
Table 13.1 Message Priority for Major Accidents That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Major Accident Occurs Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream major accident
! Construction project Upstream major accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream major accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream major accident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream major accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream major accident
! Special event exit Upstream major accident
! Adjoining state accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream major accident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream major accident
Table 13.2 Message Priority for Major Accidents That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Major Accident Occurs Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream major accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream major accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream major accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream major accident
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-4
Minor Accident with Another Event
The priorities of messages when a minor accident occurs on the same freeway concurrently
with another event are summarized in Tables 13.3 and 13.4.
Table 13.3 Message Priority for Minor Accidents That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Minor Accident Occurs Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream minor accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream minor accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream minor accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream minor accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream minor accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream minor accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream minor accident
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream minor accident
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream minor accident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream minor accident
Table 13.4 Message Priority for Minor Accidents That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Minor Accident Occurs Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream minor accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream minor accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream minor accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream minor accident
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-5
Construction with Another Event
The priorities of messages when construction is on the same freeway concurrently with
another event are summarized in Tables 13.5 and 13.6.
Table 13.5 Message Priority for Construction
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Construction Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream special event exit
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Adjoining state major accident
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Adjoining state maintenance
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Adjoining state incident
Table 13.6 Message Priority for Construction
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Construction Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-6
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) with Another Event
The priorities of messages when a temporary lane closure in a construction project occurs on
the same freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.7 and 13.8.
Table 13.7 Message Priority for Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s)
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) Upstream of Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream construction
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream construction
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream construction
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream construction
Table 13.8 Message Priority for Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s)
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s)
Downstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-7
Disabled Vehicle with Another Event
The priorities of messages when a lane-blocking disabled vehicle is on the same freeway
concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.9 and 13.10.
Table 13.9 Message Priority for Disabled Vehicles That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Disabled Vehicle Occurs Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Construction project Upstream disabled vehicle
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream disabled vehicle
Table 13.10 Message Priority for Disabled Vehicles That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Disabled Vehicle Occurs Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream disabled vehicle
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream disabled vehicle
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream disabled vehicle
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-8
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure with Another Event
The priorities of messages when an incident (load spill, debris, etc.) requiring a lane closure
occurs on the same freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.11 and
13.12.
Table 13.11 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Lane Closures That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Incident Requiring Lane Closure Occurs Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream incident
! Construction project Upstream incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream incident
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream incident
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream incident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream incident
Table 13.12 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Lane Closures That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Incident Requiring Lane Closure Occurs Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream incident
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-9
Incidents (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Freeway Closures with Another Event
The priorities of messages when an incident (load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure occurs on the same freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables
13.13 and 13.14.
Table 13.13 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Total Freeway Closures That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Incident Requiring Total Freeway Closure Occurs
Upstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream incident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream incident
! Construction project Upstream incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream incident
! Special event exit Upstream incident
! Adjoining state accident (Major) Upstream incident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream incident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream incident
Table 13.14 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Total Freeway Closures That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Incident Requiring Total Freeway Closure Occurs
Downstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream incident
! Construction project Downstream incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream incident
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-10
Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s) with Another Event
The priorities of messages when maintenance operations with lane closure(s) take place on
the same freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.15 and 13.16.
Table 13.15 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s)
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s)
Upstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream maintenance
Table 13.16 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s)
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s)
Downstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-11
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closures with Another Event
The priorities of messages when maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure take
place on the same freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.17 and
13.18.
Table 13.17 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closures
That Occur UPSTREAM of Another Event
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closure
Occurs Upstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream maintenance
! Accident (Minor) Upstream maintenance
! Construction project Upstream maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state accident (Major) Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream maintenance
Table 13.18 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closures
That Occur DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closure
Occurs Downstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream maintenance
! Construction project Downstream maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream maintenance
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream maintenance
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-12
Special Event Exit with Another Event
The priorities of messages when special event traffic uses the same freeway concurrently
with another event are summarized in Tables 13.19 and 13.20.
Table 13.19 Message Priority for Special Event Exit
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Special Event Exit Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream special event exit
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream special event exit
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream special event exit
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream special event exit
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream special event exit
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream special event exit
Table 13.20 Message Priority for Special Event Exit
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Special Event Exit) Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream special event exit
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-13
ONE EVENT OCCURS ON THE PRIMARY FREEWAY AND THE SECOND OCCURS
CONCURRENTLY ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY
The DMS message priorities when an event occurs on the primary freeway and a second
event occurs concurrently on an intersecting freeway will be dictated by the following:
! Whether the intersecting freeway is upstream or downstream of the event that occurs on the
primary freeway, and
! The distances the events on the primary freeway and the intersecting freeway are from the
DMS.
Message priorities for incidents that occur on the primary freeway upstream of an intersecting
freeway that also experiences an incident have been established and are summarized in the tables
that follow.
Because of the wide variety of issues
involved, it is not possible to specify a
single set of priorities for incidents that
occur on the primary freeway
downstream of an intersecting freeway
that concurrently experiences an incident.
Message priority in these latter cases will
be dictated by the relative location that
the incidents are from the DMS and the
likelihood that the incidents will affect
motorists who read the DMS message. Priority will be set separately for each case. The DMS
operator should consult the TMC manager whenever concurrent events occur on both the
primary freeway and on an upstream intersecting freeway.
USE THE TABLES BELOW:
! When an incident occurs concurrently on the primary
freeway and on an intersecting freeway that is
downstream of the primary freeway incident.
CONSULT THE TMC MANAGER:
! When an incident occurs concurrently on the primary
freeway and on an intersecting freeway that is
upstream of the primary freeway incident.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-14
Major Accident on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when a major accident occurs on the primary freeway
concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is UPSTREAM of the primary
freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.21.
Table 13.21 Message Priority for Major Accidents That Occur on the Primary Freeway
UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Major Accident Occurs on Primary Freeway Upstream of an
Intersecting Freeway Experiencing the Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF major accident
! Accident (Minor) PF major accident
! Construction project PF major accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF major accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF major accident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF major accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF major accident
! Special event exit PF major accident
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF major accident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF major accident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF major accident
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-15
Minor Accident on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when a minor accident occurs on the primary freeway
concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is UPSTREAM of the primary
freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.22.
Table 13.22 Message Priority for Minor Accidents That Occur on the Primary Freeway
UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Minor Accident Occurs on Primary Freeway Upstream of an
Intersecting Freeway Experiencing the Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF minor accident
! Accident (Minor) PF minor accident
! Construction project PF minor accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF minor accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF minor accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF minor accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF minor accident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF minor accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF minor accident
! Special event exit PF minor accident
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF minor accident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF minor accident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF minor accident
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-16
Construction on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when construction occurs on the primary freeway concurrently
with another event on an intersecting freeway that is UPSTREAM of the primary freeway
incident are summarized in Table 13.23.
Table 13.23 Message Priority for Construction on the Primary Freeway
UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Construction on Primary Freeway Upstream of an
Intersecting Freeway Experiencing the Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) Check with TMC manager! Accident (Minor) Check with TMC manager! Construction project PF construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Check with TMC manager! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Check with TMC manager! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Check with TMC manager! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Check with TMC manager
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Check with TMC manager! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Check with TMC manager! Special event exit Check with TMC manager! Adjoining state accident (Major) AS major accident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
AS maintenance
! Adjoining state load spill requiring total freeway closure AS incident A PF = Primary Freeway; AS = Adjoining State.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-17
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) on the Primary Freeway with Another
Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when construction with a temporary lane closure occurs on the
primary freeway concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is UPSTREAM
of the primary freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.24.
Table 13.24 Message Priority for Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) on the
Primary Freeway UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Construction with a Temporary Lane Closure on the Primary
Freeway Upstream of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing
the Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF construction
! Accident (Minor) PF construction
! Construction project PF construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF construction
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF construction
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF construction
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF construction
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF construction
! Special event exit PF construction
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF construction
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF construction
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF construction
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-18
Disabled Vehicle on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when a lane-blocking incident occurs on the primary freeway
concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is UPSTREAM of the primary
freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.25.
Table 13.25 Message Priority for Disabled Vehicles on the Primary Freeway
UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Disabled Vehicle on the Primary Freeway Upstream of an
Intersecting Freeway Experiencing the Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF disabled vehicle
! Accident (Minor) PF disabled vehicle
! Construction project PF disabled vehicle
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF disabled vehicle
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF disabled vehicle
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF disabled vehicle
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF disabled vehicle
! Special event exit PF disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF disabled vehicle
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-19
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure on the Primary Freeway with
Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when an incident (load spill, debris, etc.) requiring a lane occurs
on the primary freeway concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is
UPSTREAM of the primary freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.26.
Table 13.26 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Lane Closures on Primary Freeway
UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Incidents Requiring Lane Closure on Primary Freeway
Upstream of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing the
Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF incident
! Accident (Minor) PF incident
! Construction project PF incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF incident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF incident
! Special event exit PF incident
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF incident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF incident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF incident
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-20
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Closure of the Primary Freeway with
Another Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when an incident (load spill, debris, etc.) occurs requiring total
closure of the primary freeway concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is
UPSTREAM of the primary freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.27.
Table 13.27 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Total Closure of Primary Freeway
UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Incidents Requiring Total Closure of Primary Freeway
Upstream of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing the
Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF incident
! Accident (Minor) PF incident
! Construction project PF incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF incident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF incident
! Special event exit PF incident
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF incident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF incident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF incident
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-21
Maintenance Operations Requiring a Lane Closure on the Primary Freeway with Another
Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when maintenance operations requiring a lane closure take place
on the primary freeway concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is
UPSTREAM of the primary freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.28.
Table 13.28 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations Requiring Lane Closures on
Primary Freeway UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Maintenance Operations Requiring Lane Closure on Primary
Freeway Upstream of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing
the Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF maintenance
! Accident (Minor) PF maintenance
! Construction project PF maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF maintenance
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF maintenance
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF maintenance
! Special event exit PF maintenance
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF maintenance
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF maintenance
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF maintenance
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-22
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Closure of the Primary Freeway with Another
Event on an Intersecting Freeway
The priorities of messages when maintenance operations requiring total closure take place on
the primary freeway concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is
UPSTREAM of the primary freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.29.
Table 13.29 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Closure of Primary
Freeway UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Closure of Primary
Freeway Upstream of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing
the Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF maintenance
! Accident (Minor) PF maintenance
! Construction project PF maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF maintenance
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF maintenance
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF maintenance
! Special event exit PF maintenance
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF maintenance
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF maintenance
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF maintenance
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-23
Special Event Exit on the Primary Freeway with Another Event on an Intersecting
Freeway
The priorities of messages when maintenance operations requiring total closure take place on
the primary freeway concurrently with another event on an intersecting freeway that is
UPSTREAM of the primary freeway incident are summarized in Table 13.30.
Table 13.30 Message Priority for Special Event Exit on the Primary Freeway
UPSTREAM of an Intersecting Freeway Experiencing Another Event
Special Event Exit on Primary Freeway Upstream of an
Intersecting Freeway Experiencing the Following Event:
Give Message Priority to:A
! Accident (Major) PF special event exit
! Accident (Minor) PF special event exit
! Construction project PF special event exit
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) PF special event exit
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane PF special event exit
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure PF special event exit
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
PF special event exit
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) PF special event exit
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure PF special event exit
! Special event exit PF special event exit
! Adjoining state accident (Major) PF special event exit
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
PF special event exit
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
PF special event exit
A PF = Primary Freeway.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-24
ONE EVENT OCCURS ON THE PRIMARY FREEWAY AND THE SECOND OCCURS
CONCURRENTLY ON A CONNECTING FREEWAY IN ANOTHER STATE
Whenever there is a need to display a message for an event on the primary freeway in Texas, it
should receive priority over any request for messages to inform motorists of major incidents on a
connecting freeway in another state.
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-25
TWO EVENTS OCCUR CONCURRENTLY ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY
Major Accident with Another Event
The priorities of messages when a major accident occurs on the same intersecting freeway
concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.31 and 13.32.
Table 13.31 Message Priority for Major Accidents That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Major Accident Occurs Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream major accident
! Construction project Upstream major accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream major accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream major accident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream major accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream major accident
! Special event exit Upstream major accident
! Adjoining state accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream major accident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream major accident
Table 13.32 Message Priority for Major Accidents That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Major Accident Occurs Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream major accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream major accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream major accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream major accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream major accident
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-26
Minor Accident with Another Event
The priorities of messages when a minor accident occurs on the same intersecting freeway
concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.33 and 13.34.
Table 13.33 Message Priority for Minor Accidents That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Minor Accident Occurs Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream minor accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream minor accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream minor accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream minor accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream minor accident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream minor accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream minor accident
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream minor accident
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream minor accident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream minor accident
Table 13.34 Message Priority for Minor Accidents That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Minor Accident Occurs Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream minor accident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream minor accident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream minor accident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream minor accident
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-27
Construction with Another Event
The priorities of messages when construction is on the same intersecting freeway
concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.35 and 13.36.
Table 13.35 Message Priority for Construction
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Construction Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream special event exit
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Adjoining state major accident
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Adjoining state maintenance
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Adjoining state incident
Table 13.36 Message Priority for Construction
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Construction Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-28
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) with Another Event
The priorities of messages when a temporary lane closure in a construction project occurs on
the same intersecting freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.37
and 13.38.
Table 13.37 Message Priority for Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s)
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) Upstream of Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream construction
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream construction
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream construction
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream construction
Table 13.38 Message Priority for Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s)
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Construction with Temporary Lane Closure(s) Downstream
of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream construction
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-29
Disabled Vehicle with Another Event
The priorities of messages when a lane-blocking disabled vehicle is on the same intersecting
freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.39 and 13.40.
Table 13.39 Message Priority for Disabled Vehicles That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Disabled Vehicle Occurs Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Construction project Upstream disabled vehicle
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream disabled vehicle
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream disabled vehicle
Table 13.40 Message Priority for Disabled Vehicles That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Disabled Vehicle Occurs Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream disabled vehicle
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream disabled vehicle
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream disabled vehicle
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-30
Incident (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring a Lane Closure with Another Event
The priorities of messages when an incident (load spill, debris, etc.) requiring a lane closure
occurs on the same intersecting freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in
Tables 13.41 and 13.42.
Table 13.41 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Lane Closures That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Incident Requiring Lane Closure Occurs Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream incident
! Construction project Upstream incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream disabled vehicle
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream incident
! Special event exit Upstream incident
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream incident
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream incident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream incident
Table 13.42 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Lane Closures That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Incident Requiring Lane Closure Occurs Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream incident
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-31
Incidents (Load Spill, Debris, etc.) Requiring Total Freeway Closure with Another Event
The priorities of messages when an incident (load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure occurs on the same intersecting freeway concurrently with another event are summarized
in Tables 13.43 and 13.44.
Table 13.43 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Total Freeway Closures That Occur
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Incident Requiring Total Freeway Closure Occurs
Upstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream incident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream incident
! Construction project Upstream incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream incident
! Special event exit Upstream incident
! Adjoining state accident (Major) Upstream incident
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream incident
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream incident
Table 13.44 Message Priority for Incidents Requiring Total Freeway Closures That Occur
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Incident Requiring Total Freeway Closure Occurs
Downstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream incident
! Construction project Downstream incident
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream incident
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream incident
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-32
Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s) with Another Event
The priorities of messages when maintenance operations with lane closure(s) take place on
the same intersecting freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.45
and 13.46.
Table 13.45 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s)
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s)
Upstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream maintenance
Table 13.46 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s)
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Maintenance Operations with Lane Closure(s)
Downstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-33
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closure with Another Event
The priorities of messages when maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure take
place on the same intersecting freeway concurrently with another event are summarized in
Tables 13.47 and 13.48.
Table 13.47 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closures
That Occur UPSTREAM of Another Event
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closure
Occurs Upstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream maintenance
! Accident (Minor) Upstream maintenance
! Construction project Upstream maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state accident (Major) Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream maintenance
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream maintenance
Table 13.48 Message Priority for Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closures
That Occur DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Maintenance Operations Requiring Total Freeway Closure
Occurs Downstream of:
Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream maintenance
! Construction project Downstream maintenance
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Downstream maintenance
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream maintenance
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Downstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Downstream maintenance
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-34
Special Event Exit with Another Event
The priorities of messages when special event traffic uses the same intersecting freeway
concurrently with another event are summarized in Tables 13.49 and 13.50.
Table 13.49 Message Priority for Special Event Exit
UPSTREAM of Another Event
Special Event Exit Upstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Downstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Downstream minor accident
! Construction project Upstream special event exit
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream special event exit
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Downstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Downstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Downstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream special event exit
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Downstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
! Adjoining state: Accident (Major) Upstream special event exit
! Adjoining state: Maintenance operations requiring total
freeway closure
Upstream special event exit
! Adjoining state incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring
total freeway closure
Upstream special event exit
Table 13.50 Message Priority for Special Event Exit
DOWNSTREAM of Another Event
Special Event Exit) Downstream of: Give Message Priority to:
! Accident (Major) Upstream major accident
! Accident (Minor) Upstream minor accident
! Construction project Downstream special event exit
! Construction project with temporary lane closure(s) Upstream construction
! Disabled vehicle blocking a lane Upstream disabled vehicle
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring lane closure Upstream incident
! Incident (Load spill, debris, etc.) requiring total freeway
closure
Upstream incident
! Maintenance operations with lane closure(s) Upstream maintenance
! Maintenance operations requiring total freeway closure Upstream maintenance
! Special event exit Upstream special event exit
MODULE 13 Priorities When Competing Message Needs Arise Page 13-35
ONE EVENT OCCURS ON AN INTERSECTING FREEWAY AND THE SECOND
OCCURS CONCURRENTLY ON A CONNECTING FREEWAY IN ANOTHER STATE
Whenever there is a need to display a message for an event on an intersecting freeway in Texas,
it should receive priority over any request for messages to inform motorists of major incidents on
a connecting freeway in another state.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-i
MODULE 14. MESSAGE DESIGN EXAMPLES
FOR INCIDENTS: LARGE DMSs
TABLE OF CONTENTS
14.1 OBJECTIVES AND SUMMARY ................................................................. 14-1
14.2 INCIDENT EXAMPLES: ALL LANES ARE CLOSED .......................... 14-2
DEFINE SITUATION .................................................................................................... 14-3
Analyze Incident and Incident Scene Characteristics ............................................... 14-3
DEFINE MESSAGE FOR DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY
CLOSE TO THE INCIDENT (DMS #1) .................................................................. 14-4
Identify DMS Characteristics.................................................................................... 14-4
Review Conditions at the DMS Location.................................................................. 14-4
Identify Diversion Route Characteristics .................................................................. 14-4
Set Objectives............................................................................................................ 14-5
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ......................... 14-5
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS.............................................................. 14-6
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local
Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or
Fog....................................................................................................................... 14-6
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message.................. 14-6
Define Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ........................ 14-6
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary................................................. 14-8
Format the Message................................................................................................... 14-8
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................... 14-8
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ................................................................. 14-8
Finalize DMS Message ............................................................................................. 14-9
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorist to View the
DMS Message ................................................................................................... 14-10
DESIGN MESSAGE FOR DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY
FAR FROM THE INCIDENT (DMS #2)............................................................... 14-11
Identify DMS Characteristics.................................................................................. 14-11
Review Conditions at the DMS Location................................................................ 14-11
Identify Diversion Route Characteristics ................................................................ 14-11
Set Objectives.......................................................................................................... 14-12
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds ....................... 14-12
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric
Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS............................................................ 14-12
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-ii
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local
Environmental Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or
Fog..................................................................................................................... 14-13
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message................ 14-13
Define Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs ...................... 14-13
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary............................................... 14-14
Format the Message................................................................................................. 14-15
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS................................................................. 14-15
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less ............................................................... 14-15
Finalize DMS Message ........................................................................................... 14-16
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorist to View the
DMS Message ................................................................................................... 14-16
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-1
MODULE 14. DMS MESSAGE DESIGN EXAMPLES
FOR INCIDENTS: LARGE DMSs
14.1 OBJECTIVES AND SUMMARY
The objectives of Module 14 are to illustrate the:
DMS message design process that is detailed in Module 9 for incidents, and
Application of several design principles for messages displayed on large DMSs.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-2
14.2 INCIDENT EXAMPLES: ALL LANES ARE CLOSED
After their arrival, the police will close the freeway and in cooperation with the Emergency
Incident Response Team will set up a diversion (detour) route. The location of the crash, DMSs,
and diversion (detour) route are shown in Figure 14.1.
Figure 14.1 Locations of Crash, Dynamic Message Signs, and Diversion (Detour) Route
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-3
DEFINE SITUATION
Analyze Incident and Incident Scene Characteristics
1. What happened?
TMC personnel confirm that a major three-vehicle crash occurred. There appears to be a
fatality.
The DMS operator in the TMC pans the closed circuit television cameras to view the crash
scene.
2. Where?
On I-387 northbound just past I-22.
3. What lanes (how many) lanes are affected?
All lanes are closed.
4. What is the current time?
It is now 10:15 a.m.
5. How long do you expect the incident to block the lanes?
The nature of the crash with a fatality indicates that the crash will block all the lanes for 3
hours (until 1:00 p.m.).
6. What is the effect on traffic?
Even though the incident will not block lanes during an off-peak traffic period, congestion
will be severe because the northbound freeway will be closed for 3 hours.
7. Are the police on the scene to direct traffic or close the freeway?
Yes, the police have arrived and are directing traffic off the freeway at I-22.
8. Did the Emergency Incident Response Team arrive at the scene and implement the
preplanned traffic control plan including detour signs and trailblazers along the
preplanned diversion (detour) route?
Yes, the Team arrived and implemented the preplanned traffic control plan.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-4
DESIGN MESSAGE FOR DMS ON SAME FREEWAY AND RELATIVELY CLOSE TO
THE INCIDENT (DMS #1)
Identify DMS Characteristics
1. Where is the DMS located in relation to the incident/closure?
The DMS is on the same freeway as the incident and upstream and relatively close to the
incident. In addition, the DMS is located upstream of the exit to the primary diversion route.
2. What type of DMS is being used?
The sign is an LED DMS.
3. How many lines and characters per line on the DMS?
The overhead DMS has three lines, 20 characters per line.
Review Conditions at the DMS Location
1. What is the traffic operating speed at the DMS location?
Speeds have reduced to about 30 mph at the DMS location.
2. Are there any geometric features (vertical or horizontal curves) which will adversely
affect the motorists’ sight distance to the DMS?
Previous field inspections revealed that there are no geometric features that will adversely
affect the motorists’ sight distance to the DMS.
3. What are the current natural lighting conditions?
It is a bright sunlit day.
4. Is there rain or fog at the DMS location? If so, what are the degrees of each?
There is no rain or fog.
Identify Diversion Route Characteristics
1. Is a primary diversion route available?
The DMS operator has determined that a primary diversion route was previously identified
and documented by the TxDOT district. Agreements are in place between the TxDOT district
and the local agencies. Predetermined action plans have been published for diversion,
including types and locations of signs (both static and DMSs) and locations of police officers
to facilitate traffic movement during the freeway closure.
The established primary diversion route for I-387 North is as follows:
! I-22 East ramp onto I-22 East;
! Exit right for Oxford Road;
! Turn left onto Oxford Road;
! Cross over I-22;
! Turn left onto entrance ramp to I-22 West;
! Continue straight for I-387;
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-5
! Bear right for I-387 North;
! Use entrance ramp to I-387 North.
2. Is the primary diversion route complex for motorists?
The DMS operator concludes that the primary diversion route is complex. Therefore, it is
necessary for police or traffic control personnel to direct traffic at critical locations along the
diversion route, or that guide signs be available along the route to provide positive guidance
to motorists before the primary diversion route is given in the DMS message.
3. Are police or traffic control personnel directing traffic at critical locations along the
diversion route, or are guide signs available along the route to provide positive guidance
to motorists?
Yes.
4. Will a diversion message be displayed? If so, what type?
Because of the nature, severity, and potential duration of the incident, the Emergency
Incident Management Team installed detour signing along the designated route. In addition,
police are stationed at the established traffic control locations. A Type 5 diversion (detour)
route is in place.
Set Objectives
Based on the information in the previous sections, the DMS operator establishes the
following objectives to achieve with the DMS:
! Inform northbound I-387 motorists of freeway closure and location of closure, and
! Inform northbound I-387 motorists that they will detour at I-22 around the incident.
Because the incident is blocking all the lanes of the freeway, the freeway is closed, and the DMS
is on the same freeway and relatively close to the incident, the steps given in Section 9.3INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY on page 9-19 will be used to define
the Base DMS Message.
Even though the incident blocks all of the lanes at a location just past I-22, the primary situation
that confronts northbound I-387 motorists is that the normal route is closed at I-22. Therefore,
motorists must exit at I-22 and they can follow the detour to return to I-387 North.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speed at the DMS Location.
The freeway operating speed at the DMS location was determined to be 30 mph.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5.
Based on the sun’s position, it is initially determined from Table 7.2 that a maximum of five
units of information can be displayed on the DMS.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-6
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of
a Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
An examination of the data in Section 7.3 indicates that no reductions from the initial
maximum allowable five units of information need to be made because no vertical curve
geometric sight distance restriction exists. Therefore, go directly to Step 5.
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of
a Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
An examination of the data in Section 7.4 indicates that no reductions from the initial
maximum allowable five units of information need to be made because of no horizontal
curve geometric sight distance restriction exists. Therefore, go directly to Step 7.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
There is no rainfall. Therefore, go directly to Step 9.
Step 9 – Determine Whether Fog Exists near the DMS.
No fog. Therefore, go directly to Step 11.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Based on Steps 1 through 10, Finalize the Maximum Allowable Number of Units
of Information in the Message.
There are no reductions to the maximum allowable units of information found in Table 7.2.
Therefore, it is allowable to use up to five units of information on the DMS.
Define Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 - Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.28, page 5-31.
Incident Descriptor: MAJOR ACCIDENT
Step 13 - Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.29, page 5-32.
Incident Location: PAST I-22
Step 14 - Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.30, page 5-33.
Lanes Closed: ALL LANES CLOSED
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-7
Step 15 – Select Closure Location Message Element from Table 5.31, page 5-34.
Closure Location: AT I-22
Step 16 - Determine Whether Diversion Traffic Control is in Place.
“Yes.” Therefore, go directly to Step 20.
Step 20 – Select Type 5 Diversion (Detour) Route Action Message Element from Table 5.35,
page 5-38.
Action: EXIT AT I-22
FOLLOW DETOUR
Step 21 – Establish Whether Action Message Element Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
“No,” the Action message element applies to all motorists passing the DMS. Therefore, go
directly to Step 23.
Step 23 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route Will Be Perceived by Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
“Yes,” the detour route set up with signs and trailblazers is expected by motorists and will
provide positive guidance throughout. Therefore, go directly to Step 25.
Summary
In summary, the following Base DMS Message is suggested:
Incident Descriptor: MAJOR ACCIDENT (1 unit) Incident Location: PAST I-22 (1 unit) Lanes Closed: ALL LANES CLOSED (1 unit) Closure Location: AT I-22 (1 unit) Action: EXIT AT I-22 (1 unit) FOLLOW DETOUR (1 unit)
The Base DMS Message contains six units of information.
Notes:! An Audience for Action message element I-387 NORTH TRAFFIC is not needed because it
is understood that the Action applies to all northbound I-387 traffic.
! A Good Reason for Following the Action message element is not needed because the
motorists should know that motorists must leave the freeway when it is closed.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-8
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is
Greater than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
The Base Message requires six units of information, one more than the maximum of five
units identified in Step 11. Therefore, continue to Step 26.
Step 26 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the
Section on Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Using the guidelines beginning on page 8-15, the Base DMS Message is revised to read:
FREEWAY CLOSED (1 unit) EXIT AT I-22 (1 unit) FOLLOW DETOUR (1 unit)
The term FREEWAY CLOSED is used rather than ALL LANES CLOSED because it is
shorter and means the same thing to motorists.
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is
Greater than the Allowable from Step 11.
“No,” the message has been reduced to three units of information; the maximum allowable is
five units. Therefore, go directly to Step 32.
Format the Message
Step 32 – Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
The message format is consistent with the guidelines on page 8-6. Therefore, continue to
Step 33.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 33 – Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
“Yes,” the DMS that will be used to display the message has three lines. Therefore, go
directly to Step 35.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 35 – Determine Whether the Current DMS Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or
Less.
“Yes,” the current message can be displayed on three lines. Therefore, go directly to Step 37.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-9
Step 37 – Examine Whether There Are 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
“Yes,” the message contains only three units of information. Therefore, go directly to Step
39.
Step 39 – Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
“No,” the message elements are not split. Therefore, go directly to Step 41.
Step 41 – Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit
in the Available DMS Space.
“No,” the message is small enough to fit on the available DMS space. Therefore, go directly
to Step 45.
Finalize DMS Message
Step 45 – Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
An examination of the DMS message indicates that there are no inconsistencies in the
message. The motorist should understand the entire message. Therefore the message can be
accepted as final and can be displayed or stored in a message file.
Step 46 – Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
No adjustments are necessary. The following represents the final message:
FREEWAY CLOSED
EXIT AT I-22
FOLLOW DETOUR
Summary
Table 14.1 Comparison of DMS #1 Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information
Needs and Final Message for Incident #1
after Police Arrive
Base DMS Message
Elements
Base DMS Message to
Satisfy Motorist Information
Needs
Final Message
Incident Descriptor Incident Location Lanes Closed Closure Location Action
MAJOR ACCIDENT
PAST I-22
ALL LANES CLOSED
AT I-22
EXIT AT I-22
FOLLOW DETOUR
FREEWAY CLOSED
EXIT AT I-22
FOLLOW DETOUR
(6 Units of Information) (3 Units of Information)
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-10
You now have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or, consequently, the percentage who will not be able to see the DMS
message because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will
help the DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in
communicating the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-11
DESIGN MESSAGE FOR DMS ON SAME FREEWAY BUT RELATIVELY FAR FROM
THE INCIDENT (DMS #2)
Identify DMS Characteristics
1. Where is the DMS located in relation to the incident/closure?
The DMS is located on the same freeway as the incident and upstream and relatively far from
the incident. In addition, the DMS is located upstream of the exit to the primary diversion
route.
2. What type of DMS is being used?
The sign is an LED DMS.
3. How many lines and characters per line on the DMS?
The overhead DMS has three lines, 20 characters per line.
Review Conditions at the DMS Location
1. What is the traffic operating speed at the DMS location?
The operating speed at the DMS is about 60 mph at the DMS location.
2. Are there any geometric features (vertical or horizontal curves) which will adversely
affect the motorists’ sight distance to the DMS?
Previous field inspections revealed that there are no geometric features that will adversely
affect the motorists’ sight distance to the DMS.
3. What are the current natural lighting conditions?
It is a bright sunlit day.
4. Is there rain or fog at the DMS location? If so, what are the degrees of each?
There is no rain or fog.
Identify Diversion Route Characteristics
1. Is a primary diversion route available?
Although a primary diversion route has been identified for motorists viewing DMS #1, DMS
#2 is very far upstream of the freeway closure. It is desirable that motorists began to exit
from the freeway as soon as possible upstream of the closure in order to minimize the
congestion and delays on the freeway. However, no suitable single diversion route is
available for motorists viewing DMS #2.
2. Is the primary diversion route complex for motorists?
(Not Applicable)
3. Are police or traffic control personnel directing traffic at critical locations along the
diversion route, or are guide signs available along the route to provide positive guidance
to motorists.
(Not Applicable)
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-12
4. Will a diversion message be displayed? If so, what type?
Because of the nature, severity, and potential duration of the incident, it is desirable to
display a diversion message. The situation dictates that a “soft” diversion message can be
displayed. The DMS operator decides to display a message with “soft” diversion.
Set Objectives
Based on the information in the previous sections, the DMS operator establishes the
following objectives to achieve with the DMS:
! Inform northbound I-387 motorists of freeway closure and location of closure, and
! Recommend that northbound I-387 motorists located south of I-22 interchange to use
alternative routes.
Because the incident is blocking all the lanes of the freeway, the freeway is closed and the DMS
is on the same freeway but relatively far from the incident, the steps given in Section 10.3INCIDENTS THAT REQUIRE CLOSING THE FREEWAY on page 10-38 will be used to define
the Base DMS Message.
Even though the incident blocks all of the lanes at a location just past I-22, the primary situation
that confronts northbound I-387 motorists is that the normal route is closed at I-22.
Establish Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the Message
Based on DMS Type and Freeway Operating Speeds
Step 1 – Determine Freeway Operating Speed at the DMS Location.
The freeway operating speed at the DMS location was determined to be 60 mph.
Step 2 – Determine the Initial Maximum Allowable Number of Units of Information in the
Message from Table 7.2, page 7-5.
Based on the sun’s position, it is initially determined from Table 7.2 that a maximum
allowable of four units of information can be displayed on the DMS.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Geometric Sight Distance
Restrictions to the DMS
Step 3 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of
a Vertical Curve Using the Guidelines in SECTION 7.3 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR VERTICAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-6.
An examination of the data in Section 7.3 indicates that no reductions from the initial
maximum allowable four units of information need to be made because no vertical curve
geometric sight distance restriction exists. Therefore, go directly to Step 5.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-13
Step 5 – Determine Whether There Are Sight Distance Restrictions to the DMS Because of
a Horizontal Curve Using the Guidelines in Section 7.4 UNITS OF INFORMATION REDUCTIONS FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES – LED DMSs on page 7-10.
An examination of the data in Section 7.4 indicates that no reductions from the initial
maximum allowable four units of information need to be made because of no horizontal
curve geometric sight distance restriction exists. Therefore, go directly to Step 7.
Assess Whether the Message Must Be Reduced Because of Local Environmental Sight
Distance Restrictions to the DMS Due to Rain or Fog
Step 7 – Determine Whether Rainfall near the DMS Exceeds 2 Inches per Hour.
There is no rainfall. Therefore, go directly to Step 9.
Step 9. Determine Whether Fog Exists near the DMS.
No fog. Therefore, go directly to Step 11.
Finalize the Maximum Allowable Units of Information in the Message
Step 11 – Based on Steps 1 through 10, Finalize the Maximum Allowable Number of Units
of Information in the Message.
There are no reductions to the maximum allowable units of information found in Table 7.2.
Therefore, it is allowable to use up to four units of information on the DMS.
Define Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information Needs
Step 12 - Select Incident Descriptor Message Element from Table 5.38, page 5-41.
Incident Descriptor: MAJOR ACCIDENT
Step 13 - Select Incident Location Message Element from Table 5.39, page 5-42.
Closure Location: PAST I-22
Step 14 - Select Lanes Closed Message Element from Table 5.40, page 5-43.
Lanes Closed: ALL LANES CLOSED
Step 15 - Select Closure Location Message Element from Table 5.41, page 5-44.
Closure Location: AT I-22
Step 16 – Establish Whether Diversion Action Should Be Recommended.
“Yes.” The anticipated very congested traffic downstream justifies advising motorists at this
DMS location to divert. Therefore, continue to Step 18.
Step 18 – Establish Whether “Soft” Diversion Should Be Recommended.
“Yes.” There are no suitable alternative routes that can be specified for the motorists at the
DMS location. However, it is appropriate (and desirable) to use a “soft” diversion message
element. Therefore, continue to Step 19.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-14
Step 19 - Select “Soft” Diversion Action Message Element from Table 5.44, page 5-47.
Action: USE OTHER ROUTES
Go to Step 23.
Step 23 – Establish Whether Action Message Element Is for a Select Group of Motorists.
“No,” the Action message element applies to all motorists passing the DMS. Therefore, go
directly to Step 25.
Step 25 – Examine Whether the Diversion Route Will Be Perceived by Motorists as Being a
Most Logical Route.
No specific route will be given since a “soft” diversion will be displayed. This step does not
apply in this case. Therefore, go directly to Step 27.
Summary
In summary, the following Base DMS Message is suggested:
Incident Descriptor: MAJOR ACCIDENT (1 unit) Incident Location PAST I-22 (1 unit)
Lanes Closed ALL LANES CLOSED (1 unit) Closure Location AT I-22 (1 unit) Action USE OTHER ROUTES (1 unit)
The Base DMS Message contains five units of information.
Notes:! An Audience for Action message element I-387 NORTH TRAFFIC is not needed because it
is understood that the Action applies to all northbound I-387 traffic.
! A One Good Reason for Following the Action Statement message element is not needed
because the motorists should know that motorists must leave the freeway when it is closed.
Reduce the Number of Message Units If Necessary
Step 27 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is
Greater than the Maximum Allowable from Step 11.
The Base Message requires five units of information, one more than the maximum of four
units identified in Step 11. Therefore, continue to Step 28.
Step 28 – Omit Incident Descriptor Message Element According to Guidelines in the
Section on Combining Message Elements for Incident Messages Beginning on page 8-15.
Using the guidelines beginning on page 8-15, the Base DMS Message is revised to read:
FREEWAY CLOSED (1 unit) AT I-22 (1 unit) USE OTHER ROUTES (1 unit)
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-15
The term FREEWAY CLOSED is used rather than ALL LANES CLOSED because it is
shorter and means the same thing to motorists.
Step 29 – Examine Whether the Number of Units of Information in the Base Message Is
Greater than the Allowable from Step 11.
“No,” the message has been reduced to three units of information; the maximum allowable is
four units. Therefore, go directly to Step 34.
Format the Message
Step 34 - Format the Message According to Guidelines in the Section on FORMATTINGMESSAGES on page 8-6.
The message format is consistent with the guidelines on page 8-6. Therefore, continue to
Step 35.
Adjust Message to Fit on Existing DMS
Step 35 - Determine Whether the DMS Has 4 Lines.
“Yes”, the DMS that will be used to display the message has three lines. Therefore, go
directly to Step 37.
Adjust Message to Fit on 3 Lines or Less
Step 37 - Determine Whether the Message Can Be Displayed on 3 Lines or Less.
“Yes,” the message has 3 lines. Therefore, go directly to Step 39.
Step 39 - Examine Whether 3 or Fewer Decision-Relevant Units of Information Are
Displayed on Each of the Phases.
“Yes,” the one-phase message has three units of information. Therefore, go directly to Step
41.
Step 41 - Examine Whether Message Elements Are Split in Such a Way That a Part of One
Message Element Is on the Same Line as a Part of a Second Message Element.
“No.” A review of the DMS message reveals that the message elements are separated such
that part of one message element is not on the same line as part of a second message element.
Therefore, go directly to Step 43.
Step 43 - Examine Whether the Message or Any of the Message Lines Are Too Long to Fit
in the Available DMS Space.
“No,” since the DMS has space for 20 characters on each line, no message line exceeds the
space on the sign. Therefore, go directly to Step 47.
MODULE 14 Message Design Examples for Incidents: Large DMSs Page 14-16
Finalize DMS Message
Step 47 - Review Message for Inconsistencies and Incompatibility.
An examination of the DMS message indicates that there are no inconsistencies in the
message. The motorist should understand the entire message. Therefore the message can be
accepted as final and can be displayed or stored in a message file.
Step 48 - Make Additional Adjustments if Necessary.
No adjustments are necessary. The following represents the final message:
FREEWAY CLOSED
AT I-22
USE OTHER ROUTES
Summary
Table 14.2 Comparison of DMS #2 Base DMS Message to Satisfy Motorist Information
Needs and Final Message For Incident #1
after Police Arrive
Base DMS Message
Elements
Base DMS Message to
Satisfy Motorist Information
Needs
Final Message
Incident Descriptor Incident Location Lanes Closed Closure Location Action
MAJOR ACCIDENT
PAST I-22
ALL LANES CLOSED
AT I-22
USE OTHER ROUTES
FREEWAY CLOSED
AT I-22
USE OTHER ROUTES
(5 Units of Information) (3 Units of Information)
You now have an acceptable message ready to display or to store in the DMS message library.
Assess Effects of Large Trucks on the Ability of Motorists to View the DMS Message
The final step in the process is to assess the effects of large trucks in the traffic stream on the
ability of motorists to see the DMS and read the message. Tables 7.14 through 7.17 on pages 7-
21 and 7-22 should be studied to determine the percentage of motorists who will be able to see
the DMS message (or consequently, the percentage that will not be able to see the DMS message
because their visibility to the sign is blocked by large trucks). This information will help the
DMS operator and the TMC manager to determine the potential effectiveness in communicating
the message to the motorists in the traffic stream.
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-i
MODULE 15. AMBER ALERT
TABLE OF CONTENTS 15.1 BACKGROUND, PROGRAMS, AND POLICIES .............................. 15-1 FEDERAL AMBER PLAN PROGRAM AND POLICIES ........................................... 15-1 TEXAS AMBER ALERT NETWORK AND POLICIES.............................................. 15-2 TXDOT AMBER ALERT COORDINATION............................................................... 15-3 15.2 MESSAGE ELEMENTS ................................................................................... 15-3 PRIORITY OF INFORMATION ................................................................................... 15-3 SITUATION DESCRIPTOR .......................................................................................... 15-4 VEHICLE DESCRIPTION............................................................................................. 15-4 LICENSE PLATE NUMBER......................................................................................... 15-4 TELEPHONE NUMBER................................................................................................ 15-5 TUNE TO RADIO .......................................................................................................... 15-6 15.3 MESSAGES.............................................................................................................. 15-6 ISSUES WITH MESSAGES CONTAINING VEHICLE DESCRIPTOR AND/OR A LICENSE PLATE NUMBER............................................................... 15-7 SCENARIOS AND MESSAGES ................................................................................... 15-7
Revised July 2006
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-1
MODULE 15. AMBER ALERT
15.1 BACKGROUND, PROGRAMS, AND POLICIES AMBER (America’s Missing: Broadcast Emergency Response) alert is a notification program to help locate missing children believed to have been abducted. The Emergency Alert System (formerly known as the Emergency Broadcast System) is used to alert the public via television and radio in the event of an AMBER alert. America’s AMBER Plan Program is a voluntary program. In August 2002, the California Department of Transportation began using DMSs to provide AMBER alert information. Since then, virtually every state and most local transportation agencies that own and operate DMSs have become actively involved in responding when AMBER alerts are issued. AMBER alert messages displayed on DMSs are receiving positive reactions from the public. FEDERAL AMBER PLAN PROGRAM AND POLICIES FHWA recognized the value of the AMBER Plan Program and fully supports state and local governments’ choice to implement this program. A Memorandum “AMBER Alert Use of Changeable Message Sign (CMS)” dated August 16, 2002 (http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsregs/directives/policy/ambermemo.htm) was prepared to clarify FHWA policy on the use of CMSs to display child abduction messages as part of an AMBER Plan Program. Parts of the Memorandum that relate to policies and guidelines are presented below. (Note, FHWA uses the term changeable message signs (CMSs) in its policies.)
“If public agencies decide to display AMBER Alert or child abduction messages on a CMS [changeable message sign], FHWA has determined that this application is acceptable only if (A) it is part of a well-established local AMBER Plan Program, and (B) public agencies have developed a formal policy that governs the operation and messages that are displayed on CMS.
(A) A local AMBER Plan Program would include written criteria for issuing and calling off an AMBER Alert, procedures on issues to coordinate with local agencies and other interests, and conforms to the recommendations of the national program. Specific criteria for issuing an Alert and the associated procedures may include:
1. Confirmation that a child has been abducted, 2. Belief that the circumstances surrounding the abduction indicate that the child
is in danger of serious bodily harm or death, and 3. Enough descriptive information about the child, abductor, and/or suspect’s
vehicle to believe an immediate broadcast alert will help.
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-2
(B) The formal public agency policy and procedures relating to displaying AMBER Alert or child abduction messages on CMS must address the following issues: 1. The criteria under which CMS will be used for AMBER Alerts. 2. Clear identification of the law enforcement agency responsible for issuing the
alert (e.g., State police, local police department, etc.). 3. Agencies, interests, and persons to be contacted and information to be
disseminated to initiate or call off an AMBER Alert. 4. Specific recognition that traffic messages, such as lane closures, fog alerts,
detours, etc., are the highest priority, and circumstances under which the AMBER Alert message could or could not be displayed.
5. Length of time to display the message (should be of short duration, typically a few hours). (Note: 4 and 5 should be defined in cooperation with the responsible law enforcement agency based on the specific circumstances of the abduction.)
6. Geographic area over which the information is to be displayed (should be limited to a reasonable search distance that is reachable within a few hours).
7. Circumstances that would cause the discontinuation of use of the CMS if the AMBER Alert message creates an adverse traffic impact such as queues, markedly slowing of traffic, etc.
8. Format and content of the messages to be displayed. Agencies should follow the recommended national CMS practices related to the development, use of text, manner in which messages should be displayed, and how CMS are operated.”
FHWA noted in the Memorandum that CMSs are not always the most effective or safest method to disseminate information related to child abductions and clarified its policy on the use of DMS for displaying AMBER alert messages. Since the CMS can convey only a limited amount of information to motorists, when there is a need to provide more extensive information to motorists, it is critical that other types of traveler information services (e.g., 511 travel information telephone services, highway advisory radio (HAR), web sites, commercial radio) be used, and that the messages displayed on a CMS supplement these other services. TEXAS AMBER ALERT NETWORK AND POLICIES The Texas Amber Alert Network was activated by Governor Rick Perry to “ensure that every available resource is used to return abducted children safely to their loved ones.” (http://www.governor.state.tx.us/divisions/press/initiatives/amber) The Texas Department of Public Safety is in charge of the statewide system, but any Texas law enforcement agency has the ability to activate this network of resources when needed. When the system is activated, media outlets receive notification of an abducted child and TxDOT displays AMBER alert information on DMSs. To activate the network, the law enforcement agency with jurisdiction must determine that the case meets the following criteria:
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-3
• The child is 17 years of age or younger. • The local law enforcement agency believes that the child has been abducted, that is,
unwillingly taken from his/her environment without permission from the child’s parent or legal guardian who commits an act of murder or attempted murder during the time of the abduction.
• The local law enforcement agency believes that the missing child is in immediate danger of serious bodily harm or death.
• The local law enforcement agency confirms that an investigation has taken place that verifies the abduction and has eliminated alternative explanations for the missing child.
• Sufficient information is available to disseminate to the public that could assist in locating the child, the suspect, or the vehicle used in the abduction.
• Upon verification of the activation request, the Governor’s Division of Emergency Management determines the circumference of the search area and issues the alert. Alerts are distributed to: √ TxDOT’s Traffic Management Center (for messages on highway signs), √ National Weather Service’s Texas Warning System (for broadcast on radio and
television stations), √ Law enforcement agencies, √ Texas Missing Persons Clearinghouse, and √ Texas Office of the Governor.
TXDOT AMBER ALERT COORDINATION It is important that AMBER alert messages are designed and displayed on DMSs uniformly across the state. In TxDOT, Traffic Engineering (TE) is responsible for the format used for the messages so that they meet MUTCD requirements and provide complete information. AMBER alert messages are displayed after the Department of Public Safety (DPS) in Austin provides information to TxDOT about the event. Authorization for AMBER alert comes from DPS Austin. DPS contacts the TxDOT AMBER alert coordinator who then contacts the Districts. 15.2 MESSAGE ELEMENTS PRIORITY OF INFORMATION Results of research indicated that drivers in Texas place the following order of importance on the elements of an AMBER alert message:
1. Situation descriptor The priority order of motorist information needs for an AMBER alert message is: • Situation descriptor • Vehicle description • License plate number • Telephone number (to dial) • Tune to radio (local station or HAR)
2. Vehicle description 3. License plate number 4. Telephone number (to dial) 5. Tune to radio (local station or HAR)
Revised July 2006
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-4
SITUATION DESCRIPTOR The situation descriptor specifies the event and should always be displayed on the top line of the DMS. Ninety-six percent of drivers sampled in Texas selected the situation descriptor as the most important part of an AMBER alert message. TxDOT uses the situation descriptor KIDNAPPED CHILD. Currently, no strong research evidence exists to change this practice, but there is indication that the term AMBER ALERT should be considered in the future. Greater numbers of drivers are becoming familiar with the term because of its common use by broadcast and print media.
The situation descriptor term KIDNAPPED CHILD should be displayed on the top line. The term AMBER ALERT may be a more acceptable term in the future. The term MISSING CHILD should not be used.
Results of a recent study in Texas showed that 32 percent of the subjects in the study chose AMBER ALERT as the preferred descriptor, whereas 22 percent selected ABDUCTED CHILD and 15 percent chose KIDNAPPED CHILD. The term MISSING CHILD should not be used because it has the connotation that a child may not be in a dangerous situation. For example, MISSING CHILD could imply that the child was taken by a family member and is not in a dangerous situation. VEHICLE DESCRIPTION When a vehicle description is displayed as part of the message, it should contain the color, make, and vehicle type if it is different from an automobile (e.g., pickup, van, etc.). The year of the vehicle is optional. Many motorists are not able to identify the differences among vehicle model years.
When the vehicle description and the license plate number are both known, the vehicle description should be displayed on the second line and the license plate number displayed on the third line. A vehicle description should never be displayed unless the license plate number is also displayed.
The vehicle description should never be displayed unless the license plate number is also displayed. LICENSE PLATE NUMBER When used in a message, the license plate number should be displayed in the style shown below.
LIC # ABC-123 Use “#” preceding the number and a dash between the sets of numbers (letters). A license plate number should always be displayed whenever a vehicle descriptor is in the message.
The symbol “#” should be placed before the license plate number.
Revised July 2006
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-5
It should be recognized that a license plate number is equivalent to three units of information. (See Message Load and Unit of Information on page 4-6 of the Manual for a definition and description of “units of information.”) Thus, a message containing the situation descriptor, vehicle descriptor, and a license plate number has six units of information. Guidelines given on page 4-6 of the Manual specify that when freeway operating speeds are greater than 35 mph, no more than four units of information should be displayed in a message. In addition, no more than three units of information should be displayed on one phase (frame). The message containing the situation descriptor, vehicle descriptor, and a license plate number violates proven guidelines and exceeds the information processing capabilities of most drivers. Therefore, it should be expected that motorists will not be able to recall the entire license plate number.
A license plate number is equivalent to three units of information. When a license plate number is used in the message, the message far exceeds the maximum number of units of information that motorists can read and recall. The majority of motorists will not be able to read and recall the entire license plate number.
Almost all motorists recognize the abbreviation LIC for license plate. In addition, about 75 percent will recall the first three digits of the license plate number, and only about 40 percent will also recall the last three digits. When the vehicle has an out-of-state license plate number, the specific state should be shown using the standard two-digit abbreviation for the state. The state abbreviation should be placed in front of the license number in the style shown below.
MA LIC # DE4-567 Many motorists will have difficulty remembering the abbreviation for some of the states and therefore, may not recognize the state where the vehicle is registered. Regardless of the inability of motorists to identify the abbreviations for some of the states, surveyed motorists feel it is important to know that the vehicle is from out-of-state. It is not advisable or necessary to use an abbreviation for “Texas.” In the absence of a state abbreviation, motorists will assume that the vehicle has a Texas license plate. TELEPHONE NUMBER Motorists surveyed in Texas indicated that a contact telephone number was the next most important information to include in a DMS message after the situation descriptor, vehicle description, and vehicle license plate number. In the absence of a specific telephone number to call, motorists are most likely to dial 911 if they believe they have seen the sought-after vehicle or child.
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-6
If a telephone number is included in an AMBER alert message, it should be short. Typical 10-digit telephone numbers are equivalent to three units of information. Thus, by including a 10-digit number, the message will exceed the maximum units of information specified in the guidelines given on page 4-6 in the Manual. The result is that the large majority of motorists will not recall the number.
A typical 10-digit telephone numbers is equivalent to three units of information. When a 10-digit telephone number is used in the message, the message will exceed the maximum number of units of information that motorists can read and recall. When used, telephone numbers should be short and easy to remember.
The national traveler information number 511 is a good example of a short number that can be easily remembered by motorists. If a simple three-digit number is not available for use for Amber Alerts, other options include acquiring and using a telephone number with words that can be easily remembered (e.g., FIND A CHILD). When a telephone number is displayed, the preferred action word preceding the number is CALL rather than DIAL. An example of an easily remembered telephone number is shown below.
CALL 1 FIND A CHILD TUNE TO RADIO Motorists surveyed in Texas indicated that knowing a radio (HAR) station to tune to was by far the least important information in comparison to the four message elements discussed above. When advice is given for motorists to tune to the radio, it is important to post the specific radio station number and whether the station is AM or FM. Examples of appropriate message elements are shown below.
When advice is given to tune to the radio, the frequency and the abbreviation AM or FM should be included.
TUNE TO 530 AM TUNE RADIO TO 530 AM
Revised July 2006
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-7
15.3 MESSAGES The specific message displayed will be influenced by the specific information that the DMS operator has concerning the child abduction and the information transfer media that will be used to inform motorists. ISSUES WITH MESSAGES CONTAINING A VEHICLE DESCRIPTOR AND/OR A LICENSE PLATE NUMBER As discussed in Section 15.2, motorists want information about the vehicle description and the license plate number. However, messages containing the vehicle descriptor and/or license plate number far exceed the reading and understanding capabilities of the majority of motorists. Therefore, it should be expected that most motorists will not be able to read and recall all the information displayed on the DMS, particularly the entire license plate number and/or the entire telephone number. Messages that are too long or too complex to read and understand are undesirable because drivers may fail to read the messages that require changes in driving actions on their part or that may affect safety. However, AMBER alert messages are not designed to enhance driving behavior or safety, but are designed to provide secondary information (i.e., kidnapped child). Given the very positive reaction by the public and public officials to displaying AMBER alert messages on DMSs, it seems logical that the vehicle description and license plate number—stated as important by motorists—should be displayed if the information is available to the DMS operator, even though all of the information may not be assimilated by motorists. It is likely that as motorists pass more than one DMS containing the AMBER alert message, they will “pick up” more information. Thus, TxDOT may elect to display AMBER alert messages that exceed the maximum number of units of information. However, if drivers begin to reduce speed to read the messages, then TxDOT should rescind this practice in favor of messages with fewer units of information. SCENARIOS AND MESSAGES The recommended messages for a number of scenarios are given in the sections that follow. Message Scenario 1 Known
• Vehicle description • Vehicle license plate
Available • Telephone number to call • HAR station broadcasting AMBER alert message
Message style options for the conditions above are shown below.
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-8
KIDNAPPED CHILD BLUE TRAILBLAZER
LIC # ABC-123
Style Option 1
KIDNAPPED CHILD
BLUE CHEV SUV LIC # ABC-123
Style Option 2
NOTE: Each of the messages above contains six units of information, which violates guidelines with respect to the maximum number of four units of information that should be displayed in a message. Each message also exceeds the maximum number of three units of information that should be displayed in a phase. The majority of motorists will not be able to read and recall the entire message. Message Scenario 2 Known
• Vehicle license plate
Available • Telephone number to call • HAR station broadcasting AMBER alert message
Unknown
• Vehicle description
The message for the conditions above is shown below.
KIDNAPPED CHILD LIC # ABC-123
TUNE TO 530 AM NOTE: The message contains five units of information, which violates guidelines with respect to the maximum number of four units of information that should be displayed in a message. In addition, the message exceeds the maximum number of three units of information that should be displayed in a phase. The majority of motorists will not be able to read and recall the entire message, particularly the license plate number.
MODULE 15 AMBER Alert 15-9
Message Scenario 3 Known
• Vehicle description
Available • Telephone number to call • HAR station broadcasting AMBER alert message
Unknown
• Vehicle license plate
The message options for the conditions above are shown below.
KIDNAPPED CHILD CALL 1 FIND A CHILD
Option 1
KIDNAPPED CHILD
TUNE TO 530 AM
Option 2 Message Scenario 4 Known
• Vehicle description
Not Available • Telephone number to call • HAR station broadcasting AMBER alert message
Unknown
• Vehicle license plate
For this scenario, an AMBER alert message should not be displayed.
MODULE 16 Catastrophic Event Page 16-i
MODULE 16. CATASTROPHIC EVENT
TABLE OF CONTENTS 16.1 BACKGROUND, PROGRAMS, AND POLICIES .............................. 16-1 NATIONAL INCIDENT MANAGEMENT SYSTEM – INCIDENT COMMAND SYSTEM ................................................................................................................... 16-1 THE TEXAS OFFICE OF HOMELAND SECURITY.................................................. 16-1 THE GOVERNOR’S DIVISION OF EMERGENCY MANAGEMENT...................... 16-1 THE STATE OPERATIONS CENTER ......................................................................... 16-1 TEXAS SECURITY ANALYSIS AND ALERT CENTER........................................... 16-2 FEDERAL HIGHWAY ADMINISTRATION POLICY ON EMERGENCY OR SECURITY ALERT MESSAGES............................................................................ 16-2 16.2 MESSAGES.............................................................................................................. 16-3 CLOSING ACCESS TO THE CITY (AREA)................................................................ 16-3 DMS Relatively Close to the Event .......................................................................... 16-3 DMS Far from the Event ........................................................................................... 16-4 EVACUATION OF THE CITY (AREA) ....................................................................... 16-4
MODULE 16 Catastrophic Event Page 16-1
MODULE 16. CATASTROPHIC EVENT 16.1 BACKGROUND, PROGRAMS, AND POLICIES
NATIONAL INCIDENT MANAGEMENT SYSTEM – INCIDENT COMMAND SYSTEM Homeland Security Presidential Directive (HSPD-5), Management of Domestic Incidents, requires all federal departments and agencies to adopt the National Incident Management System (NIMS) and to use it in domestic incident management. The NIMS provides a consistent nationwide approach for federal, state, territorial, tribal, and local governments to work effectively and efficiently together to prepare for, prevent, respond to, and recover from domestic incidents, regardless of cause, size, or complexity. On March 1, 2004, the Department of Homeland Security (DHS) issued the NIMS to provide a comprehensive national approach to incident management, applicable to all jurisdictional levels and across functional disciplines.
THE TEXAS OFFICE OF HOMELAND SECURITY
The Texas Office of Homeland Security is an element of the governor’s staff that provides policy guidance for state homeland security programs and coordinates development and monitors implementation of the state homeland security strategy. The Office of Homeland Security coordinates state homeland security programs with local governments, regional organizations, and federal agencies. The Director of the Office of Homeland Security also serves as the Director of the Governor’s Division of Emergency Management (GDEM).
THE GOVERNOR’S DIVISION OF EMERGENCY MANAGEMENT The Division of Emergency Management is also an element of the governor’s office. Chapter 418 of the Government Code assigns the division specific responsibilities for carrying out a comprehensive all-hazard emergency management program for the state and for assisting cities, counties and state agencies in implementing their own emergency management programs. The GDEM, like other state agencies, is also responsible for supporting development and implementation of the Governor’s Homeland Security Strategy.
THE STATE OPERATIONS CENTER
The State Operations Center (SOC) is operated by the GDEM and serves as the state warning point. It uses an extensive suite of communications to receive and disseminate warning of threats to regional warning points and to state and local officials; monitors emergency situations throughout the state and provides information on these events to federal, state, and local officials; and coordinates state assistance to local governments that are dealing with emergencies.
MODULE 16 Catastrophic Event Page 16-2
TEXAS SECURITY ANALYSIS AND ALERT CENTER The Texas Security Analysis and Alert Center (TSAAC) is a 24-hour centralized intelligence collection, analysis, and dissemination organization. Information is obtained from law enforcement agencies, other elements of state and local government, other organizations, and industry. TSAAC also receives reports from the public of suspicious activity possibly related to terrorism. Staffed by highly trained and experienced Department of Public Safety personnel and using sophisticated technology, The TSAAC is capable of collecting, analyzing, and disseminating leads to local, state, and federal agencies to aid with the investigation of terrorism. The TSAAC is collocated with the SOC, and there is continuous coordination between the two elements.
FEDERAL HIGHWAY ADMINISTRATION POLICY ON EMERGENCY OR SECURITY ALERT MESSAGES In support of the activities of the above agencies, FHWA has determined that the display of emergency or security alert messages on DMSs is acceptable if public agencies have developed policies and procedures that govern the messages that are displayed on DMSs and their operation. The public agency policy and procedures relating to displaying emergency or security alert messages on DMSs must address the issues listed below. (Note, FHWA uses the term changeable message signs (CMSs) in its policy.) (See http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsregs/directives/policy/securmemo.htm.)
“1. The criteria under which CMS will be used for emergency or security alert messages, including the necessary coordination with public safety or security agencies. Formal policies among critical stakeholders (such as law enforcement, security, transportation, and public safety) can be used to establish these agreed upon criteria.
2. Protocols or hierarchy for prioritizing messages and determining which messages are to be displayed.
3. Geographic area over which the information is to be displayed, to be determined in cooperation with public safety and security agencies.
4. Identification of the circumstances under which transportation-related messages, such as lane closures, fog alerts, detours, or other messages that may be needed because of dangerous travel conditions in the immediate vicinity, would preempt emergency or security alert messages.
5. The criteria that would cause the discontinuation of use of the CMS if the emergency or security alert message creates an adverse traffic impact such as queues, markedly slowing traffic, etc.
6. Methodology for developing and displaying messages that are appropriate for CMS display including but not limited to standard message sets. Agencies
MODULE 16 Catastrophic Event Page 16-3
should follow the recommended national CMS practices related to the development, use of text, manner in which messages should be displayed, human factors related to understandability of the messages, and how CMS are operated.”
The guidelines in Section 16.2 below are intended to assist in meeting item 6 of the above FHWA policy. Local knowledge of the transportation system and geography are required to establish policy on the remaining five items 16.2 MESSAGES When a major catastrophe such as a terrorist attack strikes a city, there may initially be much confusion as to the exact nature and extent of the event. Local, state, and regional emergency management groups will implement emergency management plans based on the best available information. The traffic management component of the plans will normally involve: • Closing access to the city (area) and • Evacuation of the city (area). The traffic control plan will involve displaying DMS messages in the TxDOT district in which the catastrophe occurs and in adjacent districts.
CLOSING ACCESS TO THE CITY (AREA) The traffic management plan will involve closing all of the roads including freeways to the city (area) and possibly reversing the flow of traffic on high occupancy or managed lanes. Thus, the emphasis of the DMS messages should be to let drivers know the roads that are closed and information about detours, rather than information about the catastrophic event. DMS messages for closing access to the city (area) are displayed after the police or other traffic control personnel are in place to close the freeway. The design of the messages is similar (but not exactly the same) to those used for roadway closures during incidents and roadwork. DMS Relatively Close to the Event An example of a message for DMS located relatively close to the affected area within a city is shown below.
I (XX) NORTH CLOSED AT (Location)
Note that for incidents and roadwork freeway closures, the third line of the DMS message includes terms to advise drivers to exit and follow a detour or to use another route. Advising drivers to exit and follow a detour is inappropriate because detour signing will most likely not be in place. Advising drivers to use another route gives them the false impression that they can
MODULE 16 Catastrophic Event Page 16-4
reach their destination by other routes. When information about the closure is also being disseminating by HAR, the message shown below should be used.
I (XX) NORTH CLOSED AT (Location)
TUNE TO 530 AM DMS Far from the Event When the DMS is located far from the event, it is sufficient to use one of the messages shown below.
(City or Location) CLOSED TO
ALL TRAFFIC
Option 1
ALL ROADS TO (City or Location)
CLOSED
Option 2
EVACUATION OF THE CITY (AREA) During the evacuation, only messages that address incidents and congestion should be displayed in the outbound direction, with two exceptions. First, travel time messages are acceptable. Second, when the HOV lane is open to all outbound traffic, then the message shown below is appropriate.
HOV LANES OPEN TO ALL TRAFFIC
MODULE 17 High Water and Floods Page 17-i
MODULE 17. HIGH WATER AND FLOODS
TABLE OF CONTENTS 17.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 17-1 DRIVER INFORMATION NEEDS ............................................................................... 17-1 17.2 MESSAGES FOR WATER ON THE FREEWAY BUT PASSABLE ................................................................................................................17.2 MESSAGE FORMAT AND MESSAGE ELEMENTS ................................................. 17-2 Water Descriptor ....................................................................................................... 17-2 Water Location .......................................................................................................... 17-2 Water Downstream of Crossing Highway or Street ............................................ 17-2 Water Between Exit and Entrance Ramps........................................................... 17-3 Water Upstream of Exit Ramp............................................................................. 17-3 Action ........................................................................................................................ 17-3 17.3 MESSAGES FOR FREEWAY FLOOD CONDITION ..................... 17-4 MESSAGE FORMAT AND MESSAGE ELEMENTS ................................................. 17-4 Freeway Closure Descriptor...................................................................................... 17-4 Closure Location ....................................................................................................... 17-5 Action ........................................................................................................................ 17-5 DMS on Same Freeway and Relatively Close to the Flood ................................ 17-5 DMS on Same Freeway but Relatively Far from the Flood ................................ 17-5
MODULE 17 High Water and Floods Page 17-1
MODULE 17. HIGH WATER AND FLOODS 17.1 INTRODUCTION High water sometimes collects on or flows across the freeway during heavy rainstorms. In some cases drivers can safely pass through the water, and in other cases the water is too high for drivers to pass through. In summary, the following possible conditions exist: • Water on the freeway but passable or • Water on the freeway and impassible (flooded). Surveys of Texas drivers indicate a need to have information displayed on DMSs for both of the above conditions. DRIVER INFORMATION NEEDS DMS message design and display for high water and floods are based on the results of focus group studies and human factors laboratory studies conducted in 2004 and 2005 in six cities in Texas, namely Arlington, Austin, El Paso, Houston, Laredo, and San Antonio. The guidelines are based on the combined results from the six cities; differences among cities are noted when they appeared to be significant. When high water is on the freeway but drivers are still able to pass through, Texas drivers want to: • Be alerted about the high water, • Know the location of the high water, and • Be confident that they can pass through and do not have to exit the freeway. When the freeway becomes flooded and drivers are not able to pass through, the freeway will be closed to traffic. Under flood conditions Texas drivers want to: • Be alerted about the freeway closure; • Know the location of the closure; and • Be informed as to which exit ramps to take. The majority Texas drivers (69 percent) stated that it is more important to know about the closure than the fact that the freeway is flooded.
MODULE 17 High Water and Floods Page 17-2
17.2 MESSAGES FOR WATER ON THE FREEWAY BUT PASSABLE
MESSAGE FORMAT AND MESSAGE ELEMENTS The following message format should be used: • Water Descriptor message element (top line), • Water Location message element (middle line), and • Action message element (bottom line). The acceptable message format for a message is illustrated below.
WATER ON FREEWAY (Water Location)
(Action) Water Descriptor There was no clear choice by the drivers in the Texas studies as to what term should be used to describe water on the road that is still passable. However, 56 percent of the drivers selected WATER ON ROAD (FREEWAY) or WATER AHEAD. A variety of other descriptors were each selected by 7 percent or less of the drivers. The terms HIGH WATER and FLOODED were selected by only 5 percent of the drivers and thus should not be used as the descriptor for the situation. Water Location The Water Location message element will differ depending upon whether the water is • Downstream of a crossing highway or street, • Between the exit and entrance ramps, or • Upstream of the exit ramp. Water Downstream of Crossing Highway or Street The acceptable message element for the cases when the water is downstream of a crossing highway or street is shown below.
PAST [highway, street name] A very large majority of Texas drivers (95 percent) interpret the term PAST [highway, street name] to mean a location downstream of the specific crossing highway or street. For example, the descriptor PAST ROWLAND ST is interpreted as a location downstream of Rowland Street.
MODULE 17 High Water and Floods Page 17-3
Water between Exit and Entrance Ramps Acceptable Water Location message elements when the water is between the exit and entrance ramps are shown below.
AT [highway, street name] PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT
A large majority (82 percent) of Texas drivers interpret the term AT [highway, street name] to mean a location between the exit ramp and entrance ramps. For example, the descriptor AT ROWLAND ST is interpreted as a location downstream of the Rowland Street exit ramp but upstream of the Rowland Street entrance ramp. However, 16 percent of drivers interpret the descriptor to mean that the water is upstream of the Rowland Street exit ramp. Thus, the term PAST [exit ramp name] EXIT may be the better of the two options. Water Upstream of Exit Ramp When the water is upstream of an exit ramp, the Water Location message element shown below should be used.
BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT
BEFORE [exit ramp name] EXIT is preferred to BEFORE [highway, street name]. A significant percentage of Texas drivers (24%) will improperly conclude that the BEFORE [highway, street name] format means that the water is between the exit ramp and the crossing highway or street so that the exit is available for use. Action Texas drivers indicated the Action message elements shown below are sufficient to inform them that they can proceed on the freeway and do not have to exit because of the high water.
BE PREPARED TO STOP USE CAUTION
MODULE 17 High Water and Floods Page 17-4
17.3 MESSAGES FOR FREEWAY FLOOD CONDITIONS MESSAGE FORMAT AND MESSAGE ELEMENTS The following message format should be used when the message is displayed with one phase: • Freeway Closure Descriptor message element (top line), • Closure Location message element (middle line), and • Action message element (bottom line). The acceptable format for a one-phase message is illustrated below.
I (XX) (NORTH) CLOSED(Closure Location)
(Action) The following message format should be used when the message is displayed on two phases: • Freeway Closure Descriptor message element (phase 1, top line), • Closure Location message element (phase 1 middle line), and • Action message element (phase 2 top and middle lines). The acceptable format for a two-phase message is illustrated below.
I (XX) (NORTH) CLOSED(Closure Location)
(ACTION) (ACTION)
Phase 1
Phase 2 Freeway Closure Descriptor The acceptable freeway Closure Descriptor message element is shown below.
I XX [cardinal direction] CLOSED The interstate number designation of the freeway that is flooded and the direction of travel should always be the first terms on the first line in the message. The term I 45 NORTH CLOSED is preferred over FREEWAY CLOSED because it gives drivers specific information as to whether the freeway they are on is closed or whether some other freeway that may be along their route to specific destinations is closed. Overall, the majority of the Texas drivers prefer the term I-XX (68 percent) rather than IH-XX (32 percent) for the interstate number designation. A very large majority of the drivers in Arlington (81 percent), El Paso (100 percent), and Houston (81 percent) prefer the term I-XX. Drivers in Austin, Laredo, and San Antonio were generally evenly split with respect to preference
MODULE 17 High Water and Floods Page 17-5
Closure Location Acceptable terms for the Closure Location message element are shown below.
[number] MILES [AHEAD] AT [highway, street name]
Action DMS on Same Freeway and Relatively Close to the Flood Acceptable terms for the Action message element for a one-phase message are shown below.
USE OTHER ROUTES (soft diversion) TAKE NEXT EXIT TAKE NEXT X EXITS EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT USE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] USE [route number] [cardinal direction]
Acceptable terms for the Action message element for a two-phase message are shown below. EXIT AND FOLLOW DETOUR EXIT AND FOLLOW SIGNS EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] FOLLOW DETOUR EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] FOLLOW SIGNS EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] FOLLOW DETOUR EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] FOLLOW SIGNS TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT FOLLOW DETOUR TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT FOLLOW SIGNS TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] FOLLOW DETOUR TAKE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] FOLLOW SIGNS TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] FOLLOW DETOUR TAKE [route number] [cardinal direction] FOLLOW SIGNS
DMS on Same Freeway but Relatively Far from the Flood When the DMS is relatively far upstream from the flood, it is desirable to have drivers take exits far upstream of the flood to minimize freeway congestion. Detour signs are not generally
MODULE 17 High Water and Floods Page 17-6
installed at these far upstream ramps or on the arterial streets. Acceptable terms for the Action message element for a one-phase message are shown below.
USE OTHER ROUTES (soft diversion) TAKE NEXT EXIT TAKE NEXT X EXITS EXIT AT [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] EXIT AT [route number] [cardinal direction] TAKE [exit ramp name] EXIT USE [highway, street name] [cardinal direction] USE [route number] [cardinal direction]
MODULE 18 Ozone Page 18-i
MODULE 18. OZONE
TABLE OF CONTENTS 18.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 18-1 18.2 OZONE MESSAGES .......................................................................................... 18-1 DAY PRIOR TO OZONE ACTION DAY..................................................................... 18-1 DAY OF OZONE ACTION DAY.................................................................................. 18-2
MODULE 18 Ozone Page 18-1
MODULE 18. OZONE 18.1 INTRODUCTION Hot, humid, and stagnant weather conditions contribute to the formation of ground-level ozone—a major component of smog. People exposed to elevated levels of ozone may experience a variety of symptoms. The most common symptom is a feeling of irritation in the eyes, nose, and throat. Some people also experience shortness of breath, chest pain, and wheezing. Very young people and people with pre-existing lung disease, such as asthma, may be more seriously affected. Besides the adverse effects of ozone pollution, high levels of ground-level ozone can violate federal air quality standards. Violating these standards can lead to a variety of sanctions. Ozone action days are declared on hot, sunny, still days when conditions are most favorable for the accumulation of unhealthy levels of ground-level ozone. Forecasters at the Texas Commission on Environmental Quality make their forecasts a day in advance. Ozone action days are forecasted for many of Texas’ larger urban areas which may use different terms for the event. For example, in San Antonio, the term air quality health alert is used. 18.2 OZONE MESSAGES Messages are generally displayed on DMSs both the day prior to and the day of the Ozone Action Day. Messages displayed the day before the ozone action day provide drivers with advanced notice and give them an opportunity to plan for other modes of transportation, although it is not clear how many drivers change modes.
DAY PRIOR TO OZONE ACTION DAY Acceptable messages and formats are illustrated below.
OZONE ACTION DAY TOMORROW
RIDE THE BUS (FREE) SHARE A RIDE
Phase 1
Phase 2 Option 1
OZONE ACTION DAY TOMORROW
REDUCE TRIPS WORK AT HOME
Phase 1
Phase 2 Option 2
MODULE 18 Ozone Page 18-2
DAY OF OZONE ACTION DAY An acceptable message and format is illustrated below.
OZONE ACTION DAY TODAY
REDUCE TRIPS WALK TO LUNCH
Phase 1
Phase 2
MODULE 19 Planned Special Events Page 19-i
MODULE 19. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS 19.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 19-1 IMPACT AND OPERATIONAL STRATEGIES OF PLANNES SPECIAL EVENTS.................................................................................................................... 19-1 Categories of Planned Special Events ....................................................................... 19-1 SETTING PRIORITIES FOR PLANNED SPECIAL EVENT MESSAGES ................ 19-3 INFORMATION ON DMSs TO ACCOMPLISH OPERATIONAL STRATEGIES........................................................................................................... 19-3 Drivers Traveling to the Event .................................................................................. 19-3 Best Signing Strategy........................................................................................... 19-3 Information on DMS: Divert Event Traffic to an Alternative Route ................... 19-4 Static Trailblazer Signs ....................................................................................... 19-4 Drivers Not Traveling to the Event ........................................................................... 19-5 POLICY FOR DISPLAYING DMS MESSAGES ......................................................... 19-5
MODULE 19 Planned Special Events Page 19-1
MODULE 19. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS 19.1 INTRODUCTION Results of research have shown that one of the most effective uses of DMSs is for planned special events. A very large majority of drivers respond to DMS messages when information directs them to the best route to an event. For example, results of field studies conducted by TTI showed that up to 90 percent of the drivers destined to a planned special event diverted to an alternative route that was suggested on DMSs.
IMPACT AND OPERATIONAL STRATEGIES OF PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS A planned special event impacts the transportation system by generating an increase in travel demand over and above the normal traffic demand. Operations strategies for a planned special event include: 1) mitigating the travel demand impacts of the event and 2) ensuring the transportation system operates as efficiently as possible on the day-of-event. Successful operational strategies include: travel demand management, transit service and information, and pre-trip traveler information. Freeway DMSs can play important roles for the first two strategies. Two distinct groups of travelers are affected during a planned special event that is located near the freeway: • Drivers traveling to the event and • Drivers not traveling to the event. Categories of Planned Special Events Information for this section of Module 19 was obtained in large part from the Managing Traffic for Planned Special Events Handbook that was prepared for FHWA by Dunn Engineering Associates. The full text of the Handbook can be found at http://tmcpfs.ops.fhwa.dot.gov/cfprojects/new_detail.cfm?id=59&new=2. There are five categories of planned special events, namely: • Discrete/recurring event at a permanent venue, • Continuous event, • Street use event, • Regional/multi-venue event, and • Rural event. A discrete/recurring event at a permanent venue occurs on a regular basis and it has a specific starting time and predictable ending time. Events classified under this category have predictable peak arrival and departure rates relative to other categories of planned special events. These events generate high peak travel demand rates because of patron urgency to arrive at the venue
MODULE 19 Planned Special Events Page 19-2
by a specific event start time. Moreover, these events end abruptly upon game time expiration or the conclusion of a final song, which creates high peak departure rates. Information displayed on DMSs can benefit drivers both traveling to the event and those traveling on the freeway and roads that are impacted by the event traffic. A continuous event occurs over a single or multiple days. Unlike a discrete/recurring event at a permanent venue, continuous events do not exhibit sharp peak arrival and peak departure rates. Event patrons typically arrive and depart throughout the event day. Aside from conventions and state/county fairs, many continuous events take place at a temporary venue, park, or other large open space. As a result, roadway and parking capacity issues may arise in the immediate area surrounding a temporary venue which can be addressed with a management strategy that involves displaying messages on DMSs. DMSs are also helpful to drivers who are not traveling to the event at times when ensuing congestion sets in due to increased travel demand for the event. A street use event occurs on a street requiring temporary closure. These events generally occur in a city or town central business district; however, race events or motorcycle rallies may necessitate temporary closure of arterial streets or limited-access highways. A street use event significantly impacts businesses and neighborhoods adjacent to the event site from the perspective of parking and access. A street use event requires closure of a segment(s) of the roadway network and causes background and event traffic to divert onto alternative routes, thus increasing traffic demand on other streets in the roadway network. DMS messages of advance notification of the street closures can help encourage drivers to avoid the venue area on the day of the event. A regional/multi-venue event refers to multiple planned special events that occur within a region at or near the same time. The collection of events may have different starting times and differ in classification category. For instance, a major metropolitan area may have two or more adjacent fixed venues or venues utilizing the same freeway corridor. Multiple venues may occasionally host events on the same day. Stakeholders managing all planned special events within a region emphasize coordination of event times to reduce peak parking demand and impact on transportation system operations. Information displayed on DMSs can benefit both drivers traveling to one of the events and those traveling on the freeway and roads that are impacted by the event traffic. Rural events encompass any discrete/recurring event or continuous event occurring in a rural area. Planned special events occurring in rural areas deserve a stand-alone classification category for several reasons. First, there is a need for stakeholders to assume new and/or expanded roles. Second, there may be limited road capacity to access the event venue and potentially limited parking capacity at the venue. Third, there may be fewer alternative routes to accommodate event and background traffic. Again, information displayed on DMSs can benefit both drivers traveling to one of the events and those traveling on the freeway and roads that are impacted by the event traffic.
MODULE 19 Planned Special Events Page 19-3
SETTING PRIORITIES FOR PLANNED SPECIAL EVENT MESSAGES DMS messages informing drivers of incidents, roadwork involving lane closures, or traffic events that impact safety always take precedence over messages designed to manage traffic during planned special events. Also, policies should be established by TxDOT as to whether DMS signing priority should be placed on drivers heading to the venue or other drivers on the freeway who are not heading to the event but could be impacted by the additional travel demand.
INFORMATION ON DMSs TO ACCOMPLISH OPERATIONAL STRATEGIES Drivers Traveling to the Event The two most likely scenarios for using DMSs for a planned special event are to: • Inform drivers of the direct route to the event or • Divert drivers to an alternative route. Best Signing Strategy Freeway drivers traveling to a planned special event want to know where to exit or which route to take to reach the event. They are particularly concerned with knowing the availability and location of parking—desirably parking close to the venue. Although important, parking information should not be displayed on DMSs on the freeway. The best signing strategy is to inform drivers of the exit(s) or arterial that should be used to reach the event and to use well-designed and well-located static trailblazers to direct drivers to the venue and parking areas. When trailblazers are not installed, then it is important that police or traffic control personnel be stationed at the signalized intersections and the entrances to parking facilities/areas to direct traffic. Drivers expect to see an Audience for Action message element on the top line in the message. (Refer to page 4-13 for a more detailed discussion of Audience for Action.) In the case of a planned special event, the Audience for Action is the destination. FAIRPARK, for example is a special event destination in Dallas. Information on DMSs: Inform Drivers of Direct Route to Event The more common traffic management strategy is to inform drivers of the exits to take or routes to use to reach the event. It is not possible to show in the Manual the wide variety of DMS messages that might be used. Examples of typical messages are shown below.
FAIR PARK TAKE NEXT 2 EXITS
FAIR PARK EXIT AT 2ND AVE
Example 1
Example 2
Revised July 2006
MODULE 19 Planned Special Events Page 19-4
Information on DMSs: Divert Event Traffic to an Alternative Route In some situations, drivers are diverted to an alternative route. When this traffic management strategy is used, the alternative route must provide a significant travel time savings. It is essential that the traffic conditions on both the primary and diversion routes be monitored to ensure that the drivers are not being diverted to an alternative route that does not provide significant time savings. One advantage of DMSs is that the messages can be displayed when it is desirable to divert drivers to the alternative route and can be turned off whenever it no longer applies (i.e., the alternative route no longer provides significant time savings). In addition to the messages shown above to inform drivers of the direct route to the planned special event, DMS messages that would illicit greater response to divert to an alternative route are shown below.
FAIR PARK TAKE FITZHUGH
AVOID MAJOR DELAY
FAIR PARK TAKE FITZHUGH
SAVE 20 MIN
FAIR PARK TAKE FITZHUGH
AVOID 20 MIN DELAY
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
FAIR PARK
BEST ROUTE USE FITZHUGH AVE
Example 4
Static Trailblazer Signs Normally, as soon as drivers leave the freeway, they must maneuver through a major signalized intersection. They will be searching for information about the: • Destination name, • Turning movements, and • Lane assignments. Because of the relatively high exit speed and the high information load at the intersection due to high traffic volumes and the short time available to make critical decisions as soon as they leave the freeway, good trailblazer signing at the ramp/service road (or street) junction is exceptionally important. Drivers must be “pulled through” the intersection with a trailblazer assembly that is easily recognizable. The first trailblazer sign or sign assembly must contain the destination name, the turning movement to reach the venue, and the lane assignment in preparation for the turning movement. The destination name on the trailblazer must be the same as that used on the DMS. Trailblazers should be located at every point where drivers may become confused. It is important to remember that many drivers will be taking the route for the first time. A general rule of thumb is that a trailblazer is needed at major intersections where drivers have to make a decision. Where a wide major road (particularly another freeway) passes over or under the
Revised July 2006
MODULE 19 Planned Special Events Page 19-5
alternative route, trailblazers are recommended both in advance of and just beyond the interchange. Examples of well-designed trailblazer signs for a special event, proper locations, and other requirements are given in Report FHWA/TX-92/1232-10, Guidelines on the Selection and Design of Messages for Changeable Message Signs. Drivers Not Traveling to the Event Drivers not traveling to the event could be adversely affected by increased travel demand, which sometime results in congestion. Thus, it may be advantageous to provide advance notification of the event. As previously noted, DMS message priority on the day of the special event should be given to incidents, roadwork involving lane closures, and traffic events that impact safety as opposed to management of the special event traffic.
POLICY FOR DISPLAYING DMS MESSAGES TxDOT currently does not have an established statewide policy for displaying messages on DMSs during planned special events. The Houston District has developed a set of requirements for displaying messages on DMSs during special events and for displaying information for shuttle services. These are shown in Figures 19-1 and 19-2.
MODULE 19 Planned Special Events Page 19-6
TEXAS DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION
HOUSTON DISTRICT SPECIAL EVENT SIGNING REQUIREMENTS
A. Policy Pursuant to policy 22.10.22.15, concerning the use of state highway right-of-way, the Department, using the State’s Intelligent Transportation System, may assist with signing to inform the public of a special event which is open to the general public. B. Application
To obtain assistance for signing for a special event, a person or entity must file an application with the Freeway Operations Supervisor, Transportation Management Systems, and the Department’s Transportation Management Center, not fewer than 14 calendar days prior to the initial date of signing. The application shall be in the form prescribed by the Department and shall at a minimum include:
a. date of the event, beginning and ending; b. hours of operation; c. event information, what the event is benefiting, number of people anticipated to
attend; d. exact location of the event, including diagrams of the access, parking areas and
relationship to adjacent state right-of-way; e. if applicable, a letter from any and all law enforcement agencies that will be assisting
with traffic control; f. if applicable, a letter of permission from the owner of the property being utilized for
the event; g. a detailed traffic control and Dynamic Message Sign (DMS) plan, stamped by a
licensed Professional Engineer (P.E.), incorporating the requirements of the Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices, including but not limited to: 1. diagram of site and relationship of DMS to event access, stamped by a P.E.
licensed to work in the state of Texas; 2. location(s) of applicable DMS; 3. dates and hours of operation for each DMS to be utilized; 4. applicable message text for each DMS.
C. Criteria a. a minimum of 5,000 people must be projected to attend the event; b. the event location must be adjacent to the state’s right-of-way or must be shown to have
significant impact on the right-of-way.
Figure 19-1. Houston District Special Event Signing Requirements.
MODULE 19 Planned Special Events Page 19-7
TEXAS DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION
HOUSTON DISTRICT SHUTTLE SIGNING REQUIREMENTS
A. Policy The Department may assist with signing to advise the traveling public of remote shuttle parking locations during special events if there are not ample parking spaces available or if such actions are necessary to alleviate traffic congestion on the State roadway system in and around the event. B. Request
1. Who may submit?Any individual, private entity, or government entity may submit a request for assistance with shuttle signing for a special event that is offering shuttle service. If in an incorporated area the event must be approved by the local government entity.
2. RequirementsA request for assistance with shuttle parking signing must be submitted in writing to the Freeway Operations Supervisor, Transportation Management Systems, a minimum of twenty-one (21) days prior to the event and must contain the following information: a. municipalities impacted by the event; b. date for the event; c. event information, what the event is benefiting, number of people anticipated to
attend, number of people expected to utilize the shuttle service; d. exact location of the shuttle parking area(s), the event, distance from the shuttle
parking area to the event location, including diagrams of the shuttle route, event location and shuttle parking location(s);
e. dates/hours of operations for the shuttle; f. number of shuttle vehicles that will be utilized, type of vehicles used, number of
people each shuttle is capable of transporting at one time, and frequency of operation; g. if applicable, a permit or letter of permission from each of the local jurisdictions
affected by the event; h. h. if applicable, a letter of permission from the owner of the property being utilized
for the event; a detailed traffic control and Dynamic Message Sign (DMS) plan, stamped by a licensed
Professional Engineer (P.E.), incorporating the requirements of the Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices (MUTCD).
3. Criteria a. shuttle parking area must be adjacent to the State’s right-of-way; b. a minimum of 20,000 people must be projected to attend the event; c. a minimum of 10% of the patrons must be projected to utilize the shuttle service; d. a minimum of four (4) shuttle vehicles are required; e. shuttle must operate on a scheduled basis; f. the shuttle parking area must be a minimum two (2) miles from the actual event.
It is recommended that a post event report be submitted containing updated information for the current year’s event. This information will be used to meet criteria for future events.
Figure 19-2. Houston District Shuttle Signing Requirements.
MODULE 20 Hurricane Evacuation Page 20-1
MODULE 20. HURRICANE EVACUATION
Issues relating to hurricane evacuation were addressed as part of the focus group studies conducted as part of Project 0-4023 in early 2004 in Amarillo, Arlington, El Paso, Houston, Laredo, and San Antonio. One of the weaknesses of the study was that none of the focus group participants had been in a situation where they had to evacuate because of a hurricane and had a difficult time imagining themselves in this type of emergency. Thus, the results of the studies are suspect and the researchers did not have full confidence to translate the results into meaningful motorist information needs and to design effective DMS messages. Hurricane Rita in September 2005 impacted the Texas Gulf Coast and resulted in mass evacuation from major cities such as Houston and Galveston. It was deemed desirable to take advantage of the plight and evacuation experiences of some of the citizens who could provide more meaningful responses to queries about driver information needs. A task was added to Project 0-4296 Development of Guidelines for Hurricane Evacuation Signing and Markings to conduct focus group studies and to support TxDOT in developing messages for DMSs and portable changeable message signs. It is recommended that Module 20 be completed after the results from Project 0-4296 are available and DMS messages are designed.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-i
MODULE 21. DMS OPERATIONS POLICIES
TABLE OF CONTENTS 21.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 21-1 21.2 FEDERAL POLICIES ........................................................................................ 21-1 21.3 REGIONAL POLICIES..................................................................................... 21-3 21.4 POTENTIAL TXDOT OPERATIONS POLICY
STATEMENTS FOR PERMANENT DMSs ........................................... 21-4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................... 21-4 1. RESPONSIBILITY FOR OPERATIONS OF DMSs............................................... 21-5 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-5 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-5 General ...................................................................................................................... 21-5 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-5 2. OPERATION OF DMSs BY OTHER STATE PERSONNEL................................. 21-5 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-5 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-5 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-6 3. OPERATION OF DMSs BY LAW ENFORCEMENT PERSONNEL.................... 21-6 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-6 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-6 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-6 4. GENERAL OPERATIONS ...................................................................................... 21-7 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-7 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-7 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-7 5. BLANK SIGNS......................................................................................................... 21-7 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-7 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-7 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-8 6. MESSAGES DURING PEAK PERIODS ................................................................ 21-9 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-9 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-9 Justification and/or Considerations ........................................................................... 21-9
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-ii
7. DISPLAY OF TRAVEL TIMES .............................................................................. 21-9 Policy......................................................................................................................... 21-9 Policy Statement Example......................................................................................... 21-9 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-10 8. DISPLAY OF UPCOMING ROADWORK ........................................................... 21-10 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-10 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-10 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-10 9. DISPLAY OF UPCOMING SPECIAL EVENTS THAT ADVERSELY
AFFECT TRAVEL ................................................................................................. 21-11 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-11 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-11 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-11
10. TRAFFIC DIVERSION (GENERAL).................................................................... 21-11 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-11 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-11 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-12 11. TRAFFIC DIVERSION TO ROADWAYS NOT UNDER THE
JURISDICTION OF TXDOT ................................................................................. 21-12 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-12 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-12 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-12
12. ADVANCE NOTICE OF ROADWORK INVOLVING LANE CLOSURES ...... 21-13 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-13 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-13 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-13 13. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS............................................................................. 21-13 Policy Alternative #1............................................................................................... 21-14 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-14 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-14 Policy Alternative #2............................................................................................... 21-14 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-14 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-14 14. REGULATORY SPEED MESSAGES................................................................... 21-15 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-15 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-15 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-15
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-iii
15. ADVERSE WEATHER, ENVIRONMENTAL, AND ROADWAY CONDITIONS......................................................................................................... 21-16
Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-16 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-16 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-16
16. LIMITS OF DMS INFLUENCE FOR INCIDENTS.............................................. 21-16 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-16 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-16 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-17 17. ADVERTISING ...................................................................................................... 21-17 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-17 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-17 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-17 18. PUBLIC SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENTS ............................................................ 21-18 Policy Alternative #1............................................................................................... 21-18 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-18 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-18 Policy Alternative #2............................................................................................... 21-19 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-19 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-19 19. DISPLAY OF AMBER ALERTS........................................................................... 21-19 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-19 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-19 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-20 20. DRIVER SAFETY CAMPAIGNS ......................................................................... 21-20 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-20 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-21 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-21 21. DISPLAYING MESSAGES FOR OTHER STATES ............................................ 21-21 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-21 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-21 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-21 22. INTERMODAL INFORMATION.......................................................................... 21-21 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-21 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-22 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-22
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-iv
23 OPERATION WITH LANE CONTROL SIGNALS ............................................. 21-22 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-22 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-22 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-22 24. TEST MESSAGES.................................................................................................. 21-23 Policy....................................................................................................................... 21-23 Policy Statement Example....................................................................................... 21-23 Justification and/or Considerations ......................................................................... 21-23
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-1
MODULE 21. DMS OPERATIONS POLICIES
21.1 INTRODUCTION This module is divided into two parts. The first part contains summaries of available DMS operations policies and guidelines at the federal level. In part two, guidelines are presented to assist TxDOT in developing statewide and regional policies for the operation of DMSs. A list of supporting references is included at the end of the module. (Note “region” as used in this Manual refers to an area encompassing more than one state, in contrast to the division of state DOTs into regions within a state.) A distinction is made in this Manual between DMS operations a) policies and b) procedures and guidelines. DMS operations policies contain the guiding principles that are considered to be prudent and that influence the actions taken by the managers of TMCs in the operation of DMSs. An example is a policy on whether the DMSs should be blank when there are no incidents or roadwork on the freeway. DMS operations procedures and guidelines outline and describe the day-to-day operation of DMSs (e.g., the content and format of DMS messages). A list of items that TxDOT should consider in developing procedures and guidelines for the operation of DMSs is presented in Module 22 DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines. 21.2 FEDERAL POLICIES There are no written DMS operations policies at the national level. However, policies, standards, and guidance are embodied in the MUTCD (1) and in four FHWA Policy Memorandums. In addition, another Memorandum describes FHWA’s recommendation for displaying travel time on DMSs. (Note, FHWA uses the term changeable message signs (CMSs) in its policies.) The first Policy Memorandum “Use of Changeable Message Sign (CMS)” (http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsres/directives/policy/pame.htm) dated January 19, 2001 supports the use of CMSs as a traffic control device to safely and efficiently manage traffic by informing drivers of roadway conditions and required actions to perform. The primary sections addressing CMSs in the MUTCD are Section 2A.07 Changeable Message Signs, Section 2E.21 Changeable Message Signs, and Section 6F.52 Portable Changeable Message Signs. Parts of the January 19, 2001 Memorandum that relate to policies and guidelines are presented below (2).
“ . . . Section 2A.07 of the Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices (MUTCD) requires that a CMS shall conform to the principles established in the MUTCD related to the use of signs within the right-of-way of all classes of public highways, and to the extent practical, the design and applications prescribed in Sections 6F.02 and 6F.52. Section 2E.21 of the MUTCD specifies that ‘Changeable message signs shall display pertinent traffic operational and guidance information only, not advertising’. ”
“The FHWA supports the use of a CMS as a traffic control device to safely and efficiently manage traffic by informing motorists of roadway conditions and
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-2
required actions to perform. The appropriate use of a CMS and other types of real-time displays should be limited to managing travel, controlling and diverting traffic, identifying current and anticipated roadway conditions, or regulating access to specific lanes or the entire roadway.” “ . . . The use of a CMS for the display of general public information or other nonessential messages is discouraged. Only essential messages should be displayed on a CMS. As per MUTCD Section 1A.01 ‘Guide and information signs are solely for the purpose of traffic control and are not an advertising medium’.” “The content of a CMS message should be based on requiring the motorist to take an action. However, operational, road condition, and driver safety focused messages are acceptable to be displayed on a CMS. If driver safety focused messages are to be displayed on a CMS, they should be kept current and relate to a safety campaign. The period of time that a specific message is displayed for a safety campaign should be limited to a few weeks . . .”
The second Memorandum, “Click it or Ticket Signs” dated March 6, 2002, addresses whether the safety campaign message “CLICK IT OR TICKET” is in conformance with the MUTCD. (http://mutcd.fhwa.dot.gov/res-memorandum_clickit.htm) The following statements are contained in the Memorandum (3):
“The display of safety messages associated with a safety campaign is allowable under the current MUTCD, as long as it conforms to sign design, location, and spacing requirements and does not block other regulatory, guide and/or warning signs. We have determined that the "Click it or Ticket" signs meet the design requirements and are in conformance with the Manual based on the following analysis. The Millennium Edition of the MUTCD does not specifically address safety message signs; however, there are provisions in Section 1A.03 and Section 2B.51 that allow an agency to develop its own regulatory and warning message signs, as long as they follow the basic guidelines on color, appearance, etc. Section 2B.51 of the Manual also includes the seat belt symbol. The Federal Highway Administration (FHWA) supports the use of a Changeable Message Sign (CMS) as a traffic control device to safely and efficiently inform motorists of roadway conditions and required actions to perform. The FHWA issued a policy memorandum on CMS January 19, 2001 (copy attached). That policy gives general guidance and allows driver safety messages to be displayed on a CMS including those associated with a safety campaign. The "Click it or Ticket" sign design for a safety campaign conforms to the information in this memorandum.”
The third Memorandum, “AMBER Alert Use of Changeable Message Sign (CMS)” (http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsregs/directives/policy/ambermemo.htm), dated August 16, 2002, was prepared to clarify FHWA policy on the use of CMSs to display child abduction messages as
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-3
part of an AMBER (America’s Missing: Broadcast Emergency Response) Plan Program. Parts of the Memorandum that relate to policies and guidelines were presented in the Section on Federal Amber Plan Program Policies on page 15-1 (4). The fourth Memorandum, “Use of Changeable Message Sign (CMS) for Emergency Security” (http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsregs/directives/policy/securmemo.htm), dated March 21, 2003, contains a documentation of FHWA policy for use of CMSs for emergency security. The part of the Memorandum that addresses FHWA policy should a public agency decide to display emergency or security alert messages on CMSs was presented in the section on Federal Highway Administration Policy on Emergency or Security Alert Messages on page 16-2 (5). A Memorandum dated July 16, 2004 notes that FHWA strongly recommends the display of travel time information in CMSs whenever possible. A part of the Memorandum is presented below (http://www.i95coalition.org/PDF/Calendar/travel time-memo-ver3.pdf) (6).
“…(The) goal should be to have travel time information as the default information available to motorists throughout the day. A “dark” or blank CMS is a transportation investment that is not being fully utilized. We should be asking why is it dark and what will it take to get travel time posted on an ongoing basis. Furthermore, no new CMS should be installed in a major metropolitan area or along a heavily traveled route unless the operating agency and the jurisdiction have the capability to display travel time messages.”
21.3 REGIONAL POLICIES Some state DOTs coordinate their DMS operations with other operating agencies in a region through a variety of formal and informal mechanisms such as committees or coalitions. One of the objectives of a coalition is to coordinate across jurisdictional boundaries the display of timely and accurate information to drivers in major freeway corridors when major incidents occur or during construction. To accomplish this, the roles and responsibilities of the agencies affected by incidents or construction of significant proportion are defined based on the nature of their interaction with the event. These roles and responsibilities are defined in oral or written agreements. It is likely that agencies in a regional coalition may have different DMS operations policies. Individual states in the coalition should generally operate in accordance with state policies, and the regional coalition should attempt to ensure, to the extent possible, that the partnership policies on DMS operations comply with key elements of the state policies.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-4
21.4 POTENTIAL TXDOT OPERATIONS POLICY STATEMENTS FOR PERMANENT DMSS INTRODUCTION The sections that follow are intended to provide guidance to TxDOT in developing statewide or regional policies for the operation of DMSs. Twenty-four candidate policy issues are presented. Table 3-1 is a summary of suggested policy issues that should be considered at state and regional levels. Certainly, TxDOT may not wish to establish policy on each of these issues. Table 3-1 is intended to remind TxDOT of several possible policy issues that it may want to consider. To assist TxDOT in developing a policy, the following information is given for each of the issues listed in Table 3-1: a) an explanation of the policy, b) a policy statement example that TxDOT can use in developing the policy, and c) justification and/or considerations that may influence TxDOT’s decision to elect to include the statement in its policies, along with supporting references where available. The policy issues and statements were abstracted from the New Jersey DOT Variable Message Sign Operations Manual (7) and from documents that the author was able to obtain from a small number of state DOTs. It should be noted that TxDOT may prefer to change the wording in the policy statements to fit its own specific needs.
Table 3-1. Possible DMS Operations Policy Issues.
State RegionA
1. Responsibility for operation of DMSs 2. Operation of DMSs by other state DOT personnel 3. Operation of DMSs by law enforcement personnel 4. General operations 5. Blank signs 6. Messages during peak periods 7. Display of upcoming roadwork 8. Display of upcoming special events 9. Display of travel times 10. Traffic diversion (general) 11. Traffic diversion to roadways not under
jurisdiction of TxDOT 12. Advance notice of roadwork involving lane
closures 13. Special events 14. Regulatory speed messages 15. Adverse weather, environmental, and roadway
conditions 16. Limits of DMS influence for incidents 17. Advertising 18. Public service announcements 19. Driver safety campaigns 20. Display of AMBER alerts 21. Displaying information for other states 22. Intermodal information 23. Operation with lane control signals 24. Test messages
1. Responsibility for operation of DMSs 2. Operation of DMSs by other state DOT personnel 3. Operation of DMSs by law enforcement personnel 4. General operations 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Traffic diversion (general) 11. Traffic diversion to roadways not under
jurisdiction of TxDOT 12. 13. Special events 14. 15. 16. Limits of DMS influence for incidents 17. 18. 19. 20. Display of AMBER alerts 21. Displaying information for other states 22. Intermodal information 23. 24.
A The language in the Policy Statement Examples may have to be changed to accommodate cooperative interstate activities.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-5
1. RESPONSIBILITY FOR OPERATION OF DMSs Policy The policy statement is to establish final responsibility for the operation of DMSs on roadways under the jurisdiction of TxDOT and to establish responsibility for daily operations of the DMSs. Policy Statement Example General
TxDOT personnel have responsibility for the operation of DMSs on roadways under the jurisdiction of TxDOT. The [fill in] office (or position title) has final responsibility for the operation of all DMSs on roadways under the jurisdiction of TxDOT. [Add the contact name(s) for general questions about the DMSs and overall responsibility.]
The [Name of Center] Traffic Management Center manager [telephone number] the [Name of Center] Traffic Management Center manager [telephone number], and the [Name of Center] Traffic Management Center manager [telephone number] have the responsibility for the daily operations of the DMSs on Texas state highways in [list regions, areas, etc.] respectively.
Justification and/or Considerations It is advisable that clear lines of responsibility for operation of DMSs be established statewide and at the TMC levels. 2. OPERATION OF DMSs BY OTHER STATE DOT PERSONNEL Policy When a TMC does not operate 24 hours, 7 days a week, there may be situations that justify having other TxDOT personnel operate one or more of the DMSs during off hours either from the sign site or from another TMC. The situations that might arise when the TMC is not operational include events that result in unexpected congestion or impact safety such as: a) incidents, b) emergency roadwork, c) spilled loads, d) special events, e) severe weather or adverse pavement conditions, and f) heavy weekend/holiday traffic. Policy Statement Example
Authorized TxDOT district personnel may operate DMSs located in their respective districts during TMC off hours for emergency situations that may impact safety or traffic operations. The emergency situations may include the following: a) crashes, b) emergency roadwork, c) spilled loads, d) special events, e) severe weather or adverse pavement conditions, and f) heavy weekend/holiday
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-6
traffic. The authorized district personnel shall only display messages contained in a message library developed by the TMC manager.
Justification and/or Considerations Although it may not be practical for a TMC to operate the TMC 24/7, failure to display messages on DMSs when unexpected traffic congestion or events that may impact safety occur contributes to the erosion of the public’s trust in the system. Therefore, it may be desirable to have authorized non-TMC personnel operate DMSs from the sign site or from a remote location during off hours. The personnel must be trained to ensure that proper messages are displayed for the given traffic or highway situations. In addition, it is recommended that non-TMC personnel not be allowed to design messages. Rather, the TMC manager should provide a list of acceptable messages that are preprogrammed into the controller at the sign site or reside at the remote DMS system database. 3. OPERATION OF DMSs BY LAW ENFORCEMENT PERSONNEL Policy When the TMC does not operate 24 hours, 7 days a week, there may be situations when it is desirable to have law enforcement personnel operate one or more of the DMSs during off hours. The situations that may arise include: a) incidents, b) spilled loads, and c) severe weather or adverse pavement conditions. Operation of the DMSs may be at the sign site or from a remote location if the law enforcement agency is provided with the necessary equipment. Policy Statement Example
Control of DMSs during TMC off hours can be arranged with the [State, city, county, etc.] law enforcement agency provided that appropriate agreements are developed. Authorized law enforcement personnel may operate DMSs identified by the manager of the [Name of Center] TMC for emergency situations during TMC off hours. Messages may be displayed for the following situations: a) incidents, b) spilled loads, and c) severe weather or adverse pavement conditions. Law enforcement personnel shall only display messages contained in a message library developed by the TMC manager.
Justification and/or Considerations Although it may not be practical for a TMC to operate the TMC 24/7, failure to display messages on DMSs when unexpected traffic congestion or events occur that may impact safety contributes to the erosion of the public’s trust in the system. Therefore, it may be desirable to have authorized law enforcement personnel operate DMSs from the sign site during off hours.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-7
The law enforcement personnel must be trained to ensure that proper messages are displayed for the given traffic or highway situations. In addition, it is recommended that the law enforcement personnel not be allowed to design messages; but rather, the TMC manager should provide a list of acceptable preprogrammed messages. 4. GENERAL OPERATIONS Policy A policy statement is included to emphasize the type of messages that are allowable on DMSs within the state. Policy Statement Example
Only real-time information about incidents and roadwork and about traffic, roadway, environmental, or pavement conditions that could have an effect on driver safety and traffic efficiency shall be displayed on the DMSs, with the exception that the following may occasionally be displayed: a) advance notification of roadwork requiring lane closures as described in Policy Statement 7 and b) advance notification of special events that will adversely affect travel either because of the added traffic generated or the requirement to close streets or highways (e.g., parades, street auto races, etc.) as described in Policy Statement 8. Messages associated with AMBER alerts described in Policy Statement 19 are permitted. (The following statement can be added if TxDOT allows messages for safety campaigns.) Occasional messages associated with driver safety campaigns described in Policy Statement 20 are permitted. Incidents include crashes, disabled vehicles, debris, or utility line breaks.
Justification and/or Considerations It is advisable to have a policy statement that succinctly addresses the use of the DMSs. 5. BLANK SIGNS Policy The policy statement is to keep the DMS in a blank mode during the peak and off-peak periods in the absence of incidents and roadwork and current traffic, roadway, environmental, or pavement conditions that could have an effect on driver safety and traffic efficiency. Policy Statement Example
DMSs will be in blank mode during the peak and off-peak periods when traffic, roadway, environmental, or pavement conditions do not warrant the display of a
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-8
message, or messages of advance notification of roadwork requiring lane closures (Policy Statement 7. Display of Upcoming Roadwork), or special events (Policy Statement 8. Display of Upcoming Special Events) are not being displayed. (A phrase can be added if the state allows messages for safety campaigns and AMBER alerts.)
Justification and/or Considerations Once a DMS system is installed, a question always arises concerning when messages should be displayed. There are two schools of thought:
1. Display messages only when unusual conditions exist on the freeway; or 2. Always display messages regardless of whether unusual conditions exist on the freeway.
Or, as a minimum, always display a message during the peak periods and only when unusual conditions exist during the off-peak periods.
The first of the above approaches is advantageous because of human factors principles and because of difficulties in designing messages when incidents actually occur during the peak periods. The second approach of always displaying a message leads to violation of the following two important human factors principles for DMS operations:
• Don’t tell drivers something they already know; and • For more effective systems, use the DMSs only when some response by drivers is
required (i.e., change in speed, path, or route). In the absence of incidents during the peak periods, more often than not, bottleneck locations and the subsequent locations and durations of congestion can almost be predicted. Consequently, the same congestion information will most likely be displayed almost daily. The display of repetitive information will result in many drivers failing to read the DMS even when important information is given. Some TMCs are even considering the use of flashing beacons on DMSs to attract the attention of motorists when incident, roadwork, etc. messages are displayed. To circumvent any possible adverse public reaction to seeing blank signs, the public could be educated through the media that the signs will be activated only when unusual freeway conditions exist. When so advised, drivers should be alert whenever a message is displayed on a DMS because they know that it will likely affect them. Messages should be displayed when some action is required of the driver. (8) Another consideration with respect to displaying messages for recurring congestion is that one simply runs out of descriptors for the various possible levels of congestion. For example, if descriptors such as HEAVY CONGESTION or MAJOR DELAY are used to describe recurrent congestion, then descriptors are not available for the more severe congestion when incidents occur during the peak period. Results of a survey reported by Dudek (9) in 1997 showed that 20 of 26 (77 percent) of transportation agencies responding had a policy of displaying messages only when unusual conditions were present on the facility and leaving the DMS blank during other times.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-9
In contrast, because of delayed construction schedules, DMSs were installed for the INFORM Project on Long Island more than 18 months before the system became operational. Adverse public reaction to having expensive DMSs sitting idle for several months prompted New York to adopt a policy of displaying some type of message on the freeway DMSs at all times (10). 6. MESSAGES DURING PEAK PERIODS Policy The policy statement is to prohibit display information about recurring congestion on DMSs during peak periods in absence of incidents. Policy Statement Example
During daily peak traffic periods, DMS messages shall be used to advise motorists of unusual conditions (e.g., crashes, lane blockages, etc.) and congestion descriptors (e.g., CONGESTION NEXT 2 MILES) shall not be used to advise motorists of normal daily recurrent peak period traffic congestion conditions.
Justification and/or Considerations (See Justification and/or Considerations presented previously for 5. Blank Signs.) 7. DISPLAY OF TRAVEL TIMES Policy Some TxDOT districts have the capability to measure or estimate travel times between sensor stations and to automatically display travel time information on DMSs. The policy is to allow travel time messages to be displayed during peak and off-peak periods in the absence of incidents, roadwork, or other conditions that may adversely affect driver safety or travel efficiency. Policy Statement Example
Travel time information may be displayed if travel times can be measured or calculated using the electronic sensor equipment on the freeway and in the TMC, and if the information can be displayed and updated on the DMS automatically by the system computers. (Note: Experience with displaying travel time information indicates that manual operation, particularly when a large number of DMSs are operated, is extremely difficult for DMS operators. Displaying travel time manually introduces a tremendous amount of workload to the DMS operators, particularly when an incident occurs on the freeway.)
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-10
Justification and/or Considerations Display of travel time information helps to reduce the amount of time that the DMSs are blank in the absence of incidents or roadwork. Travel time is generally calculated from speed measurements taken at loop detector stations or measured directly with automated vehicle identification (AVI) sensors. It is important to recognize that the data available from these sources are estimated travel times of current conditions (loop detectors) or the travel times of the vehicles that recently traveled between two AVI sensor stations. In essence it is historical travel time. The process of accurately predicting the travel times of drivers viewing the DMS is not currently available. Recent human factors laboratory studies by Dudek et al. (12) suggest that the historical travel times obtained from loop or AVI sensors is acceptable to use in DMS messages. (Refer to the section on Travel Time beginning on page 4-11.) 8. DISPLAY OF UPCOMING ROADWORK Policy The policy statement is to allow display of DMS messages of upcoming roadwork that could impact the efficiency of drivers’ trips because of lane closures or other activities in the work zone. In addition, the number of days in advance of the roadwork during which a message can be displayed is established. Policy Statement Example
Traffic-related information that provides advance notice of upcoming roadwork may be displayed, but should be replaced by current information whenever applicable. The upcoming roadwork may be on a freeway that could possibly affect the drivers’ trips (e.g., the same freeway as the DMS, downstream intersecting freeway, etc.). The advance notification should not be given more than 7 days prior to the roadwork. Calendar dates should not be used in the message.
Justification and/or Considerations When there is a concern about adverse public reaction when DMSs are left in a blank mode in the absence of incidents, roadwork, or other conditions that may adversely affect the driver’s safety or travel efficiency, periodic display of relevant upcoming roadwork reduces the amount of blank time on the DMS. Results of human factors studies in New Jersey (11) and Texas (12) indicate that the majority of drivers cannot relate calendar days (e.g., SEP 25-SEP 28) displayed on signs with actual workdays. Consequently, calendar dates should not be displayed on DMSs. Days of the week (e.g., TUES-FRI) should be displayed instead. Therefore, advance notification of roadwork
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-11
should not be displayed more than one week prior to the roadwork in order to avoid the need to display calendar days. 9. DISPLAY OF UPCOMING SPECIAL EVENTS THAT ADVERSELY
AFFECT TRAVEL Policy The policy statement is to allow display of information about upcoming special events that will adversely affect travel by generating major traffic or by requiring street or highway closures (e.g., parades, street auto races, etc.). In addition, the number of days in advance of the event during which a message can be displayed is established. Policy Statement Example
Traffic-related information that provides advance notice of upcoming special events that will adversely affect travel by generating major traffic or by requiring street or highway closures (e.g., parades, street auto races, etc.) may be displayed. The advance notification should not be given more than 7 days prior to the special event. Calendar dates should not be used in the message.
Justification and/or Considerations (See Justification and/or Considerations for 7. Upcoming Roadwork.) 10. TRAFFIC DIVERSION (GENERAL) Policy The policy statement is to ensure that positive guidance in the form of signs and/or law enforcement or traffic control personnel are placed at critical locations along the alternative route when the DMS messages direct drivers to divert to a specific alternative route. Policy Statement Example
When incidents occur that do not require the full closure of the roadway and it is desirable to divert traffic from the freeway, DMS messages shall not divert motorists to specific alternative routes unless positive guidance is available along the alternative route in the form of a) guide signs and/or trailblazers to the major destination or b) law enforcement or traffic control personnel positioned at critical locations along the alternative route to control and guide traffic. Furthermore, both of the following conditions must be met:
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-12
• The DMS operator has current and continuously updated knowledge of the traffic conditions on the alternative route; and
• The alternative route will result in a significant savings in time for the diverted motorists.
Justification and/or Considerations It is important that motorists are not diverted from the freeway to routes that do not provide positive guidance. Motorists are more willing to divert to an alternative route before they enter the freeway. They are less willing to divert after they are on the freeway because the average motorist enjoys the “security” of not getting lost while on the freeway and is reluctant to drive on unfamiliar routes if he/she were to divert (13). Results of studies reported in 1979 showed that the average motorist at that time indicated a propensity to divert when the delay on the freeway was 20 minutes or more (14, 15).
11. TRAFFIC DIVERSION TO ROADWAYS NOT UNDER THE
JURISDICTION OF TXDOT Policy The policy statement is intended to ensure that DMS diversion messages do not advise freeway drivers to use specific local streets that are not under the jurisdiction of TxDOT without prior approvals and agreements with the local agency. Policy Statement Example
DMS messages giving specific alternative routes may be displayed when the route is another state route. Specific messages recommending that motorists divert to specific roadways and/or local streets that are not within the jurisdiction of TxDOT are not permitted unless severe conditions exist and the appropriate agencies are involved. Messages supporting preplanned diversion routes established via written agreements with the local transportation agency are permitted at all times. “Soft” diversion messages (i.e., USE OTHER ROUTES) may be displayed when conditions warrant.
Justification and/or Considerations It is important that institutional cooperation be maintained between TxDOT and local agencies.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-13
12. ADVANCE NOTICE OF ROADWORK INVOLVING LANE CLOSURES
Policy The policy statement is to allow display of advance notice of roadwork involving lane closures that could impact the safety and efficiency of travel, and to prohibit the use of calendar days in the advance notice message. Policy Statement Example
Displaying advance notice of roadwork or other potential impacts to a roadway on DMSs is acceptable. TxDOT Standard Plan TCP (6-1) – 98A states that “Static signs or changeable message signs stating the duration of ramp or freeway closure shall be placed a minimum of seven (7) calendar days in advance of actual closure.” However, starting from six days prior to the closure, the advance notice shall be displayed in terms of days of the week. Calendar dates shall not be displayed. Messages that impact the safety and operations of the roadway shall have priority over advance notice messages.
Justification and/or Considerations Giving advance notice of roadway activities that may impact motorists’ travel helps them in planning future trips and travel paths. Results of research conducted in Texas (12) and New Jersey (11) have shown that motorists cannot translate calendar dates to specific days of the week; thus, calendar dates should not be displayed. To adequately sign using the days of the week, it is important that the motorists are not confused as to whether the message applies to the current week or the following week. Thus, the message should not be displayed more than six days before the event takes place. Advance notice messages have much lower priority than messages that impact the safety and operations of the roadway. 13. PLANNED SPECIAL EVENTS Possible applications of DMSs during planned special events are as follows:
• Accommodate through drivers on the freeway when their travel is adversely affected by high-impact special events; and/or
• Manage traffic destined to the special event.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-14
Policy Alternative #1 The policy statement is to allow the display of DMS messages to inform through drivers on the freeway when their travel is adversely affected by high-impact special events. Policy Statement Example
DMS messages may be displayed to inform through drivers on the freeway of adverse traffic conditions created as a result of special event traffic or conditions, or to reroute through drivers.
Justification and/or Considerations Special events are traffic-related events on highways that involve closing lanes (e.g., bicycle races) or occur off the freeway system but may adversely influence freeway traffic and flows. Informing through freeway drivers of unexpected congestion, delays, lane closures, or detours resulting from the special event is a legitimate use for the DMSs and is in concert with Policy Statement 1. Policy Alternative #2 The policy statement is to allow DMSs messages to be displayed to manage traffic destined to high-impact special events. Policy Statement Example
DMSs may be used to accommodate motorists traveling to special events (e.g., sporting event) when the anticipated traffic flow rates to the event exceed [number] vph. The messages may be used to direct motorists from the primary route to an alternative route that will eventually lead to a parking area. Trailblazers shall be used on the alternative route to direct motorists to the special event parking areas. Traffic conditions on the primary route and alternative route must be monitored. Messages intended to elicit diversion shall only be displayed when there is a significant savings in travel time for the motorists destined to the event, or when the motorists are being directed to parking areas with available parking spaces. The message shall be blanked alternately whenever the alternative route does not provide a significant travel time saving.
DMSs may also be used to inform drivers of intermodal facilities and transportation opportunities to accommodate visitors to the special event. (See Policy Statement 22. Intermodal Information.)
Justification and/or Considerations Research has shown that one of the most effective uses of DMSs is for special events (16, 17). A large majority of motorists respond to DMS messages when the information directs them to a faster route to the special event. The alternative route must provide a significant travel time saving. Also, motorists are concerned with specific directions to parking areas; therefore,
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-15
trailblazers on the alternative route should guide drivers to parking areas. Signing guidelines for special events are given in the Manual on Real-Time Motorist Information Displays (8). One advantage of DMSs is that messages can be displayed when it is desirable to divert motorists to the alternative route and can be turned off when they no longer apply. It is essential that TxDOT personnel monitor traffic conditions on both the primary and secondary routes to ensure that motorists are not being diverted to an alternative route that does not provide significant time saving. For some special events, intermodal transportation travel is emphasized for a number of reasons, including very limited parking or no parking at all at the special event site. DMSs are useful in informing motorists if ;parking is not available and the need to park at facilities such as park-and-ride shuttle lots. Directions to the park-and-ride shuttle lots can be given as well. 14. REGULATORY SPEED MESSAGES Policy The policy is to ensure that DMSs are not used as an exclusive speed limit regulatory sign. Policy Statement Example
The DMS message can be displayed to supplement existing static speed limit signs. The DMS message is not enforceable and shall not be used in place of a static sign. However, the DMS can be used to display advisory speed limits without static advisory speed limit signs.
Justification and/or Considerations For certain conditions such as in freeway work zones there is a need to lower the speed limit below the normal posted speed limit. DMSs may be used to emphasize the change in speed limit that has been established using actual regulatory speed limit signs in that section. Regulatory messages on current types of DMSs are not recognized or standardized in the MUTCD (1), nor do they have any legal status with respect to any information that they display. (Note: FHWA is considering a change in the MUTCD that would allow a DMS sign to be used as the sole sign to post regulatory messages such as speed limits without the need for a static sign (18).)
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-16
15. ADVERSE WEATHER, ENVIRONMENTAL, AND ROADWAY CONDITIONS
Policy The policy allows display of adverse weather, environmental, roadway condition messages on DMSs. Policy Statement Example
DMSs may be used to display adverse weather, environmental, or roadway conditions downstream that may impact driver visibility and safety (e.g., fog, major snow storms, sand storms, icy roadway, high cross winds, broken pavement, etc.) or advise motorists of specific regulations due to the weather or roadway conditions (e.g., tire chains required). Messages, when used, are restricted to a specific location and a specific DMS. The roadway condition must be in the vicinity of the sign in use. General weather, environmental, or roadway condition information (ICY ROAD CONDITIONS AHEAD) is not permitted.
Justification and/or Considerations
Informing motorists of adverse conditions helps to prepare them to take action (e.g., reduce speed).
16. LIMITS OF DMS INFLUENCE FOR INCIDENTS Policy This policy statement establishes the limits of the DMS message influence with respect to distance downstream of the DMS. Policy Statement Example
The following constitutes the policy for displaying incident messages on DMSs.
• Messages should be displayed for all verified major incidents (e.g., multi-vehicle crash affected several lanes, truck overturn, etc.) that occur on the freeway up to [number] miles downstream of the DMS. The message should include the location of the incident (or closure) and the number of lanes closed.
• Information concerning verified minor incidents and lane closures should be
displayed for incidents occurring up to [number] miles from the DMS,
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-17
provided that information about the location and the number of lanes closed can also be given.
• Information concerning verified lane-blocking incidents that occur on an
intersecting freeway may be displayed on DMSs that are located upstream of the interchange with that freeway depending on the location, severity, and duration of the incident.
• DMSs located on freeways leading to other states may display messages
concerning verified major incidents (e.g., all lanes closed, truck overturn, etc.) on connecting freeways within the following states [names of states] depending on the location, severity, and duration of the incident.
Justification and/or Considerations There is sometimes uncertainty by TMC supervisors concerning whether a DMS should be activated to display a message when an incident occurs that, in the supervisor’s opinion, may not be close to the DMS. 17. ADVERTISING Policy The policy prohibits the display of advertisements or advertisement type messages on DMSs. Policy Statement Example
DMS messages advertising any product, service, campaign or political party are prohibited. Messages for special events should be designed such that advertising is not embedded in the messages (e.g., messages such as GARTH BROOKS CONCERT should not be displayed).
Justification and/or Considerations
Commercial advertisements on DMSs are prohibited by federal regulations (see Section 2E.21 in MUTCD). The illegality is also emphasized in two memoranda—one written in 1995 by Jerry L. Malone, Chief Counsel, FHWA (19) and the other written in 2001 by Christine M. Johnson, Program Manager, Operations and Director, ITS Joint Program Office, FHWA (http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsres/directives/policy/pame.htm) (2). Oftentimes, special events have a significant impact on motorists—those attending the special event and those using the same primary freeway to pass by the special event location. Messages for special events can be well designed without including the private company or person sponsoring or performing at the event. For example, if Garth Brooks was performing at a facility
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-18
at Fair Park, rather than displaying GARTH BROOKS CONCERT, the facility at which the concert will be performed (FAIR PARK) can be used. 18. PUBLIC SERVICE ANNOUNCEMENTS Policy Alternative #1 The policy prohibits display of public service announcements on DMSs. Policy Statement Example
Messages designed to relay a public service announcement (e.g., ridesharing, enforcement actions, telephone hotlines, potential transit strike notices, etc.) are not permitted on DMSs, nor are messages designed to increase public awareness of a specific topic not associated with traffic or transportation.
Justification and/or Considerations Public service announcements (PSAs) do not provide drivers with real-time safety or travel efficiency information. PSAs provide motorists with information that can be more effectively disseminated through other methods such as media campaigns or pamphlets. These and other methods would benefit a greater majority of the motoring public since it would not be limited to only those that travel on freeways with DMSs. One argument in support of this policy is the concern that motorists who continually travel a specific route will become accustomed to the public service sign message and then begin to ignore the DMSs. Subsequent messages indicating lane closures, detours, etc., that directly affect motorists’ travels may then tend to be unnoticed. Since DMSs are provided for the purpose of informing the motorists of unexpected conditions, the signs should be left blank and unused until conditions warrant their use. When use of the signs for real-time information is infrequent, it may be desirable to display other information that may affect the motorists’ travel (e.g., existing or planned roadwork on the specific facility or on other intersecting freeways, expressways or toll roads, or travel time information). A second argument in support of this policy is the potential negative response by the public when PSAs are displayed. In the past, Caltrans personnel in the TMC in Los Angeles displayed public service messages on freeway DMSs. Although these messages were transportation-related (e.g., NEXT TIME TRY AMTRAK TO LAS VEGAS; RELIEVE CONGESTION–RIDESHARE; etc.) they did not relate to the operation of the freeway system. Public reaction to the use of DMSs in this manner was quite negative. There was a belief among the traffic operations professionals that such use led to a public disregard of messages on the DMSs, thus making the signs less effective when traffic operational messages were displayed. The practice has been discontinued; DMSs are now used only for messages pertaining to unusual real-time traffic flow conditions (20).
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-19
Policy Alternative #2 The policy allows display of public service announcements on DMSs. Policy Statement Example
Public service announcements (PSAs) may be displayed on a limited and short-term basis. DMSs should only be used only randomly and sparingly for PSAs so that the primary purpose of the signs will not be degraded. PSAs shall not be displayed in urban areas during the peak periods, and the total duration of the display should not exceed [number] hours per day or more than [number] days per month at any permanent DMS location. PSAs shall not be displayed prior to the approval of the [title]. The text for PSA messages must be approved by the [title].
Justification and/or Considerations Normally, DMSs will only be used for PSAs that are directly related to transportation (e.g., carpool information, transit information, etc.). If the DMSs are used on a regular basis for non-critical messages and PSAs, motorists may begin ignoring the signs and miss urgent messages. The concept is that the signs are blank unless there is something urgent to relay to motorists. 19. DISPLAY OF AMBER ALERTS Policy The policy allows DMS messages to be displayed for child abduction (AMBER) alerts. The policy statement below is an interim policy established by Caltrans (21). Policy Statement Example
DMS messages may be displayed for AMBER alerts. Only credible real-time information, where it is crucial to the safety of the victim to disseminate the information to the public in the near term, will be displayed on these DMS signs. Law enforcement activates an Amber alert when circumstances meet the following criteria: the missing child is of a pre-determined age; the law enforcement agency believes the child has been kidnapped; and the agency believes the missing child is under threat of serious bodily harm or death. TxDOT will consult with the investigating agency prior to requesting any DMS sign activations. TxDOT will only respond to AMBER alert requests from the Texas Department of Public Safety. The TMC staff and Texas Department of Public Safety staff shall jointly agree upon the most appropriate DMS message content(s). TMC staff shall also consult with Texas Department of Public Safety staff regarding the length of time to display messages (initially 2-3 hours) and
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-20
extent of roadway system to display the messages (i.e., radius and/or directions and specific routes). TMC personnel should discuss with the requester the limitations on message content, the number of signs that can be deployed within a given time period, conflicts with other necessary sign messages etc. There is a concern that messages that are too general in describing vehicles might result in inappropriate vigilantism. The preferred response is to display a radio frequency (thus referring the public elsewhere for details) - Highway advisory radios (HAR) or appropriate commercial radio. Alternatively, a license plate number (or partial number) might be displayed along with a vehicle description. The display of any contact phone number is discouraged. Nothing in this policy suggests a requirement to preempt true motorist safety messages, e.g. unexpected “end of queue” motorist alerts, severe weather advisories (fog, smoke), road closure and detour information etc. It may be necessary to turn off an AMBER alert sign that creates a traffic hazard.
Justification and/or Considerations The AMBER Plan Program is a voluntary program through which emergency alerts are issued to notify the public about abductions of children. The FHWA has determined that the use of DMSs for this application is acceptable only if the criteria presented in the FHWA Memorandum “AMBER Alert Use of Changeable Message Sign (DMS)” dated August 16, 2002 are satisfied (http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsregs/directives/policy/ambermemo.htm). A summary of the criteria was presented earlier in this Manual starting on page 15-1. The AMBER Plan Program encourages the most effective methods to communicate with the public on behalf of abducted children. The FHWA notes that DMSs are not always the most effective or safest method to disseminate information related to child abductions. Only a limited amount of information can be conveyed on a DMS. When there is a need to provide extensive information to motorists, FHWA states that it is critical that other types of traveler information media (e.g., 511, HAR, web sites, commercial radio) be used or that the messages on a DMS supplement these other media. 20. DRIVER SAFETY CAMPAIGNS Although a safety campaign message is a form of public service announcement, it is addressed separately because some states permit safety campaign DMS messages and not other types of public service announcements. Policy The policy allows display of traffic safety messages associated with safety campaigns.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-21
Policy Statement Example
Public service announcements (PSAs) related to traffic/driver safety issues shall be displayed on DMSs only as a supplement to local or statewide traffic/driver safety media campaigns on the same topic. The PSAs shall not be displayed in urban areas during peak traffic periods, and the total duration of the display should not exceed [number] hours per day or more than [number] days per month at any permanent DMS location.
Justification and/or Considerations
(See Justification and/or Considerations for 17. Public Service Announcements, above.)
21. DISPLAYING MESSAGES FOR OTHER STATES Policy The policy allows messages to be displayed on DMSs when major incidents or roadwork occur in an adjoining state. Policy Statement Example
DMSs may be used to display messages relating to major incidents and major construction for other agencies. The priority for displaying messages shall remain in the control of TxDOT. If another agency’s message is preempted by TxDOT for higher priority needs, TxDOT shall notify the other agency.
Justification and/or Considerations Many states in high-volume corridors have recognized the importance of providing motorists who travel from one state to another or through several states with information about major incidents in the adjacent state. The I-95 Corridor Coalition and the Gary-Chicago-Milwaukee ITS Priority Corridor are examples of multi-state cooperative agreements to apply ITS technologies toward solutions of regional problems. Also, agreements are sometimes reached between adjacent states that are not in a high-volume corridor. 22. INTERMODAL INFORMATION Policy The policy is designed to allow DMS messages to be displayed for inter-modal travel.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-22
Policy Statement Example
DMSs may be used to display messages to inform motorists of conditions to assist them with inter-modal travel. For example, DMSs may display messages to inform motorists a) of the availability of parking at Park-and-Ride facilities, b) of the availability of parking at the [name] Airport, c) whether AMTRAK trains are running on schedule, or d) about delays in departures of the [name] Ferry System. This information is of a lower priority than information concerning roadway incidents and other situations that affect motorist safety. The priority for displaying messages shall remain in the control of TxDOT.
Justification and/or Considerations In high-density corridors, travel options are highly interrelated. Information about parking lot availability, ferry system departure delays, etc. can affect freeway driver real-time decisions about which exit ramps to use and so are appropriate information units to present in DMS messages. 23. OPERATION WITH LANE CONTROL SIGNALS Policy The policy requires that a message should be displayed on the relevant DMS whenever lane-use control signals (LCS) display red or yellow symbols. Policy Statement Example
DMS should always be used whenever lane-use control signals are activated to display either red or yellow symbols.
Justification and/or Considerations At least one state DOT has a similar written policy. Truly effective freeway LCS symbols should convey a clear message and elicit a consistent response from all motorists if they are to be useful tools for managing traffic during incidents. This should be true whether drivers have been educated about their use or if they are seeing them for the first time. Results of studies in the late 1950s by Forbes et al. (22), in the late 1970s by Dudek et al. (13), and more recently in the 1990s by Ullman (23) and Wohlschlaeger et al. (24) indicated that the majority of drivers tested understand the meaning of the green arrow and red X. However, the interpretations indicate that the yellow X is ambiguous, particularly when it is displayed with a red X in an adjacent lane. Wohlschlaeger et al. found that a higher percentage of drivers understood the downward slanted yellow arrow than the yellow X and that it produced the least variation and confusion. Results of studies by Dudek et al. (12) reported in 2000 showed that only 36 percent of the motorists tested responded that they did not need any additional information beyond what was
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-23
provided by the LCS and an ACCIDENT AHEAD message displayed on a DMS. Fourteen percent stated that they would like to see which lanes were closed (which would be redundant with the LCS). Meanwhile, 50 percent of the drivers stated that other information would be useful. Information about the approximate distance to the crash was cited as needed information by 14 percent of the drivers. Finally, smaller proportions of drivers indicated a preference for expected travel times, magnitudes of delays, average speeds downstream, or general caution information. The results suggest that it is possible to rely on the LCS to indicate which lanes are blocked or closed and to utilize the DMS to provide other key information (what is the problem, how far downstream the problem is located, etc.). 24. TEST MESSAGES Policy The policy establishes the appropriate DMS messages that can be displayed during system testing or for special studies. Policy Statement Example
It is sometimes necessary to display messages on a DMS to assure correct operations, to “burn-in” a new sign, or for special studies. Acceptable test messages should either state TEST-MESSAGE, display a portion of the alphabet, a sequence of numbers, or a non-message test pattern such as moving columns or rows, etc. (Note: SIGN UNDER TEST may be a suitable option to TEST-MESSAGE.) Other test messages shall be reviewed and approved by [name of office or title of person] before they are displayed.
Justification and/or Considerations It is vital that drivers are not misinformed with typical traffic control messages displayed for the purposes of system testing.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-24
REFERENCES
1. Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices. U.S. Department of Transportation, Federal Highway Administration, Washington D.C., 2003.
2. Johnson, C.M. Memorandum: Use of Changeable Message Signs. January 19, 2001.
http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsregs/directives/policy/pame.htm . 3. Peters, M.E. Memorandum: Click It Or Ticket Signs. March 6, 2002. http://mutcd.fhwa.dot.gov/res-memorandum_clickit.htm . 4. Paniati, J.F. FHWA Policy Memorandum: AMBER Alert Use of Changeable Message Sign
(DMS). August 16, 2002. http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsregs/directives/policy/ambermemo.htm . 5. Paniati, J.F. FHWA Policy Memorandum: Use of Changeable Message Sign (DMS) for
Emergency Security. March 21, 2003. http://www.fhwa.dot.gov/legsregs/directives/policy/securmemo.htm . 6. Paniati, J.F. / Lindley J.. Memorandum, Information and Action: Dynamic Message Sign
(DMS) Recommended Practice and Guidance. July 16, 2004. http://www.i95coalition.org/PDF/Calendar/traveltime-memo-ver3.pdf . 7. Dudek, C.L. Variable Message Sign Operations Manual. Report FHWA-NJ-2001-10, New
Jersey Department of Transportation, Trenton, New Jersey, December 2001. 8. Dudek, C.L. and R.D. Huchingson. Manual on Real-Time Motorist Information Displays.
Report FHWA-IP-86-16. FHWA, U.S. Department of Transportation, Washington, D.C., August 1986.
9. Dudek, C.L. Changeable Message Signs. National Cooperative Research Highway
Program, Synthesis of Highway Practice 237, Transportation Research Board, National Research Council, Washington, D.C., 1997.
10. Smith, S.A. INFORM Evaluation, Volume I: Technical Report. Report FHWA-RD-91-075,
FHWA, U.S. Department of Transportation, Washington, D.C., January 1992. 11. Dudek, C.L. Changeable Message Sign Messages for Work Zones: Time of Day, Days of
Week, and Month Dates. In Transportation Research Record 1692, Transportation Research Board, National Research Council, Washington, D.C., 1999, pp. 1-8.
12. Dudek, C.L., N. Trout, S. Booth, and G. Ullman. Improved Dynamic Message Sign
Messages and Operations. Report FHWA/TX/-01/1882-2, Texas Transportation Institute, College Station, Texas, October 2000.
MODULE 21 DMS Operations Policies Page 21-25
13. Dudek, C.L., C.J. Messer, and H.B. Jones. A Study of Design Considerations for Real-Time Freeway Information Systems. In Highway Research Record 363, Transportation Research Board, National Research Council, Washington, D.C., 1971, pp. 1-17.
14. Huchingson, R.D. and C.L. Dudek. Delay, Time Saved, and Travel Time Information for
Freeway Traffic Management. In Transportation Research Record 722, Transportation Research Board, National Research Council, Washington, D.C., 1979, pp. 36-40.
15. Dudek, C.L., R.D. Huchingson, R.J. Koppa, and M.L. Edwards. Human Factors
Requirements for Real-Time Motorist Information Displays, Vol. 10 – Human Factors Evaluation of Traffic State Descriptor Variables. Report FHWA-RD-78-14. FHWA, U.S. Department of Transportation, Washington, D.C., February 1978.
16. Dudek, C.L. G.W. Weaver, D.R. Hatcher, and S.H. Richards. Field Evaluation of Messages
for Real-Time Diversion of Freeway Traffic for Special Events. In Highway Research Board Record 682, TRB, National Research Council, Washington, D.C., 1978, pp. 37-52.
17. Dudek, C.L. Guidelines on the Use of Changeable Message Signs. Report FHWA-TS-90-
043. FHWA, U.S. Department of Transportation, Washington, D.C., May 1991. 18. Rankin, F., Federal Highway Administration. Telephone conversation on March 20, 2002. 19. Malone, J. L. Memorandum to D. Judycki and T. Ptak. Re: Legal Opinion on the Erection
of Billboards on the Right-Of-Way of an Interstate Highway by a State. December 19, 1995.
20. Roper, D., formerly Deputy District Director, Operations, California Department of
Transportation. Telephone conversation on March 21, 2002. 21. Use of DMS Signs for Child Abduction (AMBER) Alert Messages. Interim Policy,
California Department of Transportation, Division of Traffic Operations. August 8, 2002. 22. Forbes, T.W., E. Gervais, and T. Allen. Effectiveness of Symbols for Lane Control Signals.
In Bulletin 244, HRB, National Research Council, Washington, D.C., 1959, pp 16-29. 23. Ullman, G.L. Motorist Interpretation of MUTCD Freeway Lane Control Signals. In
Transportation Research Record 1403, Transportation Research Board, National Research Council, Washington, D.C., 1993, pp. 49-56.
24. Wohlschlaeger, S.D., G.L. Ullman, and C.L. Dudek. Motorist Interpretation of Yellow X
and Yellow Diagonal Arrow in Freeway Lane Control Signal Array. In Transportation Research Record 1495, Transportation Research Board, National Research Council, Washington, D.C., 1995, pp. 9-16.
MODULE 22 DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines Page 22-i
MODULE 22. DMS OPERATIONS PROCEDURES AND GUIDELINES
TABLE OF CONTENTS
22.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................. 22-1 22.2 DAYS AND HOURS OF OPERATION .................................................... 22-2 22.3 DMS OPERATORS ............................................................................................. 22-2 22.4 RESPONSIBILITIES OF DMS OPERATORS ..................................... 22-3 22.5 AUTHORITY TO DESIGN MESSAGES................................................. 22-5 22.6 DOCUMENTATION OF DMS USAGE.................................................... 22-5 22.7 GROUPING OPERATIONS OF MORE THAN ONE DMS .......... 22-5
MODULE 22 DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines Page 22-1
MODULE 22. DMS OPERATIONS PROCEDURES AND GUIDELINES
22.1 INTRODUCTION Module 21 DMS Operations Policies contained guidelines to assist TxDOT in developing statewide or regional policies for the operation of DMSs. Module 22 contains a listing and discussions of items that TxDOT may want to include in a document that contains DMS operations procedures and guidelines. The procedures and guidelines would establish the day-to-day operation of the DMSs. The operations guidelines are influenced by the policies established by TxDOT. TMC managers should consider developing an operations procedures and guidelines manual that includes the items listed below. The operations procedures and guidelines manual will be a very useful document for staff working in the TMC.
1. Responsibility for operation of DMS system 2. Days and hours of operation 3. DMS operators 4. Responsibilities of DMS operators 5. Authority to design messages 6. Authority to display messages 7. Authority to display messages during off TMC hours 8. Requests for DMS messages from agency persons outside of TMC 9. Requests for DMS messages from other agencies 10. Documentation of DMS usage 11. Verifying the incident prior to displaying message 12. Verifying the message via closed circuit television 13. Message libraries vs. developing messages as the need arises 14. Automated display of messages 15. Automatic shutoff of DMS messages 16. Grouping operations of more than one DMS 17. Use of DMSs during construction 18. Use of DMSs during non-incident related conditions 19. Operation of DMSs with lane control signals 20. Use of DMS messages as part of the freeway management system operational strategies
(along with ramp meters and traffic intersection signals) 21. Information needed about incident and alternative route before message is displayed 22. Priority of message types 23. Priority when two events (incidents, roadwork, etc.) are on the freeway at the same time 24. Format of messages 25. Maximum number of units of information in messages for each DMS 26. Reducing message size when lighting conditions change 27. Reducing the number of units of information in messages to account for their effects on
drivers’ ability to read messages 28. Messages displayed prior to identification of specifics of an incident 29. Acceptable message words/terms for
MODULE 22 DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines Page 22-2
• Incident/roadwork descriptor • Incident/roadwork location • Closure descriptor • Location of closure • Effect on travel • Audience for action • Action
30. Acceptable abbreviation terms 31. Use of one-phase and two-phase messages 32. Use and criteria for flashing messages 33. Use and criteria for flashing a message line 34. Flashing beacons on DMSs 35. Messages after an incident is removed from the freeway lanes before congestion clears 36. Messages after incident is removed from freeway lanes after congestion clears 37. Location and positioning of DMSs 38. On-site control of DMSs 39. Coordination with other agencies 40. Display of congestion information during and immediately following incidents 41. Display of “all clear” messages after an incident has been removed from the freeway
lanes 42. DMS messages to support HAR 43. Messages for truck and hazardous cargo restrictions 44. Use of graphics in messages
Information previously given in Modules 1 through 9 in this Manual should be helpful in formulating procedures and guidelines for many of the issues listed above. The sections that follow in this below address those issues in the list that were not here-to-for addressed in the Manual. 22.2 DAYS AND HOURS OF OPERATION The TMC operating hours must be established. If the TMC is not staffed 24/7, credibility could be compromised if the DMSs are not operating when major events that result in severe congestion occur (crashes, holiday traffic, etc.). Thus, the TMC manager should make arrangements to ensure that messages are displayed on appropriate DMSs during off hours. 22.3 DMS OPERATORS The DMS operators are often the critical link between TxDOT and the motorists. They are the ones who ultimately control and monitor what is displayed on DMSs. No matter how automated the DMS message posting practices, proper DMS operation requires well-trained individuals to operate the system. Some of the desirable skills needed by operators are as follows:
MODULE 22 DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines Page 22-3
• Common sense, • Ability to make decisions under stress, • Ability to understand and follow written and oral procedures, • Writing and verbal abilities, • People skills, • Computer skills, • General knowledge of transportation, • Familiarity with local and statewide roadway network, • Technical knowledge, and • Basic knowledge of electronics.
Recruitment and retention of qualified operators is a challenge, particularly when the TMC operates 24/7. Thus, TMC managers should establish practices concerning DMS operator
• Recruiting, • Hiring, • Training, • Retaining, and • Performance.
22.4 RESPONSIBILITIES OF DMS OPERATORS The TMC manager should consider preparing written responsibilities of DMS operators, procedures with respect to operator shifts, and responsibilities of DMS operators at the beginning and end of each shift. These help the DMS operators to understand their responsibilities, provide clarity to work schedules, and maintain operational consistency among the operators. Useful resources for developing responsibilities of DMS operators are listed below. 1. Arizona Department of Transportation, Transportation Technology Group. Traffic
Operations Center (TOC) Operations Manual. January 2002.
2. Baxter, D.H. Guidelines for TMC Transportation Management Operations Technician Staff Development, Report FHWA-OP-03-071, Traffic Management Center Pooled-Fund Study, Federal Highway Administration, U.S. Department of Transportation, Washington, D.C., August 2005.
Also at: http://tmcpfs.ops.fhwa.dot.gov/cfprojects/new_detail.cfm?id=26&new=2 3. Ray, J.B., Jr., T.M. Whaley, D.R. Stocks, and D.J. Folds. TMC Operator Requirements and
Position Descriptions. Traffic Management Center Pooled-Fund Study, Federal Highway Administration, U.S. Department of Transportation, Washington, D.C., October 2002. http://tmcpfs.ops.fhwa.dot.gov/cfprojects/new_detail.cfm?id=55&new=2
Below is an operator’s mission statement contained in the Arizona DOT Traffic Operations Center Manual.
MODULE 22 DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines Page 22-4
“The operator’s primary mission is to assure the safety of the motoring public. The operator must understand the system, be able to make sound decisions, and quickly implement the proper procedures for routine and emergency actions. This is accomplished through a thorough understanding and working knowledge of TOC policies and procedures. Timely and accurate responses to all reports of incidents and requests for information, services, or ADOT equipment is required at all times. The operator must provide quality information in a prompt and courteous manner to the public, public agencies, and ADOT personnel. When a situation arises that the operator cannot resolve, the TOC Supervisor or designee will be advised immediately and a proper response will provided as rapidly as possible. The Traffic Management System (TMS) is a computerized system designed to assist with management of traffic occurrences. The system cannot react to emergencies without input from the operator. The TMS must be monitored continuously to enable the operator to give timely and accurate notification to the proper agencies.”
Below are statements of procedures established by the Arizona DOT.
“There are three shifts: a) morning shift (6 AM to 2 PM), b) evening shift (2 PM to 10 PM), and c) graveyard shift (10 PM to 6 AM). Each operator and shift supervisor works 8 hours a day, five days a week. At the end of each shift, each operator will: √ Discuss any ongoing incidents or issues with the operator going off-shift. √ Access and read E-mail. √ Scan all monitors to determine traffic conditions and verify the status of any
incident. √ Review closed incidents for previous 24 hours on the Operator Workstation
(OW). √ Review Highway Condition Reporting System (HCRS) status. Check for any
incidents that are being worked by other districts. √ Check HCRS entries for quality At the end of each shift, every operator will: √ Verify that the OW incident logs are completely up-to-date. √ Advise the incoming operator of any pending issues. √ Leave the work area in a clean and orderly condition. √ Make sure all customer inquiries received during their shift have been
handled.
All operators may be assigned additional duties as necessary by the Operations Supervisor.”
MODULE 22 DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines Page 22-5
22.5 AUTHORITY TO DESIGN MESSAGES Results of interviews with state DOT representatives revealed that DMS operators at some TMCs have the authority to design messages and to display the messages they design without TMC supervisor approval of the messages. This practice is more likely to occur at TMCs that operate a small number of DMSs or where software has not been developed to a level that will suggest messages for display based on minimal input by the operator or present the operator with a standardized message template. Allowing operators to design messages without supervision can have serious negative credibility consequences because there is no assurance that the messages will adhere to sound design principles. Also, this practice can increase the likelihood of inconsistent messages among the many operators. Therefore, TMC supervisors should regularly review and critique any messages created by operators and provide feedback to the operator on ways to improve consistency and credibility of the messages.
22.6 DOCUMENTATION OF DMS USAGE It is important to document DMS benefits as operational needs increase and resources dwindle. Continuous recordkeeping of DMS use during incidents, roadwork, inclement weather, special events, etc., is one measure of the benefits of the DMS system. Documentation of when DMS messages are displayed is important to evaluate the effectiveness of the messages in the library and DMS locations. The logs are also important for possible tort defense. DMS benefits may be quantified in order to arrive at benefit/cost ratios. For example, when an incident occurs, a DMS message upstream of the incident can inform motorists to exit and take an alternative route, thus preventing them from standing in a traffic jam. Knowing the time of the incident, the time the message is displayed, the number and percentage of vehicles diverted, and the conditions on the freeway and alternate route, one can determine an estimated cost savings resulting from the use of the DMS. 22.7 GROUPING OPERATIONS OF MORE THAN ONE DMS Some transportation agencies use an automation technique referred to as grouping. Grouping allows the TMC manager to place a certain number of signs into a group and associate a specific message with each sign in that group. Then, when a single command is given by the DMS operator to activate that group, the messages on all the DMSs in the group change appropriately. This further simplifies system operations and helps keep incomplete or conflicting information from being displayed. An example of automatic grouping of messages which was used by the Houston District is shown in Figure 22-1.
MODULE 22 DMS Operations Procedures and Guidelines Page 22-6
Figure 22-1. Example of Automatic DMS Grouping – Houston TranStar).
APPENDIX A Message Length Reductions for Vertical Curves Page A-1
APPENDIX A. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS
FOR VERTICAL CURVES
A.1 THEORY
Vertical curve designs are based on providing adequate stopping sight distance to a small
object located in the travel lane for a motorist traveling at the design speed of the curve. The
AASHTO Policy on Geometric Design of Highways and Streets recommends using a parabolic
vertical curve to connect two intersecting grade lines. Near worst-case conditions are assumed
for driver perception-reaction time, pavement friction, driver eye and roadway object heights,
and other factors that influence a driver’s ability to safely stop a vehicle. Basic geometry is then
used to define the relationship between the length of curve required to provide a given sight
distance (when the sight distance is less than the length of the curve):
where,
L = length of parabolic curve (ft)
A = algebraic difference in grades (%)
S = required stopping sight distance (ft)
h1= driver eye height (ft)
h2= roadway object eye height (ft)
The above equation can be rearranged to describe the sight distance available as a function of the
length of curve provided, as shown below:
Written in this manner, it is possible to assess how different object heights influence the
available sight distance (or “reading” distance) for a given curve (defined by its length L and
grade difference A). More importantly, the available sight distance of an object at any height
above the roadway can be related to the stopping sight distance (Sssd) used for vertical curve
design purposes using the simple ratio shown below (with the second subscript in the numerator
denoting the new object height). Note that the constant, L, and A drop out of the equation:
h+h
AS=L21
2
2
22100 (1)
AL
h+h=S 21 2210
APPENDIX A Message Length Reductions for Vertical Curves Page A-2
For Sssd design purposes, an object height (h2ssd) of 0.5 ft is commonly assumed. DMSs, on the
other hand, are located considerably higher above the road and so will have a greater sight
(reading) distance available. The driver eye height assumed for calculations is the same (h11 =
h1ssd) regardless of the object being considered (current guidelines use a driver eye height of 3.5
ft. Labeling h21 as the height of a DMS (hDMS) and the other variables with their assumed values
yields the following relationship:
This ratio can then easily be solved for different DMS mounting heights to determine the
available reading distance to the sign in relation to the stopping sight distance provided by that
vertical curve. Figure A.1 presents a plot of the relationship between DMS height above the road
and this sight distance ratio. As an example, a portable DMS located 7 ft above the roadway on
a crest vertical curve would yield a sight distance that is approximately 1.7 times that of the
stopping sight distance provided by that curve. Likewise, a permanent overhead-mounted DMS
located 26 ft above the roadway (a fairly common mounting height) provides a relative sight
distance to the sign that is about 2.7 times the stopping sight distance.
Figure A.1 Ratio of DMS Reading Distance to Stopping Sight Distance
h+hh+h=
SS
2ssd1ssd
2111
ssd
1
22
22 (2)
17
27
+h+
=SS DMS
ssd
DMS (3)
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
0 5 10 15 20 25 30
VMS Mounting Height (ft)
VM
S R
ea
din
g D
ista
nc
e/S
SD
APPENDIX A Message Length Reductions for Vertical Curves Page A-3
The relationship depicted in Figure A.1 can then be used with design information about the
vertical curve to estimate the available reading distance to the sign. The analyst either uses the
curve design criteria directly (L and A) to compute Sssd or uses the stated design speed of the
curve to estimate Sssd from tables already provided in most state roadway design manuals or from
AASHTO policy.
In most cases, permanent overhead DMSs generally have adequate available reading distances to
allow typical-length messages to be used. Conditions where this may not be the case include
situations where actual operating speeds on the facility exceed the design speed of the curve or
situations where a considerable lateral offset exists between the driver’s eye and the center of the
DMS. To illustrate this point, Figure A.2 presents a plot of the actual available reading distance
to a DMS mounted 26 ft above the roadway on vertical curves with design speeds ranging from
25 to 70 mph. Also plotted on Figure A.2 are the required reading distances for a message
presenting 4 units of information (as defined by Dudek and Huchingson) to the driver (current
guidelines recommend this as an upper limit for presentation) on a DMS that has a lateral offset
from the driver of 30, 65, and 100 ft. According to guidelines, such a message would require 8
seconds of reading time to properly perceive and interpret the information. Two points should be
evident from this figure. First, conditions where required reading distance to a DMS may exceed
the available reading distance of that DMS are more likely to occur at lower design speeds. The
second point to note is that a significant lateral offset between the driver and the DMS can
significantly increase the required reading distance to the sign and create message constraints
even up to fairly high design speeds. It should be intuitive that these constraints will be even
more significant for portable DMSs that are typically lower in height.
Figure A.2 Available versus Required Reading Distance to a DMS on a
Vertical Curve for a Four-Unit Message (26 ft DMS Mounting Height)
0
500
1000
1500
2000
2500
40 50 60 70
Curve Design Speed (mph)
Sig
ht
Dis
tan
ce (
ft)
Avail Sight Distance - 26 ft high VMS 30 ft driver-VMS offset
65 ft driver-VMS offset Avail Sight Distance - 7 ft high VMS
APPENDIX A Message Length Reductions for Vertical Curves Page A-4
A.2 PROCEDURE
Generally speaking, permanent DMSs mounted above the travel lanes are not affected by the
presence of crest vertical curves. Vertical curvature is established based on safe stopping sight
distances to a rather small (i.e., 6 inch) object located in the roadway, based on the design speed
of the roadway. The high (20 to 25 ft) typical mounting heights of permanent DMSs provide
viewing distances over the curve that usually exceed the visual capabilities of the signs
themselves. However, this is often not the case for portable DMSs positioned on the shoulder of
the roadway. Furthermore, conditions where actual operating speeds are higher than the design
speed of the vertical curve can sometimes provide less viewing time than are normally assumed
to exist.
To assess the potential influence of the vertical curve, the DMS message designer requires the
following information for the DMS of interest:
Maximum sign viewing offset (ft), which is the sum of
The number of lanes a driver must look across to view the sign, and
The actual sign offset distance from the edge of the travel lanes,
Sign mounting height (ft),
Design speed of the curve (mph),
Curve length (ft), and
Expected operating speed on the curve (mph).
Tables A.1 and A.2 are provided to help evaluate whether a vertical curve is constricting the
viewing of a permanent or portable DMS, respectively. The DMS message designer selects the
appropriate table and finds the actual design speed of the curve, DMS mounting height, and sign
viewing offset (the message designer should extrapolate if actual mounting heights and viewing
offsets are not found in the table). The selected cell defines the available viewing travel distance
that a motorist has available to read a message on the sign. This distance is then compared to the
length of the vertical curve. If the curve is longer than the available viewing distance, the
message designer computes the available viewing time over the curve (if the curve is shorter,
there will not be a viewing constraint due to the vertical curve). Available viewing time is
defined by equation 4:
1.467SpeedOperating
DistanceViewingTimeViewing (4)
In this equation, viewing time is in seconds, viewing distance is in feet, and operating speed in
miles per hour (the 1.467 is a multiplier to convert the units to seconds). The available viewing
time can then simply be divided by 2 to compute the number of units of information that can be
read and processed by motorists.
APPEND
IX A: Message Length Reductions for Vertical C
urves Page A-5
Table A.1 Available Permanent DMS Viewing Distance over Vertical Curves
Available Viewing Distance While Traveling (ft)
DMS Mounting Height = 20 ft DMS Mounting Height = 25 ft
Vertical Curve
Design Speed
(mph) DMS
Over Lanes
DMS Viewing
Offset:20 ft
DMS Viewing
Offset: 60 ft
DMS
Over Lanes
DMS Viewing
Offset: 20 ft
DMS Viewing
Offset: 60 ft
30
35
40
45
50
55
60
65
70
75
490
620
800
980
1170
1350
1600
1780
2090
2300
305
435
615
795
985
1165
1415
1595
1905
2115
80
210
390
570
760
940
1190
1370
1680
1890
530
670
870
1060
1260
1460
1730
1930
2260
2490
345
485
685
875
1075
1275
1545
1745
2075
2305
120
260
460
650
850
1050
1320
1520
1850
2080
Table A.2 Available Portable DMS Viewing Distance over Vertical Curves
Available Viewing Distance While Traveling (ft)
DMS Mounting Height = 7 ft DMS Mounting Height = 10 ft
Vertical Curve
Design Speed
(mph) DMS Viewing
Offset:20 ft
DMS Viewing
Offset: 60 ft
DMS Viewing
Offset: 20 ft
DMS Viewing
Offset: 60 ft
30 235 5 275 45
35 325 95 375 145
40 375 145 515 285
45 585 355 665 435
50 715 485 815 585
55 845 615 955 725
60 1025 795 1155 925
65 1155 925 1295 1065
70 1375 1145 1545 1315
75 1525 1295 1705 1475
APPENDIX A: Message Length Reductions for Vertical Curves Page A-6
For simplicity, the DMS offsets from Table A.1 or A.2 should be selected to represent worst-case
viewing conditions. That is, it should reflect the lateral distance from a motorist traveling in the
lane farthest from the DMS to the middle of the DMS sign (including adjacent travel lanes,
shoulder, actual DMS offset from the edge of pavement, and one-half of the width of the DMS
itself).
The following examples illustrate how the tables are used to estimate reading times for
permanent and portable over crest vertical curves.
A.3 EXAMPLE 1
A 3-line, 15-character DMS (26 ft wide mounted 20 ft above the travel lanes) is located in
the middle of a 20-ft median on a four-lane freeway with a 6-ft inside paved shoulder. The sign
is located on the downstream end of a 1200-ft crest vertical curve. The design speed of the curve
is 60 mph, as is the average operating speed of traffic on that facility. Does the curve constrain
the amount of information that can be presented on the DMS?
DMS VIEWING OFFSET
Worst-case viewing conditions are from the right shoulder lane. Assuming that the driver is
located one-third of a lane in from the lane line, the viewing offset is the sum of that one-third of
a lane, the other travel lane to the left, the 6-ft paved shoulder, and one-half of the median.
Viewing offset = 12/3 + 12 + 6 + 10 = 32 ft
Since this is not shown in Table A.1, one must interpolate between the 20- and 60-ft offset
distances. Using a 60 mph design speed, the available reading distance for a DMS mounted 20 ft
above the roadway is 1415 ft at a 20-ft viewing offset and 1190 ft at a 60-ft viewing offset.
Linear interpolation indicates the available reading distance at a 32-ft offset to be approximately
1350 ft. This is less than the curve length, so is assumed to be the available viewing distance to
the sign. Therefore,
seconds151.47mph60
ft1350TimeViewing
This indicates that there is enough viewing distance for 7 or 8 units of information to be viewed
by motorists. Since this exceeds both the 4 units of information typically assumed as the limit of
driver information processing capability from a DMS and the typical legibility distance of the
DMS itself, the vertical curve does not constrain DMS readability in this example.
APPENDIX A: Message Length Reductions for Vertical Curves Page A-7
A.4 EXAMPLE 2
In this example, a 3-line, 15-character DMS (also 26 ft wide mounted 20 ft above the
roadway) is located to the right of a six-lane urban arterial. The sign is positioned such that the
center of the sign is 15 ft from the edge of pavement. It is located at the downstream end of a
600-ft crest vertical curve that is designed for 35 mph. However, average operating speeds on
this facility are currently closer to 45 mph. Does the curve constrain the amount of information
that can be presented on the DMS?
Worst-case viewing conditions are from the left lane. Assuming the driver is located one-third of
a lane in from the lane line, the viewing offset is the sum of the driver lateral position in the left
lane, the other two travel lanes to the right, and the remaining distance to the middle of the sign.
Viewing offset = 12 + 24 + 15 = 51 ft
Since this is not shown in Table A.1, one must interpolate between the 20- and 60-ft distances.
Using a 35 mph design speed, the available reading distance for a DMS mounted 20 ft above the
roadway is 435 ft at a 20-ft viewing offset and 290 ft at a 60-ft viewing offset. Linear
interpolation indicates the available reading distance at a 51-ft offset to be approximately 320 ft.
This is less than the curve length of 600 ft, and so is assumed to be the available viewing
distance to the sign. Therefore,
seconds51.47mph45
ft320TimeViewing
Dividing this value by 2 indicates that the sign can be seen only far enough to read and process
two to three units of information. Consequently, the vertical curve does constrain DMS
readability in this example.
A.5 EXAMPLE 3
Example 3 characteristics are identical to Example 1, except that a portable DMS with a 7-ft
mounting height is used.
DMS offset = 32 ft
Using a 60 mph design speed, the available viewing distance for a DMS mounted 7 ft above the
roadway is 1025 ft at a 20-ft viewing offset and 795 ft at a 60-ft viewing offset. Linear
interpolation indicates the available reading distance at a 32-ft offset to be approximately 960 ft.
This is less than the 1200-ft curve length, so is assumed to be the available viewing distance to
the sign. Therefore,
APPENDIX A: Message Length Reductions for Vertical Curves Page A-8
seconds111.47mph60
ft960TimeViewing
This corresponds to 5 or 6 units of DMS information (11 seconds divided by 2). Since this
exceeds the 4 units of information typically assumed as the limit of driver information processing
capability from a DMS, the vertical curve does not constrain DMS readability in this example.
A.6 EXAMPLE 4
The details for this example remain the same as in Example 2. However, a 3-line, 8-
character DMS 7 ft above the roadway is located to the right of a six-lane urban arterial. The
sign is positioned such that the center of the sign is 15 ft from the edge of pavement. It is located
at the downstream end of a 600-ft vertical crest curve that is designed for 35 mph. However,
average operating speeds on that facility are currently closer to 45 mph. Does the curve
constrain the amount of information that can be presented on the DMS?
Viewing offset = 51 ft
Since this is not shown in Table A.2, one must interpolate between the 20- and 60-ft distances.
Using a 35 mph design speed, the available reading distance for a DMS mounted 7 ft above the
roadway is 325 ft at a 20-ft viewing offset and 95 ft at a 60-ft viewing offset. Linear
interpolation indicates the available reading distance at a 47-ft offset to be approximately 170 ft.
This is less than the curve length of 600 ft, so is assumed to be the available viewing distance to
the sign. Therefore,
seconds2.51.47mph45
ft170TimeViewing
This time would allow a driver to process approximately 1 unit of information. Since this is
much less than the 4 units of information typically assumed as the limit of driver information
processing capability from a DMS, the vertical curve does constrain DMS readability in this
example. More importantly, such a low available viewing time indicates a significant problem
with placing a portable DMS at this proposed location. In this situation, the message designer
should find a better placement location, such as before the start of the curve itself.
APPENDIX B Message Length Reductions for Horizontal Curves Page B-1
APPENDIX B. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS
FOR HORIZONTAL CURVES
Design criteria for horizontal curvature is based on driver comfort and the friction between
the tires and the roadway. With respect to DMS visibility and viewing time, horizontal curves
generally do not impact permanent DMSs mounted over travel lanes. Likewise, permanent
DMSs mounted adjacent to the travel lanes (in the median or off to the right) will extend above
most obstructions that may exist on the roadside and so will not be affected by horizontal curves
(although certain spot obstructions such as overhead signs or luminaires may be more
problematic to DMS viewing on horizontal curves).
The situation is different for portable DMSs placed on the side of the road within the curve (on
the right side of a right-hand curve, on the left side of a left-hand curve). If an object
(construction vehicle, tree, etc.) is located close to the edge of a roadway on the same side as the
DMS, a driver in the closest lane may not be able to see around the object and fully read and
comprehend the message. The following sections describe the analysis theory and then present a
process to follow to assess whether an obstruction may constrain the reading time of a portable
DMS around a horizontal curve. The procedure is approximate in that it does not consider the
effects of spiral curves sometimes used in horizontal curve design, and so provides slightly
conservative results.
B.1 THEORY
Although horizontal curves are generally not a problem for permanently mounted overhead
DMSs, they can often cause sight distance problems for portable DMSs located to the side of the
road because of roadside obstructions blocking the driver’s view around the curve. Figure B.1
illustrates the analysis of the roadside obstruction situation graphically, as depicted in AASHTO
policy. The worst-case condition for this situation occurs for the driver traveling in the far right
lane. Key variables defining sight distance are the radius of the curve, R, and the offset of the
sight obstruction from the travel path of the vehicle, M, as indicated by the following equation
(other key variables noted in Figure B.1 are also defined below):
where,
M = distance from inside travel lane to obstruction (ft)
S = sight distance around curve (ft)
R = curve radius (ft)
s = offset between edge of far right shoulder lane and the DMS (ft)
L = lane width (ft)
RSR=M
2cos–1 (1)
APPENDIX B Message Length Reductions for Horizontal Curves Page B-2
= ½ angle subtended by a sight distance chord around obstruction
= angle between end of the sight distance chord and location of the DMS
Unlike the vertical curve analysis, DMS mounting height does not enter into consideration of
horizontal curve reading distance calculations. However, lateral placement of the sign relative to
the roadway has a key impact upon the available sight distance to the sign. The effect of this
placement is to reduce the length of the travel arc around the curve to where the DMS intersects
the chord defining the sight distance around the obstruction (see Figure B.1).
Figure B.1 Geometry of Horizontal Curve Sight Obstruction to a DMS
To analyze the effective sight distance to the sign in this situation, the above equation must first
be rewritten and solved for the normal sight distance around the curve, as defined below (note
that the trigonometric relationships are calculated in terms of radians and not degrees):
The travel distance around the curve to the location of the DMS off of the side of the road can be
computed by determining the angle in Figure B.1. This can be accomplished using the
mathematical relationships between M, R, s + L/2 (with s = sign offset and L = lane width), ,
and :
RMR=S –1cos2 1– (2)
MDMS viewing cone
s+L/2
DMS
APPENDIX B Message Length Reductions for Horizontal Curves Page B-3
By rearranging this equation and substituting cos–1
(1 – M/R) for , a solution for is obtained
that is strictly dependent on M, R, s, and L:
The travel distance along the curve bisected by the angle is simply R , where is defined in
terms of radians instead of degrees. Subtracting this value from the original sight distance (S)
yields the following relationship:
The available sight distance around the horizontal curve can then be compared to the required
reading distance of the DMS for a driver traveling at a given speed. Figure B.2 provides an
example of the calculated reading distances to a DMS located 3 ft from the edge of the travel
lane around a horizontal curve where an obstruction is present (similar figures could be
calculated for different DMS offsets).
Assuming that the analyst wants to display a message requiring 8 seconds to read on a facility
with operating speeds of 70 mph, a minimum of 820 ft reading distance is necessary. From
Figure B.2, this requires a minimum curve radius of approximately 1300 ft if the obstruction is
located 80 ft from the travel lane, and more than 2950 ft if the obstruction is located only 10 m
(30 ft) from the travel lane. Depending on the design characteristics of the curve (i.e., AASHTO
policy allows curve radii near these values, depending on superelevation rates used), it is
possible that this reading distance would not be available within the curve. The analyst would
then have to choose between moving the obstruction farther away from the curve (if it a portable
object such as a construction vehicle) or reducing the message length by reducing the units of
information on the DMS.
=L sR
MR–(cos
2––
– (6)
2––
–cos––1cos
1–1–
LsR
MRRM= (7)
L sR
MRRMR=Distance SightAvailable
2––
–cos
2
1–1cos
1–1– (8)
APPENDIX B Message Length Reductions for Horizontal Curves Page B-4
Figure B.2 Example of Available Reading Distance around a Horizontal Curve
(DMS Offset 3 ft from Edge of Travel Lanes)
B.2 PROCEDURE
To determine whether a potential horizontal curve sight distance restriction to a portable
DMS exists, the message designer must have the following information at hand:
Radius of the curve (ft),
Length of the curve (ft),
Distance of DMS to edge of the travel lane (ft),
Distance of a potential sight obstruction from the edge of the travel lane (ft), and
Expected operating speed of vehicles traversing the curve (mph).
Although horizontal curve design typically starts with a design speed, many curves use radii
longer than the minimum required. Consequently, more detailed geometric information (curve
radii and length of curve) is needed to evaluate possible horizontal curve sight restrictions.
Using the above information about the curve, Table B.1 or B.2 is used to determine the possible
restricted viewing distance around a sight obstruction on the curve. If the appropriate sign offset,
curve radius, and/or sight obstruction offset is not listed, the viewing distance value must be
interpolated. This distance is then compared to the length of the horizontal curve and to the
estimated distance between the DMS and the sight obstruction. If both exceed the value
determined in Table B.1 or B.2, then the sign may be obstructed. The estimated viewing
0
500
1000
1500
2000
2500
3000
0 2000 4000 6000 8000 10000
Curve Radius (ft)
Availab
le D
MS
Read
ing
Dis
tan
ce
(ft)
30 ft obstruction offset 80 ft obstruction offset
APPENDIX B Message Length Reductions for Horizontal Curves Page B-5
distance is then converted to a corresponding viewing time using equation 1. Finally, the
available viewing time is used to estimate the number of units of information that can be
presented to motorists on the DMS at that location.
The following examples illustrate the procedure.
B.3 EXAMPLE 1
A portable DMS is placed 2 ft from the edge of travel lanes on a rural highway upstream of a
work zone toward the end of a long (2500 ft) horizontal curve. Traffic speeds on the roadway
average 65 mph. A bridge overpass abutment is located upstream of the DMS along the curve as
well. The abutment is 50 ft from the edge of the travel lane, and the curve radius is 1500 ft. Is
the viewing distance of the DMS constrained by the bridge abutment?
Using Table B.1 for the 2-ft DMS offset, the available viewing distance around the curve for an
obstruction located 50 ft from the roadway is 750 ft. The length of the curve is longer than this
value, and so the analysis proceeds to the computation of available viewing time. A motorist
traveling 65 mph around the curve will have the following available time:
seconds81.47mph65
feet750TimeViewing
This time allows 4 units of information of information to be presented on the DMS. This is
considered the maximum amount of information that a motorist can perceive and process while
driving. Therefore, the horizontal curve does not constrict the amount of information that can be
presented on the DMS.
B.4 EXAMPLE 2
A portable DMS is to be used to assist in providing trailblazer information along a detour
route for a section of freeway that has been closed. The sign will be placed 10 ft from the travel
lanes. The diversion route is an urban arterial with vehicle operating speeds of about 40 mph.
The operating agency is contemplating the location of the sign toward the end of the 750-ft
horizontal curve with curve radius of 500 ft. A brick wall located 20 ft from the roadway is used
to separate the roadway from the adjacent neighborhood. Does the curve constrain the amount of
information that can be presented on the DMS?
Using Table B.2, the available viewing distance for an obstruction 20 ft from the roadway is 250
ft. This is less than the length of horizontal curve.
APPEND
IX B: Message Length Reductions for H
orizontal Curves
Page B-6
Table B.1 Available DMS Reading Distances around a Horizontal Curve: 2-ft DMS Offset
Edge of Travel Lane to Obstruction (ft) Curve
Radii (ft) 10 20 50 100 150 200 250
250
500
750
1000
1250
1500
1750
2000
2250
2500
2750
3000
4000
5000
7500
10000
100
150
180
200
230
250
270
290
310
320
340
360
410
460
560
650
180
250
310
360
400
440
470
500
530
560
590
620
710
790
970
1120
310
430
530
610
680
750
800
860
910
960
1010
1050
1210
1360
1660
1920
460
630
770
890
990
1080
1170
1250
1320
1390
1460
1520
1760
1960
2400
2770
580
790
950
1100
1220
1340
1440
1540
1630
1720
1800
1880
2170
2420
2970
3420
680
920
1110
1280
1420
1550
1670
1790
1890
2000
2090
2180
2520
2810
3440
3970
790
1040
1250
1440
1600
1750
1880
2010
2130
2240
2350
2450
2820
3150
3850
4450
APPEND
IX B: Message Length Reductions for H
orizontal Curves
Page B-7
Table B.2 Available DMS Reading Distances around a Horizontal Curve: 10-ft DMS Offset
Edge of Travel Lane to Obstruction (ft) Curve
Radii (ft) 10 20 50 100 150 200 250
250
500
750
1000
1250
1500
1750
2000
2250
2500
2750
3000
4000
5000
7500
10000
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
150
210
250
290
330
360
380
410
440
460
480
500
580
650
790
920
300
410
510
580
650
710
770
820
870
920
960
1000
1160
1290
1580
1830
450
620
750
870
970
1060
1140
1220
1290
1360
1430
1490
1720
1920
2350
2710
570
780
940
1080
1210
1320
1420
1520
1610
1700
1780
1860
2140
2390
2920
3370
680
920
110
1270
1410
1540
1660
1770
1880
1980
2070
2160
2490
2780
3400
3930
780
1040
1250
1430
1590
1730
1870
1990
2110
2220
2330
2430
2800
3130
3820
4410
N/A Reading sight distance not available for any message.
APPENDIX B: Message Length Reductions for Horizontal Curves Page B-8
The available viewing time to the DMS along this curve will be
seconds41.47mph40
feet250TimeViewing
This is only enough time to present 2 units of information to drivers on the DMS. The operating
agency will need to make sure that the message displayed on this DMS contains only 2 units of
information, or else select another location for the DMS.
APPENDIX C Message Length Reductions for Rain and Fog Page C-1
APPENDIX C. MESSAGE LENGTH REDUCTIONS
FOR RAIN AND FOG
Rain and fog can influence the amount of information that can be presented on a DMS.
Both conditions deteriorate the amount of light that comes from the DMS (either direct
illumination from the light pixels on the DMS or reflected by the DMS from other light sources
such as the sun, overhead lighting, or automobile headlights). This reduces the contrast between
the sign legend and its background. If the contrast becomes too low, motorists cannot read the
DMS message.
For LED DMSs, contrast ratios are at their minimums on bright, sunny days because the sun
increases the background luminance of the signs. Under cloudy conditions, the luminance of the
legend will be much greater than the background and create very large contrast ratios.
Unfortunately, data on typical DMS background luminance or contrast ratios on cloudy, rainy, or
foggy days are not available (in actuality, there may not be a true “typical” cloudy day anyway).
Conversely, contrast ratios for light-reflecting DMSs decrease as external lighting levels
decrease, becoming zero (or nearly so) as the amount of light falling on the sign reaches zero.
Consequently, it is the light-reflecting technologies for which this section is most appropriate.
C.1 THEORY
EFFECT OF RAINFALL ON LEGIBILITY
Light traveling through rainfall in the atmosphere is attenuated, which causes a reduction in
the apparent luminance and contrast of an object. Mathematically, the influence of rain (which
affects the light transmissivity of the atmosphere) can be described in terms of its effect on the
apparent illumination of an object using Allard’s law, established in the 1870s:
2
d
dtIE
where,
E = apparent illumination at some distance from the object
I = light intensity of the object at its source
t = transmissivity coefficient of the medium over which light is traveling
d = distance from the object to the point where illumination is being measured
The difficulty in applying this relationship to the interpretation of rainfall effects is in relating it
to a factor that can be easily measured and is readily available. Intuitively, light attenuation
should be related to rainfall intensity. Empirical observations have suggested this to be the case.
In one instance, researchers estimated that a 1-in/hr rainfall rate reduces visibility by about 30
APPENDIX C Message Length Reductions for Rain and Fog Page C-2
percent and a 2-in/hr rainfall rate reduces visibility by about 50 percent. Often, a coefficient of
atmospheric extinction term (s) is used instead of the transmissivity coefficient to describe the
optical extinction phenomenon caused by rainfall. These two coefficients are related in the
following simple manner:
–set
A relationship, originally developed by Atlas, expresses the atmospheric extinction coefficient as
a function of rainfall intensity:
000,10
5.85 0.63Rs
where,
s = atmospheric extinction coefficient
R = rainfall intensity (in/hr)
These relationships can then be combined in order to estimate the influence of rainfall on the
apparent illuminance of an object. To illustrate, Figure C.1 presents the relative reduction in the
illuminance of a DMS as a function of the distance to that object for various rainfall intensity
rates.
Figure C.1 Effect of Rainfall on the Apparent Illuminance of a DMS
The reduction in illuminance from a DMS due to rainfall may or may not impact its legibility,
depending on the design characteristics of the sign. As will be discussed more thoroughly in a
later section of this Appendix, there is a fairly wide range of luminance values (which are
inherently related to sign illuminance) and contrast ratios that provide fairly consistent
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
1.2
0 500 1000 1500 2000 2500
Distance From Object (ft)
Pro
po
rtio
n o
f N
orm
al
Illu
min
an
ce
0.25"/hr 0.5"/hr
1"/hr 2"/hr
APPENDIX C Message Length Reductions for Rain and Fog Page C-3
performance in terms of message legibility. In adverse weather conditions, a given rainfall rate
may or may not have an impact upon legibility, depending on the luminance level normally
provided by the sign. If the rainfall rate is excessive enough to reduce the apparent sign
luminance below minimum requirements, a degradation in legibility will occur. On the other
hand, if the reduction in sign luminance caused by the rain still provides adequate contrast, no
significant change in legibility would be expected. Since the occurrence of rain in the daytime
typically reduces ambient lighting levels (as compared to bright sunlight), a reduced DMS
luminance would not automatically reduce contrast levels below minimum acceptable thresholds.
The effect of rain at night would be to also reduce sign luminance values, but again contrast
levels are already so great that the reduction would need to be extremely severe in order to
adversely affect legibility. In fact, it could be envisioned that rainfall could actually be
somewhat beneficial to nighttime legibility if the normal DMS luminance levels were at or
slightly above optimum levels and were approaching irradiation conditions.
A final note is required in this section. The mathematical model above does not take into
consideration the potential for light scatter due to water on the windshield, which might simulate
irradiation conditions, nor does the model account for the periodic obscuring of the sign as the
windshield wipers pass over the driver’s line of sight. Such influences are vehicle and driver
dependent and beyond representation in any reasonable model.
EFFECT OF FOG ON LEGIBILITY
Allard’s law can also be used to theorize the effect of fog on DMS legibility. Again,
however, the difficulty comes in relating the transmissivity coefficient to an easily measurable
and interpretable factor describing fog intensity or density. Unlike rainfall intensity, researchers
found no relationship in the literature to relate fog characteristics to an atmospheric extinction or
transmissivity coefficient. Several fog warning systems that are in place worldwide utilize fog
detection equipment that measures changes in atmospheric transmissivity over some distance.
However, these systems are designed to determine when fog is present (and to enact appropriate
warning devices), not to relate how the fog affects visibility and legibility.
Rather than attempt to work directly with Allard’s law, researchers looked for alternative
approaches to relate DMS legibility to fog characteristics. Researchers were able to identify a
relationship that relates the apparent contrast of an object to its “normal” contrast as a function of
the visibility range of the atmosphere. This relationship, as expressed by Duntley, is as follows :
RV
inherentapparent CC–3.912
e
where,
Capparent = apparent contrast of object viewed as some distance under given degraded
atmospheric visibility conditions
Cinherent = inherent contrast of object under perfect visibility conditions
V = atmospheric visibility range
R = distance at which object is being viewed
APPENDIX C Message Length Reductions for Rain and Fog Page C-4
The National Weather Service describes atmospheric visibility ranges as part of its normal
operations, and so atmospheric visibility is a factor that is easily accessible. Duntley’s
relationship can be used to generate a plot describing the relative reduction in contrast as a
function of viewing distance and atmospheric visibility ranges. This is shown in Figure C.2.
Figure C.2 Effect of Fog on DMS Contrast Levels
Figure C.2 illustrates the dramatic effect that fog will have upon DMS legibility during daytime
conditions. For example, fog that limits atmospheric visibility to 0.5 mile will reduce the
apparent contrast of a DMS message viewed at 800 ft by nearly 50 percent. If the fog is heavier
(i.e., 0.25 mile visibility), contrast levels of the DMS viewed at 800 ft will be reduced by 90
percent.
As with rainfall impacts upon DMS legibility, reductions in legibility caused by fog are
dependent upon the normal contrast levels generated by the sign. Legibility distances are
affected once degraded contrast levels fall below minimum levels. The use of contrast as the
primary measure for assessing DMS legibility does create problems in considering nighttime
conditions, however. Contrast levels at night are nearly infinite, and so the impact of fog is not
easily interpreted from the above equation or graph. It is conceivable that fog could have a
negligible impact on nighttime legibility because of these high original contrast levels (or fog
might even enhance legibility slightly by reducing the effects of irradiation when the DMS
luminance levels are too high). On the other hand, the above mathematical model does not take
into consideration the effects of light scatter and refraction of the vehicle headlights back to the
driver, which would raise the apparent ambient light levels at the driver’s eye and possibly
reduce contrast levels (and thus legibility distances).
0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1
0 200 400 600 800 1000 1200
Viewing Distance (ft)
Pro
po
rtio
n o
f
Ori
gin
al
Co
ntr
as
t
1 mile visibility 1/2 mile visibility
1/4 mile visibility
APPENDIX C Message Length Reductions for Rain and Fog Page C-5
C.2 PROCEDURE
This section presents a very simple procedure to check whether the DMS viewing distance
desired for a given message will result in a contrast ratio that exceeds the minimum required
under a given fog condition. Figure C.2 presents contrast reduction factors for daytime fog
conditions. The analyst selects the desired DMS viewing distance and the appropriate fog
condition. The value read from the y-axis is the reduction factor that is applied to the normal
contrast ratio for that particular sign.
The following general guidelines are suggested for initial contrast ratios in daylight but overcast
conditions. The reflective disk values are based on TTI data and published literature for sunny
conditions (which are probably slightly higher than would be achieved in overcast conditions).
The values for LED DMSs are those observed by TTI under sunny conditions, increased by
approximately 50 percent to account for lower ambient light when the sky is overcast. Data are
needed in the future to better define these ranges.
DMS Type Normal Contrast Ratio Range
Reflective Disk 5–10
Light-Emitting 20–50
The following example illustrates how Figure C.2 is used to assess whether weather conditions
would affect the necessary visibility distance of the DMS.
C.3 EXAMPLE 1
A permanent LED DMS is located in the middle of a six-lane freeway (offset between the
motorist in the right lane and the middle of the DMS = 60 ft). A fog that rolled in the previous
evening is still present the next morning as the peak period begins, limiting visibility to about
0.75 mile. A series of messages designed for use during peak period incidents on that sign have
been developed with four units of information and are stored at the control center for
downloading. Traffic speeds have only reduced slightly (i.e., 60 mph). Can the original
messages with four units of information be used in this foggy condition?
PROCEDURE:
1. Figure C.2 is used with (2 * 4 * 60 * 1.47 + 300) = 1004 ft required visibility distance (300 ft
is the additional distance required for the lateral offset) and an extrapolation between the 1-
and 0.5-mile visibility curves.
2. The resulting adjustment factor is 0.4.
3. It is assumed that the DMS normally generates a contrast ratio of approximately 25 in normal
weather. Multiply this value by the 0.4 adjustment factor.
4. The resulting ratio, 10, is within the optimum range. No adjustments are needed.
APPENDIX C Message Length Reductions for Rain and Fog Page C-6
C.4 EXAMPLE 2
Assume the same conditions as previous but that the technology is a reflective disk DMS
with a normal contrast ratio in the morning peak of approximately 8.
PROCEDURE:
The same adjustment factor (0.4) is used to multiply by the normal contrast ratio (8). The
product is 3.2, which is at the lower threshold of human performance. Given that driving in
adverse weather typically increases the demand for the motorist’s attention, the DMS message
designer may be better served to reduce the length of the messages to 3 units of information (so
that the message can be read in 6 seconds or less) on this day.
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-1
APPENDIX D. EFFECTS OF LARGE TRUCKS
ON DMS LEGIBILITY
Large trucks can be a major cause of sight obstructions to DMSs. Motorists traveling close
behind or adjacent to a truck may have a limited amount of time to read a DMS. If they follow
too closely, they may not be able to see the DMS at all. This can occur in some instances for
permanent overhead DMSs. However, the majority of concerns relating to trucks pertain to the
portable DMSs located to the side of the travel lanes.
Evaluating truck obstructions of DMSs requires a slightly different analysis approach. This is
because a motorist has the ability to adjust his or her speed slightly relative to that of a truck and
find a travel position that allows for adequate viewing. However, as the number of trucks on the
roadway increases, the amount of roadway space that a motorist can travel in with an
unobstructed view decreases. If the number of vehicles traveling on the facility approaches or
exceeds the number that can “fit” into the unobstructed viewing spaces, then some motorists will
not be able to read all of a DMS message. Depending on the specific message being presented,
this can begin to create operational problems on the facility.
D.1 THEORY
Large trucks can significantly obstruct a motorist’s reading distance to a DMS. Motorists
traveling close behind or adjacent to a truck may be limited in the amount of time they have to
read a DMS, or may not be able to see the DMS at all. This can occur in some instances for
DMSs mounted directly over the travel lanes. However, the majority of concerns relating to
trucks pertain to DMSs located to the side of the travel lanes.
Others have noted the problems that trucks create with respect to obstructing both roadside and
overhead signing. Unfortunately, only limited efforts have been undertaken to date to quantify
the magnitude of the obstruction problem. Furthermore, those who have tried to assess the
impacts have only addressed simple signing situations having limited reading time requirements.
Evaluating truck obstructions of a DMS requires a slightly different analysis approach than that
used for horizontal and vertical curvature. This is because a motorist has the ability to adjust his
or her speed slightly relative to that of a truck and find a travel position that allows for adequate
viewing. However, as the number of trucks on the roadway increases, the amount of roadway
space that a motorist can travel in with an unobstructed view decreases. If the number of
vehicles traveling on the facility approaches or exceeds the number that can “fit” into the
unobstructed viewing spaces, then some motorists will not be able to read all of a DMS message.
Depending on the specific message being presented, this can begin to create operational
problems on the facility.
To analyze the roadside-mounted (i.e., portable) DMS visibility problem, the proportion of
driving area on a roadway where visibility distances to a DMS are unacceptable (i.e., less than
required viewing times) is computed. Figure D.1 illustrates the geometrics of this situation for a
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-2
shoulder lane passenger vehicle and truck (this could occur either on a multi-lane roadway or on
a two-lane, two-way highway). The analysis process relies on the assumption that DMS reading
must be completed within the 10° driver cone of vision. Simple trigonometric relationships are
then used establish the minimum acceptable passenger vehicle-truck separation for a side-
mounted DMS positioned at a given offset distance from the edge of the travel lane.
The minimum gap size required for the passenger vehicle driver to read the DMS is the
difference between the required sight distance (S) and the sign-to-back-of-truck-distance (x).
Using the equations illustrated in Figure D.1, this can be written as:
Figure D.1 Effect of a Truck on Shoulder Lane Vehicles Seeing a DMS
Figure D.2 presents a similar analysis when a truck is in the shoulder lane and a passenger
vehicle is in the adjacent lane. Because the motorist in a passenger vehicle in this scenario can
see the roadside both in front of and behind the truck from the adjacent lane, the situation is
analyzed in two phases. The first phase considers how far back the passenger vehicle can be
relative to the truck and still be able to adequately read the DMS by looking in front of the truck
(depicted in Figure D.2a). The second phase addresses how far behind the truck the passenger
vehicle must be in order to read the DMS from behind the truck (shown in Figure D.2b).
s+L s+TW)(L S=GapMinimum
32
––1 (1)
Minimum gap needed fordriver to read DMS
1/2(L-TW) + s 2/3L+s
x S=
2/3L+sx = S
S = sight distance neededs = DMS offsetL = lane widthTW = truck widthTL = truck length = DMS
1/2(L-TW)+s
2/3L+s
S
LTW
sx
TL
DMS
1/2(L-TW) + s
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-3
(a)
(b)
Figure D.2 Effect of a Truck on Adjacent Lane Vehicles Seeing a DMS
The distance between these two locations (equal to the sum of the variable x from both figures)
defines the roadway section in the adjacent lane next to the truck where a driver cannot
adequately read the DMS message. In Figure D.2a, the location of the passenger vehicle relative
to the back of the truck can be written as follows:
1/2(L+TW)
1 2/3L+s+SW
z = [1 2/3L + s+SW] / tan 10o
z
xDMS
TW
TLy
10o
y = [1/2(L + TW) + s+SW] / tan 10o
SW
s
1 2/3L+s
S
DMSys
x
1/2(L-TW) + s
y = S( )1/2(L-TW) - s
1 2/3L+s
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-4
where,
L = lane width (ft)
TL = truck length (ft)
TW = truck width (ft)
The other variables are as defined in the figure. This position reflects the fact that the reading of
the message needs to be completed before the sign is out of the driver 10° cone of vision. If a
vehicle is any farther behind the front of the truck than position x, the DMS will become
obscured before reaching that critical cone of vision, and thus the full reading distance needed
will not be provided.
Likewise, the variable x in Figure D.2b is defined in terms of lane width, truck width, and DMS
offset as shown in the following equation:
This allows the driver to experience the full reading DMS distance from behind the truck. If the
driver is any closer to the back of the truck, the needed reading distance will not be achieved.
With the variable x in both equations defined relative to the same location on the truck, their sum
defines the length of roadway in that adjacent lane where DMS viewing is not adequate.
The same type of analysis is valid for each lane to the left of the truck. The total effect of a
single truck is the sum of inadequate viewing lengths in each lane. The same type of approach is
then used to evaluate the influence of trucks in other lanes (the relative offset of the DMS will be
measured to the next lane, though). In general, the influence of these trucks in the left lanes will
be much less significant than for the trucks in the right shoulder lane when the DMSs are positioned to the right of the travel lanes.
Once the impact of an individual truck in each of the travel lanes has been estimated in terms of
the length of lane segment that is obscured, the next step in the analysis is to determine whether
adequate “viewing capacity” exists for the traffic that is using the facility.
TLTWL
=TLyz=x 67
–10tan
––– 2
1
(2)
s+L s+TWL
S=y S=x32
21
1
)(–1– (3)
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-5
D.2. PROCEDURE
The analysis procedure to assess the impact of large trucks on DMS viewing time requires an
iterative process that begins with a required viewing distance corresponding to particular DMS
message of interest. This distance is simply the number of units of information being presented
multiplied by 2 seconds each (i.e., the necessary viewing time), and then multiplied by the
average travel speed of the vehicle. Other data required at this point in the analysis include the
following:
The number of travel lanes on the facility,
The lateral offset of the DMS to the travel lanes,
The volume of traffic on the roadway per direction,
The percent of traffic that comprises large trucks, and
An estimate of how truck traffic distributes itself among the available travel lanes (i.e., what
percentage travels in the shoulder lane, what percentage travels in the next adjacent lane,
etc.).
The procedure consists of the following steps:
1. Divide the total traffic volume on the roadway into an auto volume and truck volume (truck
volume = total volume percent of trucks on the roadway; auto volume = total volume –
truck volume).
2. Estimate the truck volume in each lane (based on local data, as there are no true “typical”
truck lane distributions. Most trucks travel in the right lane).
3. Estimate the density of trucks in each lane per mile (truck volume in each lane/average truck
speed). Estimate average automobile density (auto volume/average speed).
4. Estimate the necessary viewing distance for a particular DMS message of interest (as
described above).
5. Select the appropriate truck influence table (Table D.1 or D.2) for the roadway being
analyzed. Enter the table using the necessary viewing distance to find the truck influence
distance for each truck in each lane. This distance represents the space around each truck
where a motorist will not be able to obtain the desired viewing distance for the DMS
message.
6. Multiply the influence distance of each truck in each lane by the number of trucks in each
lane and sum these distances over all lanes. This is the total truck viewing influence per
mile.
7. Subtract the total truck viewing influence distance per mile from the total available viewing
distance in the absence of trucks (equal to the number of travel lanes multiplied by 5280
ft/mile). The result is the lane distance per mile where acceptable viewing distance to the
DMS is attainable.
8. Divide the available viewing distance by the minimum space needed by each automobile
while traveling down the roadway. As a conservative value, this is estimated to be equal to
vehicle spacing near capacity conditions (between approximately 120 and 165 ft per
automobile). Multiply this by the average speed of traffic on the roadway to estimate the
volume that represents the automobile “viewing capacity” on that roadway section for that
particular DMS message.
9. Divide the automobile volume on the roadway by the automobile “viewing capacity.”
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-6
10. If the ratio is significantly less than unity (<1), then there is adequate space on the roadway to
view the DMS message of interest.
If the ratio approaches or exceeds unity, there is inadequate viewing capacity and many motorists
will not have enough viewing time to read the DMS message in its entirety. If this occurs, the
analyst must reduce the DMS message in order to reduce the necessary viewing distance. The
analysis then returns to step 4 to reassess the available viewing capacity for the reduced message.
This process continues until an acceptable auto-volume-to-available-viewing-capacity ratio is
achieved.
This process is more easily understood in the context of the following examples.
D.3 EXAMPLE 1
A portable DMS is to be placed alongside a two-lane facility (one lane per direction)
upstream of a shoulder work zone scheduled between 9 a.m. and 3 p.m. The facility has no
paved shoulder, so the DMS is located 2 ft from the edge of the travel lane. Traffic volumes on
the facility are approximately 600 vehicles/hour, with 25 percent of these being large trucks
(average length = 75 ft). Travel speeds on the roadway are 70 mph. Can the DMS message
designer use a message that contains four units of information?
PROCESS:
1. Truck volume = 0.25 * 600 = 150 trucks/hour; auto volume = 600 – 150 = 450 autos/hour.
2. All truck traffic will be located in the single lane.
3. Truck density = 150/70 = 2.1 trucks/mile.
4. Estimated DMS viewing distance = 4 units * 2 sec/unit * 70 mph * 1.47 fps/mph = 823 ft
5. Estimate each truck’s influence distance for a viewing distance of 823 ft (extrapolated in
Table D.1) = 590 ft.
6. Compute total truck influence distance = 590 ft/truck * 2.1 trucks/mile = 1240 ft/mile.
7. Compute lane distance where acceptable viewing occurs = 5280 ft/mile – 1240 ft/mile =
4040 ft/mile.
8. Estimate available automobile viewing capacity = 4040 ft/mile ÷ 140 ft/auto = 28.9
autos/mile. Multiply this value by 70 mph to estimate the available viewing capacity of 2023
autos/hour.
9. Compare ratio of automobile demand to available viewing capacity => 450 ÷ 2023 = 0.22.
Since this is significantly less than unity, the roadway section is expected to have sufficient
space where adequate viewing of the DMS message can occur. No reduction in reading time
of 8 seconds is required.
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-7
Table D.1 Influence Distance of Each Truck (ft):
2-ft DMS Offset from Travel Lanes
Lane that Truck is Located in
(1 is the shoulder lane)
Necessary Viewing
Distance for DMS Message
(ft) 1 2 3 4
2-Lane Highway: 100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
138
200
263
325
388
450
513
575
638
700
4-Lane Highway: 100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
240
386
531
677
822
967
1113
1258
1404
1549
103
132
160
189
217
245
274
302
331
359
6-Lane Highway: 100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
281
515
750
984
1218
1453
1687
1922
2156
2391
177
259
341
423
505
587
669
751
833
916
93
112
130
149
167
185
204
222
240
259
8-Lane Highway: 100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
281
582
909
1235
1561
1888
2214
2540
2866
3193
194
342
490
638
786
933
1081
1229
1377
1525
93
179
262
345
427
510
593
675
758
840
89
102
116
129
143
157
170
184
197
211
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-8
Table D.2. Influence Distance of Each Truck (ft):
10-ft DMS Offset from Travel Lanes
Lane that Truck is Located in
(1 is the shoulder lane)
Necessary Viewing
Distance for DMS Message
(ft) 1 2 3 4
2-Lane Highway: 100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
110
144
179
214
249
283
318
353
388
422
4-Lane Highway: 100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
190
286
381
477
572
668
764
859
955
1050
96
117
138
158
179
200
221
242
263
283
6-Lane Highway: 100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
214
382
549
717
884
105
1219
1387
1555
1722
159
223
288
352
416
480
545
609
673
738
90
105
120
135
149
164
179
194
209
224
8-Lane Highway: 100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
214
422
667
913
1159
1405
1651
1897
2142
2388
167
287
407
528
648
768
888
1009
1129
1249
90
134
193
251
310
369
428
487
545
604
87
98
110
121
133
144
156
168
179
191
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-9
D.4 EXAMPLE 2
A portable DMS is to be placed alongside a six-lane facility (three lanes per direction)
to assist in the management of a downstream incident. The DMS is located 10 ft from the
edge of the travel lane. Traffic volumes on the facility are approximately 4500 vehicles/
hour, with 10 percent of these being large trucks (average length = 75 ft). Local data
indicate that 80 percent of the truck traffic uses the right travel lane, with 10 percent of
trucks using the center and median lanes. Travel speeds on the roadway are 60 mph.
Can the DMS message designer use a message that contains four units of information?
PROCESS:
1. Truck volume = 0.10 * 4500 = 450 trucks/hour; auto volume = 4500 – 450 = 4050
autos/hour.
2. Truck volumes per lane will be 0.80 * 450 = 360 trucks/hour in the shoulder lane,
0.10 * 450 = 45 trucks/hour in the center and median lanes.
3. Truck density: 360/60 = 6 trucks/mile in the shoulder lane, 45/60 = 0.75 trucks/mile
in center and median lanes.
4. Estimated DMS viewing distance = 4 units * 2 sec/unit * 60 mph * 1.47 fps/mph =
705 ft.
5. Estimate each truck’s influence distance for a viewing distance of 705 ft (extrapolated
in Table D.1) = 1220 ft for the shoulder lane, 545 ft in the center lane, and 179 ft in
the median lane.
6. Compute total truck influence distance:
1220 ft/truck * 6 trucks/mile = 7320 ft/mile for shoulder lane trucks
545 ft/truck * 0.75 trucks/mile = 410 ft/mile for median lane trucks
179 ft/truck * 0.75 trucks/mile = 130 ft/mile for shoulder lane trucks
7860 ft/mile obstructed viewing due to trucks.
7. Compute lane distance where acceptable viewing occurs
5280 ft/mile * 3 lanes – 7860 ft/mile = 7980 ft/mile
====> 7980 lane ft/mile has viewing conditions that offer 705 ft of viewing
distance to the DMS.
8. Estimate available automobile viewing capacity = 7980 ft/mile ÷ 140 ft/auto = 57
autos/mile. This equates to a viewing capacity volume of 57 * 60 = 3420 autos/hour.
9. Compare ratio of automobile demand to available viewing capacity = 4050 ÷ 3420 =
1.2. Since this is greater than unity, the roadway section will not have sufficient
space where adequate viewing of the DMS message can occur. Reductions in the
number of units of information are required.
Based on these calculations, suppose that the analyst than adjusts the DMS message to 2
units of information. To check whether this is acceptable, the analyst returns to step 4 in
the process and proceeds through the process again:
4. Estimated required DMS viewing distance = 2 * 2 * 60 * 1.47 = 355 ft.
APPENDIX D Effects of Large Trucks on DMS Legibility Page D-10
5. Estimate each truck’s influence distance for a viewing distance of 355 ft (extrapolated
in Table D.2) = 635 ft for the shoulder lane, 320 ft in the center lane, and 125 ft in the
median lane.
6. Compute total truck influence distance:
635 ft/truck * 6 trucks/mile = 3810 ft/mile for shoulder lane trucks
320 ft/truck * 0.75 trucks/mile = 240 ft/mile for median lane trucks
125 ft/truck * 0.75 trucks/mile = 95 ft/mile for shoulder lane trucks
4145 ft/mile obstructed viewing due to trucks.
7. Compute lane distance where acceptable viewing occurs
5280 ft/mile * 3 lanes – 4145 ft/mile = 11,695 ft/mile.
8. Estimate available automobile viewing capacity = 11,695 ft/mile ÷ 140 ft/auto = 84
autos/mile. This equates to a viewing capacity volume of 84 * 60 = 5015 autos/hour.
9. Compare ratio of automobile demand to available viewing capacity = 4050 ÷ 5015 =
0.80. Since this is less than unity, the roadway section will have sufficient space
where adequate viewing of the DMS message can occur.
It should be noted that a demand to available viewing capacity ratio less than unity does
not guarantee that all automobile drivers will see the DMS for the required viewing
distance, only that there is potential space within the traffic stream as a whole where
adequate viewing is possible. Some motorists may still choose to travel immediately
behind or adjacent to large trucks, and their view will be obstructed. Unless they adjust
their position relative to the truck, they will still miss the DMS message. From an
operational standpoint, however, the lower the demand to available viewing capacity
ratio, the less likely that automobile drivers will travel in obstructed viewing locations
around large trucks and the greater the likelihood of reaching the intended audience with
the DMS message.